hsba201105116k2.htm
FORM 6-K
 
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
 
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
 
 
Report of Foreign Private Issuer
 
Pursuant to Rule 13a - 16 or 15d - 16 of
 
the Securities Exchange Act of 1934
 
 
 
For the month of May
 
HSBC Holdings plc
 
42nd Floor, 8 Canada Square, London E14 5HQ, England
 
 
 
(Indicate by check mark whether the registrant files or will file annual reports under cover of Form 20-F or Form 40-F).
 
Form 20-F   X              Form 40-F ......
 
(Indicate by check mark whether the registrant by furnishing the information contained in this Form is also thereby furnishing the information to the Commission pursuant to Rule 12g3-2(b) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934).
 
Yes.......          No    X
 
(If "Yes" is marked, indicate below the file number assigned to the registrant in connection with Rule 12g3-2(b): 82- ..............).
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 



 
UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND
EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
 
FORM 10-Q
 
 
(Mark One)
R
QUARTERLY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d)
 OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the quarterly period ended March 31, 2011
OR
o
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d)
OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period from                    to                      
 
Commission file number 1-7436
 
 
HSBC USA INC.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
 
Maryland
13-2764867
(State of Incorporation)
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)
452 Fifth Avenue, New York
10018
(Address of principal executive offices)
(Zip Code)
 
(212) 525-5000
Registrant's telephone number, including area code
 
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.  Yes R No o
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).  Yes o No o
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of "large accelerated filer," "accelerated filer" and "smaller reporting company" in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):
 
Large accelerated filer o                    Accelerated filer o                    Non-accelerated filer R                  Smaller reporting company o
                                            (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).  Yes o No R
 
As of April 30, 2011, there were 712 shares of the registrant's common stock outstanding, all of which are owned by HSBC North America Inc.
 


HSBC USA Inc.
 
FORM 10-Q
 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
Part/Item No.
 
Page
Part I.
   
Item 1.
Financial Statements (Unaudited):
 
 
Consolidated Statement of Income
 
 
Consolidated Balance Sheet
 
 
Consolidated Statement of Changes in Shareholders' Equity
 
 
Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows
 
 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
Item 2.
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations:
 
 
Forward-Looking Statements
 
 
Executive Overview
 
 
Basis of Reporting
 
 
Balance Sheet Review
 
 
Real Estate Owned
 
 
Results of Operations
 
 
Segment Results - IFRSs Basis
 
 
Credit Quality
 
 
Liquidity and Capital Resources
 
 
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
 
 
Fair Value
 
 
Risk Management
 
 
Average Balances and Interest Rates
 
Item 3.
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
 
Item 4.
Controls and Procedures
 
Part II
   
Item 1.
Legal Proceedings
 
Item 6.
Exhibits
 
Index
 
Signature
 
 


 
 
PART I. FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
Item 1. Financial Statements
 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF INCOME  (UNAUDITED)
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Interest income:
   
Loans
$923
$1,211
Securities
319
242
Trading assets
51
32
Short-term investments
31
28
Other
12
11
Total interest income
1,336
1,524
Interest expense:
   
Deposits
116
163
Short-term borrowings
13
21
Long-term debt
163
140
Total interest expense
292
324
Net interest income
1,044
1,200
Provision for credit losses
106
211
Net interest income after provision for credit losses
938
989
Other revenues:
   
Credit card fees
169
233
Other fees and commissions
198
285
Trust income
28
26
Trading revenue
224
186
Net other-than-temporary impairment losses(1)
-
(28)
Other securities gains, net
44
21
Servicing and other fees from HSBC affiliates
46
33
Residential mortgage banking revenue (loss)
(35)
(37)
Gain on instruments designated at fair value and related derivatives
21
46
Other income
29
158
Total other revenues
724
923
Operating expenses:
   
Salaries and employee benefits
293
264
Support services from HSBC affiliates
461
510
Occupancy expense, net
68
71
Other expenses
278
209
Total operating expenses
1,100
1,054
Income from continuing operations before income tax expense
562
858
Income tax expense
82
314
Income from continuing operations
480
544
Discontinued operations (Note 2):
   
Income (loss) from discontinued operations before income tax (benefit) expense
(2)
16
Income tax (benefit) expense
(1)
6
(Loss) income from discontinued operations
(1)
10
Net income
$479
$554
 
 
(1)
During the three months ended March 31, 2011 there were no other-than-temporary impairment ("OTTI") losses on securities recognized in other revenues and no OTTI losses in the non-credit component on securities were recognized in accumulated other comprehensive loss ("AOCL"). During the three months ended March 31, 2010, OTTI losses on securities available-for-sale and held-to-maturity totaling $28 million were recognized in other revenues and losses in the non-credit component recognized in AOCL were not significant.
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.
 


CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET  (UNAUDITED)
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Assets(1)
   
Cash and due from banks
$1,968
$1,576
Interest bearing deposits with banks
27,838
8,202
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell
6,774
8,236
Trading assets
32,980
32,402
Securities  available-for-sale
40,575
45,523
Securities held-to-maturity (fair value of $2.4 billion and $3.4 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, and includes $881 million at December 31, 2010 collateralizing short-term borrowings)
2,222
3,190
Loans (includes $1.5 billion at December 31, 2010 collateralizing debt)
71,718
73,069
Less - allowance for credit losses
1,832
2,170
Loans, net
69,886
70,899
Loans held for sale (includes $814 million and $1.3 billion designated under fair value option at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively)
1,688
2,390
Properties and equipment, net
532
549
Intangible assets, net
425
424
Goodwill
2,626
2,626
Other assets
8,949
7,677
Assets of discontinued operations
124
119
Total assets
$196,587
$183,813
Liabilities(1)
   
Debt:
   
Deposits in domestic offices:
   
Noninterest bearing
$23,342
$23,078
Interest bearing (includes $8.3 billion and $7.4 billion designated under fair value option at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively)
75,584
72,808
Deposits in foreign offices:
   
Noninterest bearing
1,301
1,263
Interest bearing
32,534
23,502
Total deposits
132,761
120,651
Short-term borrowings
13,820
15,187
Long-term debt (includes $5.4 billion designated under fair value option at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 and $150 million at December 31, 2010, collateralized by loans and available-for-sale securities)
16,986
17,230
Total debt
163,567
153,068
Trading liabilities
11,165
10,528
Interest, taxes and other liabilities
4,625
3,470
Liabilities of discontinued operations
9
14
Total liabilities
179,366
167,080
Shareholders' equity
   
Preferred stock
1,565
1,565
Common shareholder's equity:
   
Common stock ($5 par; 150,000,000 shares authorized; 712 shares issued and outstanding at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010)
-
-
Additional paid-in capital
13,808
13,785
Retained earnings
1,997
1,536
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
(149)
(153)
Total common shareholder's equity
15,656
15,168
Total shareholders' equity
17,221
16,733
Total liabilities and shareholders' equity
$196,587
$183,813
 
 
(1)
The following table summarizes assets and liabilities related to variable interest entities ("VIEs") as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 which are consolidated on our balance sheet. Assets and liabilities exclude intercompany balances that eliminate in consolidation.


 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Assets
   
Interest bearing deposits with banks
$90
$759
Securities  held-to-maturity
-
881
Loans, net
11,658
14,183
Other assets
690
(543)
Total assets
$12,438
$15,280
Liabilities
   
Deposits
$23
$20
Short-term borrowings
-
3,022
Long-term debt
55
205
Interest, taxes and other liabilities
1,251
373
Total liabilities
$1,329
$3,620
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.
 


CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY  (UNAUDITED)
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Preferred stock
   
Balance at beginning and end of period
$1,565
$1,565
Common stock
   
Balance at beginning and end of period
-
-
Additional paid-in capital
   
Balance at beginning of period
13,785
13,795
Capital contributions from parent
21
-
Return of capital on preferred shares issued to CT Financial Services, Inc. 
-
(3)
Employee benefit plans and other
2
2
Balance at end of period
13,808
13,794
Retained earnings
   
Balance at beginning of period
1,536
45
Adjustment to initially apply new guidance for consolidation of VIEs, net of tax
-
1
Balance at beginning of period, as adjusted
1,536
46
Net income
479
554
Cash dividends declared on preferred stock
(18)
(19)
Balance at end of period
1,997
581
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
   
Balance at beginning of period
(153)
(228)
Adjustment to initially apply new guidance for consolidation of VIEs, net of tax
-
(246)
Balance at beginning of period, as adjusted
(153)
(474)
Net change in unrealized gains (losses), net of tax as applicable on:
   
Securities  available-for-sale, not other-than-temporarily impaired
(147)
104
Other-than-temporarily impaired securities available for sale(1)
1
25
Other-than-temporarily impaired securities held to maturity(1)
11
26
Adjustment to reverse other-than-temporary impairment on securities held-to-maturity due to deconsolidation of VIE
142
-
Derivatives designated as cash flow hedges
(4)
6
Unrecognized actuarial gains, transition obligation and prior service costs relating to pension and postretirement benefits, net of tax
1
3
Other comprehensive income, net of tax
4
164
Balance at end of period
(149)
(310)
Total shareholders' equity
$17,221
$15,630
Comprehensive income
   
Net income
$479
$554
Other comprehensive income, net of tax
4
164
Comprehensive income
$483
$718
 
 
(1)
During the three months ended March 31, 2011 there were no OTTI losses on securities recognized in other revenues and no OTTI losses in the non-credit component on securities were recognized in AOCL. During the three months ended March 31, 2010, OTTI losses on securities available-for-sale and held-to-maturity totaling $28 million were recognized in other revenues and losses in the non-credit component recognized in AOCL were not significant.
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.
 


CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS  (UNAUDITED)
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Cash flows from operating activities
   
Net income
$479
$554
Income (loss) from discontinued operations
(1)
10
Income from continuing operations
480
544
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:
   
Depreciation and amortization
203
154
Impairment of internally developed software
78
-
Provision for credit losses
106
211
Other-than-temporary impairment losses relating to credit
-
28
Realized gains on securities available for sale
(44)
(21)
Net change in other assets and liabilities
(225)
2,573
Net change in loans held for sale:
   
Originations of loans
(1,052)
(947)
Sales and collection of loans held for sale
1,600
1,516
Tax refund anticipation loans:
   
Originations of loans
-
(3,068)
Transfers of loans to HSBC Finance, including premium
-
3,072
Net change in trading assets and liabilities
191
2,931
LOCOM on loans held for sale
12
(85)
Mark-to-market on financial instruments designated at fair value and related derivatives
-
(25)
Net change in fair value of derivatives and hedged items
(73)
(21)
Cash provided by operating activities - continuing operations
1,276
6,862
Cash used in operating activities - discontinued operations
(5)
(144)
Net cash provided by operating activities
1,271
6,718
Cash flows from investing activities
   
Net change in interest bearing deposits with banks
(19,636)
(12,354)
Net change in federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell
1,462
(1,852)
Securities  available-for-sale:
   
Purchases of securities available-for-sale
(4,818)
(12,721)
Proceeds from sales of securities available-for-sale
8,499
6,076
Proceeds from maturities of securities available-for-sale
991
699
Securities held-to-maturity:
   
Purchases of securities held-to-maturity
-
(2,036)
Proceeds from maturities of securities held-to-maturity
371
706
Change in loans:
   
Originations, net of collections
6,902
10,862
Recurring loans purchases from HSBC Finance
(7,906)
(7,834)
Loans sold to third parties
155
41
Net cash used for acquisitions of properties and equipment
(5)
(14)
Other, net
(7)
98
Cash used in investing activities - continuing operations
(13,992)
(18,329)
Cash used in investing activities - discontinued operations
-
-
Net cash used in investing activities
(13,992)
(18,329)
Cash flows from financing activities
   
Net change in deposits
12,085
6,363
Debt:
   
Net change in short-term borrowings
1,260
5,029
Issuance of long-term debt
776
678
Repayment of long-term debt
(975)
(1,171)
Debt repayment related to structured note vehicle VIEs
-
(150)
Repayment of debt issued related to the sale and leaseback of 452 Fifth Avenue property
(11)
-
Return of capital on preferred shares issued to CT Financial Services, Inc. 
-
(3)
Other increases in capital surplus
2
2
Dividends paid
(18)
(19)
Cash provided by financing activities - continuing operations
13,119
10,729
Cash provided by financing activities - discontinued operations
-
14
Net cash provided by financing activities
13,119
10,743
Net change in cash and due from banks
398
(868)
Cash and due from banks at beginning of period(1)
1,693
3,159
Cash and due from banks at end of period(2)
$2,091
$2,291
Supplemental disclosure of non-cash flow investing activities
   
Trading securities pending settlement
$132
$(757)
 
 
(1)
Cash at beginning of period includes $117 million and $1,060 million for discontinued operations as of January 1, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
   
(2)
Cash at end of period includes $123 million and $771 million for discontinued operations as of March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statement
 
 


            .
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
Note
 
Page
1
Organization and Basis of Presentation
 
2
Discontinued Operations
 
3
Trading Assets and Liabilities
 
4
Securities
 
5
Loans
 
6
Allowance for Credit Losses
 
7
Loans Held for Sale
 
8
Intangible Assets
 
9
Goodwill
 
10
Derivative Financial Instruments
 
11
Fair Value Option
 
12
Income Taxes
 
13
Pension and Other Postretirement Benefits
 
14
Related Party Transactions
 
15
Regulatory Capital
 
16
Business Segments
 
17
Variable Interest Entities
 
18
Guarantee Arrangements and Pledged Assets
 
19
Litigation and Regulatory Matters
 
20
Fair Value Measurements
 
21
New Accounting Pronouncements
 
 
1.  Organization and Basis of Presentation
 
HSBC USA Inc. is an indirect wholly owned subsidiary of HSBC North America Holdings Inc. ("HSBC North America"), which is an indirect wholly owned subsidiary of HSBC Holdings plc ("HSBC"). The accompanying unaudited interim consolidated financial statements of HSBC USA Inc. and its subsidiaries (collectively "HUSI") have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America ("U.S. GAAP") for interim financial information and with the instructions to Form 10-Q and Article 10 of Regulation S-X, as well as in accordance with predominant practices within the banking industry. Accordingly, they do not include all of the information and footnotes required by generally accepted accounting principles for complete financial statements. In the opinion of management, all normal and recurring adjustments considered necessary for a fair presentation of financial position, results of operations and cash flows for the interim periods have been made. HSBC USA Inc. and its subsidiaries may also be referred to in this Form 10-Q as "we," "us" or "our." These unaudited interim consolidated financial statements should be read in conjunction with our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2010 (the "2010 Form 10-K"). Certain reclassifications have been made to prior period amounts to conform to the current period presentation.
 
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires the use of estimates and assumptions that affect reported amounts and disclosures. Actual results could differ from those estimates. Unless otherwise noted, information included in these notes to the consolidated financial statements relates to continuing operations for all periods presented. See Note 2, "Discontinued Operations" for further details. Interim results should not be considered indicative of results in future periods.
 
As of March 31, 2011, we no longer have a controlling financial interest in Bryant Park Funding LLC ("Bryant Park") and as a result, we no longer consolidate this variable interest entity. See Note 17, "Variable Interest Entities," for further details and related impact.
 
2.  Discontinued Operations
 
In June 2010, we decided that the wholesale banknotes business ("Banknotes Business") within our Global Banking and Markets segment did not fit with our core strategy in the U.S. and, therefore, made the decision to exit this business. This business, which was managed out of the United States with operations in key locations worldwide, arranged for the physical distribution of banknotes globally to central banks, large commercial banks and currency exchanges. As a result of this decision, we recorded closure costs of $14 million during 2010, primarily relating to termination and other employee benefits. No significant additional closure costs are expected to be incurred. At March 31, 2011, the remaining liability associated with these costs totaled $2 million.


As part of the decision to exit the Banknotes Business, in October 2010 we sold the assets of our Asian banknotes operations ("Asian Banknotes Operations") to an unaffiliated third party for total consideration of approximately $11 million in cash. As a result, during the third quarter of 2010 we classified the assets of the Asian Banknotes Operations of $23 million, including an allocation of goodwill of $21 million, as held for sale. Because the carrying value of the assets being sold exceeded the agreed-upon sales price, we recorded a lower of cost or fair value adjustment of $12 million in the third quarter of 2010.
 
The exit of our Banknotes Business, including the sale of our Asian Banknotes Operations, was substantially completed in the fourth quarter of 2010 and as a result, we report the results of our Banknotes Business as discontinued operations. The table below summarizes the operating results of our Banknotes Business for the periods presented.
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Net interest income and other revenues
$16
$28
Income (loss) from discontinued operations before income tax (benefit) expense
(2)
16
 
The following summarizes the assets and liabilities of our Banknotes Business which are now reported as assets of discontinued operations and liabilities of discontinued operations in our consolidated balance sheet.
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Cash
$123
$117
Other assets
1
2
Assets of discontinued operations
$124
$119
Other liabilities
$9
$14
Liabilities of discontinued operations
$9
$14
 


3.  Trading Assets and Liabilities
 
Trading assets and liabilities are summarized in the following table.
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Trading assets:
   
U.S. Treasury
$2,164
$1,874
U.S. Government agency
189
62
U.S. Government sponsored enterprises(1)
30
632
Asset-backed securities
1,133
1,148
Corporate and foreign bonds
9,289
5,897
Other securities
49
52
Precious metals
13,594
16,725
Fair value of derivatives
6,532
6,012
 
$32,980
$32,402
Trading liabilities:
   
Securities sold, not yet purchased
$349
$212
Payables for precious metals
5,377
5,326
Fair value of derivatives
5,439
4,990
 
$11,165
$10,528
 
 
(1)
Includes mortgage-backed securities of $14 million and $598 million issued or guaranteed by the Federal National Mortgage Association ("FNMA") and $16 million and $34 million issued or guaranteed by the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation ("FHLMC") at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively
 
At March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, the fair value of derivatives included in trading assets has been reduced by $3.2 billion and $3.1 billion, respectively, relating to amounts recognized for the obligation to return cash collateral received under master netting agreements with derivative counterparties.
 
At March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, the fair value of derivatives included in trading liabilities has been reduced by $5.8 billion, relating to amounts recognized for the right to reclaim cash collateral paid under master netting agreements with derivative counterparties.
 


4.  Securities
 
The amortized cost and fair value of the securities available-for-sale and securities held to maturity are summarized in the following tables.
 
 
 
 
 
March 31, 2011
 
 
 
Amortized
Cost
Non-Credit
Loss
Component of
OTTI
Securities
 
 
 
Unrealized
Gains
 
 
 
Unrealized
Losses
 
 
 
Fair
Value
 
(in millions)
Securities  available-for-sale:
         
U.S. Treasury
$15,938
$-
$95
$(470)
$15,563
U.S. Government sponsored enterprises:(1)
         
Mortgage-backed securities
45
-
-
(1)
44
Direct agency obligations
2,188
-
68
(12)
2,244
U.S. Government agency issued or guaranteed:
         
Mortgage-backed securities
10,558
-
192
(34)
10,716
Collateralized mortgage obligations
6,935
-
129
(48)
7,016
Direct agency obligations
19
-
-
(1)
18
Obligations of U.S. states and political subdivisions
569
-
11
(5)
575
Asset backed securities collateralized by:
         
Residential mortgages
13
-
-
(2)
11
Commercial mortgages
505
-
10
(1)
514
Home equity
436
-
-
(102)
334
Student loans
27
-
-
(2)
25
Other
117
-
1
(15)
103
Corporate and other domestic debt securities(2)
575
-
6
-
581
Foreign debt  securities(2)(6)
2,649
-
48
-
2,697
Equity securities(3)
126
-
8
-
134
Total available-for-sale securities
$40,700
$-
$568
$(693)
$40,575
Securities held-to-maturity:
         
U.S. Government sponsored enterprises:(4)
         
Mortgage-backed securities
$1,528
$-
$148
$-
$1,676
U.S. Government agency issued or guaranteed:
         
Mortgage-backed securities
90
-
15
-
105
Collateralized mortgage obligations
324
-
35
-
359
Obligations of U.S. states and political subdivisions
101
-
3
(1)
103
Asset backed securities collateralized by:
         
Residential mortgages
179
-
9
(2)
186
Total held-to-maturity securities
$2,222
$-
$210
$(3)
$2,429


 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2010
 
 
 
Amortized
Cost
Non-Credit
Loss
Component of
OTTI
Securities
 
 
 
Unrealized
Gains
 
 
 
Unrealized
Losses
 
 
 
Fair
Value
 
(in millions)
Securities  available-for-sale:
         
U.S. Treasury
$19,300
$-
$200
$(402)
$19,098
U.S. Government sponsored enterprises:(1)
         
Mortgage-backed securities
47
-
-
(1)
46
Direct agency obligations
2,100
-
93
(9)
2,184
U.S. Government agency issued or guaranteed:
         
Mortgage-backed securities
11,229
-
260
(27)
11,462
Collateralized mortgage obligations
7,566
-
160
(52)
7,674
Direct agency obligations
19
-
-
(1)
18
Obligations of U.S. states and political subdivisions
571
-
13
(5)
579
Asset backed securities collateralized by:
         
Residential mortgages
13
-
-
(2)
11
Commercial mortgages
537
-
17
(2)
552
Home equity
464
(1)
-
(111)
352
Student loans
29
-
-
(2)
27
Other
120
-
1
(17)
104
Corporate and other domestic debt securities(2)
676
-
7
-
683
Foreign debt  securities(2)(6)
2,540
-
65
-
2,605
Equity securities(3)
126
-
2
-
128
Total available-for-sale securities
$45,337
$(1)
$818
$(631)
$45,523
Securities held-to-maturity:
         
U.S. Government sponsored enterprises:(4)
         
Mortgage-backed securities
$1,586
$-
$151
$-
$1,737
U.S. Government agency issued or guaranteed:
         
Mortgage-backed securities
94
-
15
-
109
Collateralized mortgage obligations
327
-
36
-
363
Obligations of U.S. states and political subdivisions
111
-
4
(1)
114
Asset backed securities collateralized by:
         
Residential mortgages
191
-
8
(3)
196
Asset-backed securities (predominantly credit card) and other debt securities held by consolidated VIE(5)
1,034
(153)
-
-
881
Total held-to-maturity securities
$3,343
$(153)
$214
$(4)
$3,400


 
 
(1)
Includes securities at amortized cost of $28 million and $30 million issued or guaranteed by the FNMA at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, and $17 million issued or guaranteed by FHLMC at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
   
(2)
At March 31, 2011, other domestic debt securities included $575 million of securities at amortized cost fully backed by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation ("FDIC") and foreign debt securities consisted of $2.3 billion of securities fully backed by foreign governments. At December 31, 2010, other domestic debt securities included $676 million of securities at amortized cost fully backed by the FDIC and foreign debt securities consisted of $2.2 billion of securities fully backed by foreign governments.
   
(3)
Includes preferred equity securities at amortized cost issued by FNMA of $2 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010. Balances at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 reflect cumulative other-than-temporary impairment charges of $203 million.
   
(4)
Includes securities at amortized cost of $621 million and $622 million issued or guaranteed by FNMA at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, and $907 million and $964 million issued and guaranteed by FHLMC at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
   
(5)
Relates to securities held by Bryant Park Funding LLC, a variable interest entity which was consolidated at December 31, 2010. See Note 17, "Variable Interest Entities" for additional information.
   
(6)
There were no foreign debt securities issued by the governments of Portugal, Ireland, Italy, Greece or Spain at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
A summary of gross unrealized losses and related fair values as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, classified as to the length of time the losses have existed follows:
 
 
One Year or Less
Greater Than One Year
 
 
March 31, 2011
 
Number of
Securities
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Aggregate
Fair Value
of Investment
 
Number of
Securities
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Aggregate
Fair Value
of Investment
 
(dollars are in millions)
Securities  available-for-sale:
           
U.S. Treasury
37
$(470)
$13,438
-
$-
$-
U.S. Government sponsored enterprises
17
(12)
209
14
(1)
10
U.S. Government agency issued or guaranteed
64
(82)
3,996
2
(1)
2
Obligations of U.S. states and political subdivisions
26
(3)
125
5
(2)
36
Asset backed securities
2
-
-
50
(122)
489
Foreign debt securities
2
-
184
1
-
25
Equity securities
1
-
-
-
-
-
Securities  available-for-sale
149
$(567)
$17,952
72
$(126)
$562
Securities held-to-maturity:
           
U.S. Government sponsored enterprises
24
$-
$9
1
$-
$-
U.S. Government agency issued or guaranteed
610
-
2
6
-
-
Obligations of U.S. states and political subdivisions
25
-
8
10
(1)
13
Asset backed securities
-
-
-
5
(2)
36
Securities  held-to-maturity
659
$-
$19
22
$(3)
$49


 
 
One Year or Less
Greater Than One Year
 
 
December 31, 2010
Number
of
Securities
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Aggregate
Fair Value
of Investment
Number
of
Securities
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Aggregate
Fair Value
of Investment
 
(dollars are in millions)
Securities  available-for-sale:
           
U.S. Treasury
40
$(402)
$7,911
-
$-
$-
U.S. Government sponsored enterprises
14
(9)
131
13
(1)
10
U.S. Government agency issued or guaranteed
70
(80)
4,409
2
-
2
Obligations of U.S. states and political subdivisions
27
(3)
127
5
(2)
36
Asset backed securities
3
-
-
51
(134)
506
Corporate and other domestic debt securities
3
-
200
-
-
-
Foreign debt securities
-
-
-
1
-
25
Securities  available-for-sale
157
$(494)
$12,778
72
$(137)
$579
Securities held-to-maturity:
           
U.S. Government sponsored enterprises
21
$-
$-
1
$-
$-
U.S. Government agency issued or guaranteed
570
-
2
2
-
-
Obligations of U.S. states and political subdivisions
14
-
7
12
(1)
14
Asset backed securities
-
-
-
6
(3)
44
Securities  held-to-maturity
605
$-
$9
21
$(4)
$58
 
Gross unrealized losses within the available-for-sale portfolio increased overall in the first three months of 2011 primarily due to an increase in rates on U.S. Treasury securities. We have reviewed the securities for which there is an unrealized loss in accordance with our accounting policies for other-than-temporary impairment. During the three months ended March 31, 2011, none of our debt securities were determined to have either initial other-than-temporary impairment or changes to previous other-than-temporary impairment estimates relating to the credit component and changes in the non-credit portion represent a reversal of a portion of previously recorded impairment losses that were recognized in other comprehensive income. During the three months ended March 31, 2010, 19 debt securities were determined to have either initial other-than-temporary impairment or changes to previous other-than-temporary impairment estimates. The credit loss component of the applicable debt securities totaling $28 million was recorded as a component of net other-than-temporary impairment losses in the accompanying consolidated statement of income, while there was no significant losses in the non-credit component of such impaired securities reflected in AOCL and changes in the non-credit portion primarily represent a net reversal of a portion of previously recorded impairment losses recognized in other comprehensive income.
 
We do not consider any other securities to be other-than-temporarily impaired as we expect to recover the amortized cost basis of these securities and we neither intend nor expect to be required to sell these securities prior to recovery, even if that equates to holding securities until their individual maturities. However, additional other-than-temporary impairments may occur in future periods if the credit quality of the securities deteriorates.
 
On-going Assessment for Other-Than-Temporary Impairment On a quarterly basis, we perform an assessment to determine whether there have been any events or economic circumstances to indicate that a security with an
unrealized loss has suffered other-than-temporary impairment. A debt security is considered impaired if its fair value is less than its amortized cost at the reporting date. If impaired, we assess whether the unrealized loss is other-than-temporary.
 
An unrealized loss is generally deemed to be other-than-temporary and a credit loss is deemed to exist if the present value of the expected future cash flows is less than the amortized cost basis of the debt security. As a result, the credit loss component of an other-than-temporary impairment write-down for debt securities is recorded in earnings while the remaining portion of the impairment loss is recognized, net of tax, in other comprehensive income provided we do not intend to sell the underlying debt security and it is more-likely-than-not that we would not have to sell the debt security prior to recovery.
 
For all securities held in the available-for-sale or held-to-maturity portfolio for which unrealized losses have existed for a period of time, we do not have the intention to sell and believe we will not be required to sell the securities for contractual, regulatory or liquidity reasons as of the reporting date. As debt securities issued by U.S. Treasury, U.S. Government agencies and government sponsored entities accounted for 88 percent and 89 percent of total available-for-sale and held-to-maturity securities as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, our assessment for credit loss was concentrated on private label asset-backed securities. Substantially all of the private label asset-backed securities are supported by residential mortgages, home equity loans or commercial mortgages. Our assessment for credit loss was concentrated on this particular asset class because of the following inherent risk factors:
 
 
•   The recovery of the U.S. economy remains sluggish;
 
 
•   The continued weakness in the U.S. housing markets with high levels of delinquency and foreclosure;
 
 
•   A lack of traction in government sponsored programs in loan modifications;
 
 
•   A lack of refinancing activities within certain segments of the mortgage market, even at the current low interest rate environment, and the re-default rate for refinanced loans;
 
 
•   The unemployment rate remains high despite recent improvement, and consumer confidence remains low compared to historical levels;
 
 
 
•   The decline in the occupancy rate in commercial properties; and
 
 
•   The severity and duration of unrealized loss.
 
In determining whether a credit loss exists and the period over which the debt security is expected to recover, we considered the following factors:
 
 
•   The length of time and the extent to which the fair value has been less than the amortized cost basis;
 
 
•   The level of credit enhancement provided by the structure, which includes but is not limited to credit subordination positions, over collateralization, protective triggers and financial guarantees provided by monoline wraps;
 
 
•   Changes in the near term prospects of the issuer or underlying collateral of a security such as changes in default rates, loss severities given default and significant changes in prepayment assumptions;
 
 
•   The level of excess cash flows generated from the underlying collateral supporting the principal and interest payments of the debt securities; and
 
 
•   Any adverse change to the credit conditions of the issuer, the monoline insurer or the security such as credit downgrades by the rating agencies.
 
We use a standard valuation model to measure the credit loss for available-for-sale and held-to-maturity securities. The valuation model captures the composition of the underlying collateral and the cash flow structure of the security. Management develops inputs to the model based on external analyst reports and forecasts and internal credit assessments. Significant inputs to the model include delinquencies, collateral types and related contractual
features, estimated rates of default, loss given default and prepayment assumptions. Using the inputs, the model estimates cash flows generated from the underlying collateral and distributes those cash flows to respective tranches of securities considering credit subordination and other credit enhancement features. The projected future cash flows attributable to the debt security held are discounted using the effective interest rates determined at the original acquisition date if the security bears a fixed rate of return. The discount rate is adjusted for the floating index rate for securities which bear a variable rate of return, such as LIBOR-based instruments.
 
The excess of amortized cost over the present value of expected future cash flows recognized during the three months ended March 31, 2010 on our other-than-temporarily impaired debt securities, which represents the credit loss associated with these securities, was $28 million. For the three months ended March 31, 2011 there were no other-than-temporary impairment losses recognized related to credit loss. The excess of the present value of expected future cash flows over fair value, representing the non-credit component of the unrealized loss associated with all other-than-temporarily impaired securities, was $154 million at December 31, 2010. At March 31, 2011, there are no remaining non-credit component amounts recognized. Since we did not have the intention to sell the securities and had sufficient capital and liquidity to hold these securities until a full recovery of the fair value occurs, only the credit loss component was reflected in the consolidated statement of income. The non-credit component of the unrealized loss was recorded, net of taxes, in other comprehensive income (loss).
 
The following table summarizes the roll-forward of credit losses on debt securities that were other-than-temporarily impaired which were recognized in income:
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Credit losses at the beginning of the period
$36
$81
Credit losses related to securities for which an  other-than-temporary impairment was not previously recognized
-
18
Increase in credit losses for which an other-than-temporary impairment was previously recognized
-
10
Reduction for credit losses previously recognized on sold securities
(4)
(15)
Reduction for credit losses previously recognized on held to maturity securities due to deconsolidation of VIE
(31)
-
Reduction of credit losses for increases in cash flows expected to be collected that are recognized over the remaining life of the security
-
(20)
Ending balance of credit losses on debt securities held for which a portion of an other-than-temporary impairment may have been recognized in other comprehensive income (loss)
$1
$74
 
At March 31, 2011, we held 76 individual asset-backed securities in the available-for-sale portfolio, of which 23 were also wrapped by a monoline insurance company. The asset-backed securities backed by a monoline wrap comprised $420 million of the total aggregate fair value of asset-backed securities of $987 million at March 31, 2011. The gross unrealized losses on these securities were $117 million at March 31, 2011. We did not take into consideration the value of the monoline wrap of any non-investment grade monoline insurers as of March 31, 2011 and, therefore, we only considered the financial guarantee of monoline insurers on securities for purposes of evaluating other-than-temporary impairment with a fair value of $146 million. One security wrapped by a below investment grade monoline insurance company with an aggregate fair value of $1 million was deemed to be other-than-temporarily impaired at March 31, 2011.
 
At December 31, 2010, we held 78 individual asset-backed securities in the available-for-sale portfolio, of which 24 were also wrapped by a monoline insurance company. The asset-backed securities backed by a monoline wrap comprised $437 million of the total aggregate fair value of asset-backed securities of $1.0 billion at December 31, 2010. The gross unrealized losses on these securities were $127 million at December 31, 2010. We did not take into consideration the value of the monoline wrap of any non-investment grade monoline insurers as of December 31, 2010 and, therefore, we only considered the financial guarantee of monoline insurers on securities for purposes of evaluating other-than-temporary impairment with a fair value of $156 million. Two securities wrapped by below investment grade monoline insurance companies with an aggregate fair value of $5 million were deemed to be other-than-temporarily impaired at December 31, 2010.
 
As discussed above, certain asset-backed securities have an embedded financial guarantee provided by monoline insurers. Because the financial guarantee is not a separate and distinct contract from the asset-backed security, they are considered as a single unit of account for fair value measurement and impairment assessment purposes. The monoline insurers are regulated by the insurance commissioners of the relevant states and certain monoline insurers that write the financial guarantee contracts are public companies. In evaluating the extent of our reliance on investment grade monoline insurance companies, consideration is given to our assessment of the creditworthiness of the monoline and other market factors. We perform both a credit as well as a liquidity analysis on the monoline insurers each quarter. Our analysis also compares market-based credit default spreads, when available, to assess the appropriateness of our monoline insurer's creditworthiness. Based on the public information available, including the regulatory reviews and actions undertaken by the state insurance commissions and the published financial results, we determine the degree of reliance to be placed on the financial guarantee policy in estimating the cash flows to be collected for the purpose of recognizing and measuring impairment loss.
 
A credit downgrade to non-investment grade is a key but not the only factor in determining the credit risk or the monoline insurer's ability to fulfill its contractual obligation under the financial guarantee arrangement. Although a monoline may have been down-graded by the credit rating agencies or have been ordered to commute its operations by the insurance commissioners, it may retain the ability and the obligation to continue to pay claims in the near term. We evaluate the short-term liquidity of and the ability to pay claims by the monoline insurers in estimating the amounts of cash flows expected to be collected from specific asset-backed securities for the purpose of assessing and measuring credit loss.
 
The following table summarizes realized gains and losses on investment securities transactions attributable to available-for-sale and held to maturity securities.
 
 
Gross
Realized
Gains
Gross
Realized
(Losses)
Net
Realized
Gains (Losses)
 
(in millions)
Three months ended March 31, 2011:
     
Securities  available-for-sale
$82
$(38)
$44
Securities held to maturity
-
-
-
 
$82
$(38)
$44
Three months ended March 31, 2010:
     
Securities  available-for-sale
$32
$(34)
$(2)
Securities held to maturity
-
(5)
(5)
 
$32
$(39)
$(7)
 
The amortized cost and fair values of securities available-for-sale and securities held-to-maturity at March 31, 2011, are summarized in the table below by contractual maturity. Expected maturities differ from contractual maturities because borrowers have the right to prepay obligations without prepayment penalties in certain cases. Securities available-for-sale amounts exclude equity securities as they do not have stated maturities. The table below also reflects the distribution of maturities of debt securities held at March 31, 2011, together with the approximate taxable equivalent yield of the portfolio. The yields shown are calculated by dividing annual interest income, including the accretion of discounts and the amortization of premiums, by the amortized cost of securities outstanding at March 31, 2011. Yields on tax-exempt obligations have been computed on a taxable equivalent basis using applicable statutory tax rates.
 
   
After One
After Five
 
 
Within
But Within
But Within
After Ten
Taxable Equivalent Basis
One Year
Five Years
Ten Years
Years
as of March 31, 2011
Amount
Yield
Amount
Yield
Amount
Yield
Amount
Yield
 
(dollars are in millions)
Available-for-sale:
               
U.S. Treasury
$-
-%
$4,288
1.64%
$7,977
2.69%
$3,673
4.30%
U.S. Government sponsored enterprises
-
-
-
-
1,967
3.99
266
4.21
U.S. Government agency issued or guaranteed
-
-
1
4.73
211
4.80
17,300
3.90
Obligations of U.S. states and political subdivisions
-
-
-
-
272
4.25
297
4.48
Asset backed securities
-
-
88
5.36
6
1.40
1,004
2.95
Other domestic debt securities
359
2.05
216
0.56
-
-
-
-
Foreign debt securities
1,196
2.43
1,443
2.28
10
5.36
-
-
Total amortized cost
$1,555
2.34%
$6,036
1.81%
$10,443
3.02%
$22,540
3.94%
Total fair value
$1,577
 
$6,065
 
$10,248
 
$22,551
 
Held-to-maturity:
               
U.S. Government sponsored enterprises
$-
-%
$20
7.95%
$2
6.93%
$1,506
6.16%
U.S. Government agency issued or guaranteed
-
-
-
-
6
7.66
408
6.54
Obligations of U.S. states and political subdivisions
11
5.14
22
5.59
19
4.79
49
5.17
Asset backed securities
-
-
-
-
-
-
179
6.16
Foreign debt securities
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Total amortized cost
$11
5.14%
$42
6.72%
$27
5.58%
$2,142
6.21%
Total fair value
$11
 
$46
 
$26
 
$2,346
 
 
Investments in Federal Home Loan Bank ("FHLB") stock and Federal Reserve Bank ("FRB") stock of $119 million and $477 million, respectively, were included in other assets at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 

 

5.  Loans
 
Loans consisted of the following:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Commercial loans:
   
Construction and other real estate
$8,281
$8,228
Business banking and middle markets enterprises
8,054
7,945
Large corporate(1)
11,878
10,745
Other commercial
2,844
3,356
Total commercial
31,057
30,274
Consumer loans:
   
Home equity mortgages
3,678
3,820
Other residential mortgages
13,868
13,697
Private label cards
12,014
13,296
Credit cards
10,014
10,811
Other consumer
1,087
1,171
Total consumer
40,661
42,795
Total loans
$71,718
$73,069
 
 
(1)
Includes $1.2 billion of commercial loans at December 31, 2010 related to a VIE which was consolidated at December 31, 2010.
 
Deferred origination costs, excluding MasterCard and Visa annual fees net of direct lending costs, totaled $86 million and $90 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. MasterCard and Visa annual fees are netted with direct lending costs, deferred and amortized on a straight-line basis over one year. Deferred MasterCard and Visa annual fees, net of direct lending costs related to these loans totaled $24 million at both March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
At March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, we had net unamortized premium on our loans of $414 million and $436 million, respectively. We amortized $143 million and $85 million of net premiums on our loans for the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
Collateralized Funding Transactions Involving Securitization There were no financings secured by private label cards or credit card receivables at March 31, 2011. Secured financings of $30 million and $120 million at December 31, 2010 were secured by $44 million and $189 million of private label cards and credit cards, respectively.
 
Purchased Loan Portfolios In January 2009, we purchased the General Motors MasterCard receivable portfolio ("GM Portfolio") and the AFL-CIO Union Plus MasterCard/Visa receivable portfolio ("UP Portfolio") with an aggregate outstanding principal balance of $6.3 billion and $6.1 billion, respectively from HSBC Finance Corporation ("HSBC Finance"). The aggregate purchase price for the GM and UP Portfolios was $12.2 billion, which included the transfer of approximately $6.1 billion of indebtedness, resulting in a cash consideration of $6.1 billion.
 
Purchased loans for which at the time of acquisition there was evidence of deterioration in credit quality since origination and for which it was probable that all contractually required payments would not be collected and that the associated line of credit has been closed were recorded upon acquisition at an amount based upon the cash flows expected to be collected ("Purchased Credit-Impaired Loans"). The carrying amount of the Purchased Credit-Impaired Loans, net of credit loss reserves at March 31, 2011 totaled $19 million for the UP Portfolio, and is included in credit card loans. The outstanding contractual balances at March 31, 2011 for UP Portfolio were $29 million. The carrying amount of the Purchased Credit-Impaired Loans, net of credit loss reserves at December 31, 2010 totaled $23 million for the UP Portfolio and is included in credit card loans. The outstanding contractual balances at December 31, 2010 for UP Portfolio were $36 million. Credit loss reserves of $2 million and $3 million as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, were held for the Purchased Credit-Impaired Loans due to a decrease in the expected future cash flows since the acquisition. The following summarizes the change in accretable yield associated with the Purchased Credit-Impaired Loans:
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Accretable yield at beginning of period
$(8)
$(29)
Accretable yield amortized to interest income during the period
2
7
Reclassification to non-accretable difference
-
-
Accretable yield at end of period(1)
$(6)
$(22)
 
 
(1)
At March 31, 2011, the entire remaining accretable yield is related to the UP portfolio. The accretable yield related to the GM portfolio was fully amortized to interest income during the second quarter of 2010.
 
Age Analysis of Past Due Loans The following table summarizes the past due status of our loans at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010. The aging of past due amounts are determined based on the contractual delinquency status of payments under the loan. An account is generally considered to be contractually delinquent when payments have not been made in accordance with the loan terms. Delinquency status may be affected by customer account management policies and practices such as re-age or modification.
 
 
Days Past Due
     
At March 31, 2011
1 - 29 days
30 - 89 days
90+ days
Total Past Due
Current
Total Loans
 
(in millions)
Commercial loans:
           
Construction and other real estate
$27
$65
$377
$469
$7,812
$8,281
Business banking and middle market enterprises
292
134
78
504
7,550
8,054
Large corporate
269
69
74
412
11,466
11,878
Other commercial
71
43
72
186
2,658
2,844
Total commercial
659
311
601
1,571
29,486
31,057
Consumer loans:
           
HELOC and home equity mortgages
270
55
93
418
3,260
3,678
Other residential mortgages
115
459
812
1,386
12,482
13,868
Credit card receivables:
           
Private label cards
418
225
243
886
11,128
12,014
Credit cards
226
163
194
583
9,431
10,014
Other consumer
9
12
34
55
1,032
1,087
Total consumer
1,038
914
1,376
3,328
37,333
40,661
Total loans
$1,697
$1,225
$1,977
$4,899
$66,819
$71,718

 

 
 
Days Past Due
     
At December 31, 2010
1 - 29 days
30 - 89 days
90+ days
Total Past Due
Current
Total Loans
 
(in millions)
Commercial loans:
           
Construction and other real estate
$72
$200
$433
$705
$7,523
$8,228
Business banking and middle market enterprises
367
84
66
517
7,428
7,945
Large corporate
902
90
74
1,066
9,679
10,745
Other commercial
80
86
24
190
3,166
3,356
Total commercial
1,421
460
597
2,478
27,796
30,274
Consumer loans:
           
HELOC and home equity mortgages
327
83
93
503
3,317
3,820
Other residential mortgages
123
525
900
1,548
12,149
13,697
Credit card receivables:
           
Private label cards
475
260
295
1,030
12,266
13,296
Credit cards
312
212
250
774
10,037
10,811
Other consumer
12
14
34
60
1,111
1,171
Total consumer
1,249
1,094
1,572
3,915
38,880
42,795
Total loans
$2,670
$1,554
$2,169
$6,393
$66,676
$73,069
 
Nonaccrual Loans Nonaccrual loans totaled $1.9 billion and $2.0 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. Interest income that would have been recorded if such nonaccrual loans had been current and in accordance with contractual terms was approximately $26 million and $45 million for three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. Interest income that was included in finance and other interest income on these loans was approximately $1 million and $3 million for three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. For an analysis of reserves for credit losses, see Note 6, "Allowance for Credit Losses."
 
Nonaccrual loans and accruing receivables 90 days or more delinquent are summarized in the following table:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Nonaccrual loans:
   
Commercial:
   
Real Estate:
   
Construction and land loans
$70
$70
Other real estate
553
529
Business banking and middle markets enterprises
107
116
Large corporate
74
74
Other commercial
12
12
Total commercial
816
801
Consumer:
   
Residential mortgages, excluding home equity mortgages
812
900
Home equity mortgages
93
93
Total residential mortgages
905
993
Credit card receivables
-
-
Other consumer loans
9
9
Total consumer loans
914
1,002
Nonaccrual loans held for sale
169
186
Total nonaccruing loans
1,899
1,989
Accruing loans contractually past due 90 days or more:
   
Total commercial:
   
Real Estate:
   
Construction and land loans
-
-
Other real estate
48
137
Business banking and middle market enterprises
37
47
Large corporate
-
-
Other commercial
13
12
Total commercial
98
196
Consumer:
   
Private label card receivables
243
295
Credit card receivables
194
250
Other consumer
25
25
Total consumer loans
462
570
Total accruing loans contractually past due 90 days or more
560
766
Total nonperforming loans
$2,459
$2,755
 

 

Impaired Loans A loan is considered to be impaired when it is deemed probable that all principal and interest amounts due, according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement, will not be collected. Probable losses from impaired loans are quantified and recorded as a component of the overall allowance for credit losses. Commercial and consumer loans for which we have modified the loan terms as part of a troubled debt restructuring are considered to be impaired loans. Additionally, commercial loans in nonaccrual status, or that have been partially charged-off or assigned a specific allowance for credit losses are also considered impaired loans.
 
Troubled debt restructurings The following tables present information about our TDR Loans and the related credit loss reserves for TDR Loans:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
TDR Loans(1)(2):
   
Commercial loans:
   
Construction and other real estate
$294
$308
Business banking and middle market enterprises
57
64
Large corporate
-
-
Other commercial
58
57
Total commercial
409
429
Consumer loans:
   
Residential mortgages
461
402
Private label cards
208
230
Credit cards
240
250
Total consumer
909
882
Total TDR Loans(3):
$1,318
$1,311

 

 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Allowance for credit losses for TDR Loans(4):
   
Commercial loans:
   
Construction and other real estate
$24
$44
Business banking and middle market enterprises
7
8
Large corporate
-
-
Other commercial
-
1
Total commercial
31
53
Consumer loans:
   
Residential mortgages
65
53
Private label cards
72
78
Credit cards
80
88
Total consumer
217
219
Total Allowance for credit losses for TDR Loans
$248
$272
 
 
(1)
TDR Loans are considered to be impaired loans. For consumer loans, all such loans are considered impaired loans regardless of accrual status. For commercial loans, impaired loans include other loans in addition to TDRs which totaled $754 million and $698 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
   
(2)
The TDR Loan balances included in the table above reflect the current carrying amount of TDR Loans and includes all basis adjustments on the loan, such as unearned income, unamortized deferred fees and costs on originated loans and premiums or discounts on purchased loans. The following table reflects the unpaid principal balance of TDR Loans:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Commercial loans:
   
Construction and other real estate
$322
$335
Business banking and middle market enterprises
109
96
Large corporate
-
-
Other commercial
60
60
Total commercial
491
491
Consumer loans:
   
Residential mortgages
510
431
Private label cards
205
227
Credit cards
261
276
Total consumer
976
934
Total
$1,467
$1,425
 
(3)
Includes balances of $214 million and $255 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, which are classified as nonaccrual loans.
   
(4)
Included in the allowance for credit losses.
 

 

Additional information relating to TDR Loans is presented in the table below.
 
 
March 31,
2011
March 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Average balance of TDR Loans
   
Commercial loans:
   
Construction and other real estate
$301
$120
Business banking and middle market enterprises
61
18
Large corporate
-
-
Other commercial
57
61
Total commercial
419
199
Consumer loans:
   
Residential mortgages
434
194
Private label cards
219
223
Credit cards
245
116
Auto finance(1)
-
38
Total consumer
898
571
Total average balance of TDR Loans
$1,317
$770
Interest income recognized on TDR Loans
   
Commercial loans:
   
Construction and other real estate
$2
$1
Business banking and middle market enterprises
-
-
Large corporate
-
-
Other commercial
1
1
Total commercial
3
2
Consumer loans:
   
Residential mortgages
3
2
Private label cards
6
6
Credit cards
4
3
Auto finance(1)
-
1
Total consumer
13
12
Total interest income recognized on TDR Loans
$16
$14
 
 
(1)
In August 2010, we sold auto finance loans with an outstanding principal balance of $1.2 billion at date of sale, and other related assets to Santander Consumer USA ("SC USA").

 

Impaired commercial loans Impaired commercial loan statistics are summarized in the following table:
 
 
 
Amount with
Impairment
Reserves
Amount
without
Impairment
Reserves
 
 
Total Impaired
Commercial Loans(1)(2)
 
 
Impairment
Reserve
 
(in millions)
At March 31, 2011
       
Construction and other real estate
$413
$406
$819
$88
Business banking and middle market enterprises
102
64
166
28
Large corporate
72
2
74
70
Other commercial
20
84
104
5
Total
$607
$556
$1,163
$191
At December 31, 2010
       
Construction and other real estate
$378
$377
$755
$84
Business banking and middle market enterprises
113
39
152
26
Large corporate
103
2
105
72
Other commercial
26
89
115
6
Total
$620
$507
$1,127
$188
 
 
(1)
Includes impaired commercial loans which are also considered TDR Loans as follows:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Construction and other real estate
$294
$308
Business banking and middle market enterprises
57
64
Large corporate
-
-
Other commercial
58
57
Total
$409
$429
 
(2)
The impaired commercial loan balances included in the table above reflect the current carrying amount of the loan and includes all basis adjustments, such as unamortized deferred fees and costs on originated loans and any premiums or discounts. The unpaid principal balance of impaired commercial loans included in the table above are as follows:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Construction and other real estate
$848
$782
Business banking and middle market enterprises
218
184
Large corporate
74
105
Other commercial
106
118
Total
$1,246
$1,189

 

The following table presents information about average impaired commercial loan balances and interest income recognized on the impaired commercial loans:
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Average balance of impaired commercial loans:
   
Construction and other real estate
$787
$710
Business banking and middle market enterprises
159
146
Large corporate
89
339
Other commercial
110
197
Total average balance of impaired commercial loans
$1,145
$1,392
Interest income recognized on impaired commercial loans:
   
Construction and other real estate
$2
$1
Business banking and middle market enterprises
1
2
Large corporate
-
3
Other commercial
1
1
Total interest income recognized on impaired commercial loans
$4
$7
 
Commercial Loan Credit Quality Indicators The following credit quality indicators are monitored for our commercial loan portfolio:
 
Criticized asset classifications These classifications are based on the risk rating standards of our primary regulator. Problem loans are assigned various criticized facility grades. We also assign obligor grades which are used under our allowance for credit losses methodology. Criticized assets for commercial loans are summarized in the following table:
 
 
Special Mention
Substandard
Doubtful
Total
 
(in millions)
At March 31, 2011
       
Construction and other real estate
$1,499
$1,109
$158
$2,766
Business banking and middle market enterprises
402
443
16
861
Large corporate
247
379
74
700
Other commercial
131
105
9
245
Total
$2,279
$2,036
$257
$4,572
At December 31, 2010
       
Construction and other real estate
$1,324
$1,230
$115
$2,669
Business banking and middle market enterprises
465
504
5
974
Large corporate
260
386
74
720
Other commercial
235
140
8
383
Total
$2,284
$2,260
$202
$4,746
 

 

Nonperforming The status of our commercial loan portfolio is summarized in the following table:
 
 
 
Performing
Loans
 
Nonaccrual
Loans
Accruing Loans
Contractually Past
Due 90 days or More
 
 
Total
 
(in millions)
At March 31, 2011
       
Commercial:
       
Construction and other real estate
$7,610
$623
$48
$8,281
Business banking and middle market enterprise
7,910
107
37
8,054
Large corporate
11,804
74
-
11,878
Other commercial
2,819
12
13
2,844
Total commercial
$30,143
$816
$98
$31,057
At December 31, 2010
       
Commercial:
       
Construction and other real estate
$7,492
$599
$137
$8,228
Business banking and middle market enterprise
7,782
116
47
7,945
Large corporate
10,671
74
-
10,745
Other commercial
3,332
12
12
3,356
Total commercial
$29,277
$801
$196
$30,274
 
Credit risk profile The following table shows the credit risk profile of our commercial loan portfolio at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010:
 
 
Investment Grade(1)
Non-Investment Grade
Total
 
(in millions)
At March 31, 2011
     
Construction and other real estate
$2,303
$5,978
$8,281
Business banking and middle market enterprises
3,226
4,828
8,054
Large corporate
7,546
4,332
11,878
Other commercial
352
2,492
2,844
Total commercial
$13,427
$17,630
$31,057
At December 31, 2010
     
Construction and other real estate
$1,900
$6,328
$8,228
Business banking and middle market enterprises
2,866
5,079
7,945
Large corporate
6,808
3,937
10,745
Other commercial
855
2,501
3,356
Total commercial
$12,429
$17,845
$30,274
 
 
(1)
Investment grade includes commercial loans with credit ratings of at least BBB- or above or the equivalent based on our internal credit rating system.

 

Consumer Loan Credit Quality Indicators The following credit quality indicators are monitored for our consumer loan portfolio:
 
Delinquency The following table summarizes dollars of two-months-and-over contractual delinquency and as a percent of total loans and loans held for sale ("delinquency ratio") for our consumer loan portfolio:
 
 
March 31, 2011
December 31, 2010
 
Dollars of
Delinquency
Delinquency
Ratio
Dollars of
Delinquency
Delinquency
Ratio
 
(dollars are in millions)
Consumer:
       
Residential mortgage, excluding home equity mortgages
$1,164
7.96%
$1,248
8.52%
Home equity mortgages
168
4.57
182
4.76
Total residential mortgages
1,332
7.28
1,430
7.74
Private label card receivables
336
2.80
403
3.03
Credit card receivables
267
2.67
339
3.13
Other consumer
36
3.08
36
2.88
Total consumer
$1,971
4.75%
$2,208
5.04%
 
Nonperforming The status of our consumer loan portfolio is summarized in the following table:
 
 
 
Performing
Loans
 
Nonaccrual
Loans
Accruing Loans
Contractually Past
Due 90 days or More
 
 
Total
 
(in millions)
At March 31, 2011
       
Consumer:
       
Residential mortgage, excluding home equity mortgages
$13,056
$812
$-
$13,868
Home equity mortgages
3,585
93
-
3,678
Total residential mortgages
16,641
905
-
17,546
Private label card receivables
11,771
-
243
12,014
Credit card receivables
9,820
-
194
10,014
Other consumer
1,053
9
25
1,087
Total consumer
$39,285
$914
$462
$40,661
At December 31, 2010
       
Consumer:
       
Residential mortgage, excluding home equity mortgages
$12,797
$900
$-
$13,697
Home equity mortgages
3,727
93
-
3,820
Total residential mortgages
16,524
993
-
17,517
Private label card receivables
13,001
-
295
13,296
Credit card receivables
10,561
-
250
10,811
Other consumer
1,137
9
25
1,171
Total consumer
$41,223
$1,002
$570
$42,795
 

 

Troubled debt restructurings See discussion of impaired loans above for further details on this credit quality indicator.
 
Concentrations of Credit Risk Our loan portfolio includes the following types of loans:
 
 
•   High loan-to-value ("LTV") loans - Certain residential mortgages on primary residences with LTV ratios equal to or exceeding 90 percent at the time of origination and no mortgage insurance, which could result in the potential inability to recover the entire investment in loans involving foreclosed or damaged properties.
 
 
•   Interest-only loans - A loan which allows a customer to pay the interest-only portion of the monthly payment for a period of time which results in lower payments during the initial loan period. However, subsequent events affecting a customer's financial position could affect the ability of customers to repay the loan in the future when the principal payments are required.
 
 
•   Adjustable rate mortgage ("ARM") loans - A loan which allows us to adjust pricing on the loan in line with market movements. A customer's financial situation and the general interest rate environment at the time of the interest rate reset could affect the customer's ability to repay or refinance the loan after the adjustment.
 
The following table summarizes the balances of high LTV, interest-only and ARM loans in our loan portfolios, including certain loans held for sale, at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in billions)
Residential mortgage loans with high LTV and no mortgage insurance(1)
$1.2
$1.2
Interest-only residential mortgage loans
2.8
2.7
ARM loans(2)
8.1
7.8
 
 
(1)
Residential mortgage loans with high LTV and no mortgage insurance includes both fixed rate and adjustable rate mortgages. Excludes $111 million and $125 million of sub-prime residential mortgage loans held for sale at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
   
(2)
ARM loan balances above exclude $61 million and $99 million of sub-prime residential mortgage loans held for sale at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. During the remainder of 2011 and during 2012, approximately $333 million and $395 million, respectively, of these ARM loans will experience their first interest rate reset.
 
 
Concentrations of first and second liens within the outstanding residential mortgage loan portfolio are summarized in the following table. Amounts in the table exclude closed end first lien loans held for sale of $763 million and $1.0 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Closed end:
   
 First lien
$13,868
$13,697
 Second lien
408
437
Revolving:
   
 Second lien
3,270
3,383
Total
$17,546
$17,517
 
6.  Allowance for Credit Losses
 
An analysis of the allowance for credit losses is presented in the following table:
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Balance at beginning of period
$2,170
$3,861
Provision for credit losses
106
211
Charge-offs
(535)
(934)
Recoveries
90
82
Other
1
4
Balance at end of period
$1,832
$3,224
 

 
The following table summarizes the changes in the allowance for credit losses by product and the related loan balance by product during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010:
 
 
Commercial
Consumer
 
 
 
 
Construction
and Other
Real Estate
Business
Banking
and Middle
Market
Enterprises
 
 
 
Large
Corporate
 
 
 
Other
Comm'l
Residential
Mortgage,
Excl Home
Equity
Mortgages
 
 
Home
Equity
Mortgages
 
 
Private
Label
Card
 
 
 
Credit
Card
 
 
 
Auto
Finance
 
 
 
Other
Consumer
 
 
 
 
Total
 
(in millions)
Three Months Ended March 31, 2011:
                     
Allowance for credit losses - beginning of period
$243
$132
$116
$45
$167
$77
$752
$606
$-
$32
$2,170
Provision charged to income
(28)
(2)
(5)
(6)
21
10
51
61
-
4
106
Charge offs
(4)
(13)
-
(5)
(26)
(20)
(225)
(229)
-
(13)
(535)
Recoveries
6
2
-
1
1
-
46
31
-
3
90
Net charge offs
2
(11)
-
(4)
(25)
(20)
(179)
(198)
-
(10)
(445)
Other
-
-
-
 
-
-
-
1
-
-
1
Allowance for credit losses - end of period
$217
$119
$111
$35
$163
$67
$624
$470
$-
$26
$1,832
Ending balance: collectively evaluated for impairment
$129
$91
$41
$30
$102
$63
$552
$388
$-
$26
$1,422
Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment
88
28
70
5
61
4
72
80
-
-
408
Ending balance: loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
2
-
-
2
Total allowance for credit losses
$217
$119
$111
$35
$163
$67
$624
$470
$-
$26
$1,832
Loans:
                     
Collectively evaluated for impairment
$7,462
$7,888
$11,804
$2,740
$12,668
$3,669
$11,806
$9,753
$-
$1,087
$68,877
Individually evaluated for impairment(1)
819
166
74
104
452
9
208
240
-
-
2,072
Loans carried at net realizable value
-
-
-
-
748
-
-
-
-
-
748
Loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
21
-
-
21
Total loans
$8,281
$8,054
$11,878
$2,844
$13,868
$3,678
$12,014
$10,014
$-
$1,087
$71,718
Three Months Ended March 31, 2010:
                     
Allowance for credit losses - beginning of period
$303
$184
$301
$150
$347
$185
$1,184
$1,106
$36
$65
$3,861
Provision charged to income
2
3
(77)
(1)
(19)
(21)
109
190
25
-
211
Charge offs
(16)
(28)
(4)
(61)
(49)
(36)
(335)
(360)
(24)
(21)
(934)
Recoveries
3
6
-
1
1
-
42
25
-
4
82
Net charge offs
(13)
(22)
(4)
(60)
(48)
(36)
(293)
(335)
(24)
(17)
(852)
Other
-
-
-
1
-
-
-
3
-
-
4
Allowance for credit losses - end of period
$292
$165
$220
$90
$280
$128
$1,000
$964
$37
$48
$3,224
Ending balance: collectively evaluated for impairment
$187
$141
$85
$49
$231
$125
$944
$921
$25
$48
$2,756
Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment(1)
105
24
135
41
49
3
56
32
12
-
457
Ending balance: loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
11
-
-
11
Total allowance for credit losses
$292
$165
$220
$90
$280
$128
$1,000
$964
$37
$48
$3,224
Loans:
                     
Collectively evaluated for impairment
$8,071
$6,852
$10,600
$2,863
$12,666
$4,039
$13,236
$11,574
$1,409
$1,371
$72,681
Individually evaluated for impairment
723
147
233
148
222
7
230
130
44
-
1,884
Loans carried at net realizable value
-
-
-
-
624
-
-
-
-
-
624
Loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
109
-
-
109
Total loans
$8,794
$6,999
$10,833
$3,011
$13,512
$4,046
$13,466
$11,813
$1,453
$1,371
$75,298
 
 
(1)
For consumer loans, these amounts represent TDR Loans for which we evaluate reserves using a discounted cash flow methodology. Each loan is individually identified as a TDR Loan and then grouped together with other TDR Loans with similar characteristics. The discounted cash flow analysis is then applied to these groups of TDR Loans.
 

 

7.  Loans Held for Sale
 
Loans held for sale consisted of the following:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Commercial loans
$845
$1,356
Consumer loans:
   
 Residential mortgages
763
954
 Other consumer
80
80
Total consumer
843
1,034
Total loans held for sale
$1,688
$2,390
 
We originate and syndicate commercial loans in connection with our participation in a number of leveraged acquisition finance transactions. A substantial majority of these loans are originated with the intent of selling them to unaffiliated third parties and are classified as commercial loans held for sale at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010. The fair value of commercial loans held for sale under this program was $542 million and $1.0 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, all of which are recorded at fair value as we have elected to designate these loans under fair value option. We also have provided foreign currency denominated loans to third parties which are classified as commercial loans held for sale and for which we also elected to apply fair value option. The fair value of these commercial loans under this program was $271 million and $273 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. See Note 11, "Fair Value Option," for additional information.
 
Residential mortgage loans held for sale include sub-prime residential mortgage loans with a fair value of $304 million and $391 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, which were acquired from unaffiliated third parties and from HSBC Finance with the intent of securitizing or selling the loans to third parties. Also included in residential mortgage loans held for sale are first mortgage loans originated and held for sale primarily to various government sponsored enterprises.
 
Other consumer loans held for sale consist of student loans.
 
Excluding the commercial loans designated under fair value option discussed above, loans held for sale are recorded at the lower of cost or fair value. While the initial book value of loans held for sale continued to exceed fair value at March 31, 2011, we experienced a decrease in the valuation allowance during 2011 due primarily to loan sales. The valuation allowance on loans held for sale was $377 million and $435 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
 
Loans held for sale are subject to market risk, liquidity risk and interest rate risk, in that their value will fluctuate as a result of changes in market conditions, as well as the interest rate and credit environment. Interest rate risk for residential mortgage loans held for sale is partially mitigated through an economic hedging program to offset changes in the fair value of the mortgage loans held for sale. Trading related revenue associated with this economic hedging program, which is included in net interest income and residential mortgage banking revenue (loss) in the consolidated statement of income, were losses of $12 million and $6 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 

8.  Intangible Assets
 
Intangible assets consisted of the following:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Mortgage servicing rights
$404
$403
Other
21
21
Intangible assets
$425
$424
 
Mortgage Servicing Rights ("MSRs") A servicing asset is a contract under which estimated future revenues from contractually specified cash flows, such as servicing fees and other ancillary revenues, are expected to exceed the obligation to service the financial assets. We recognize the right to service mortgage loans as a separate and distinct asset at the time they are acquired or when originated loans are sold.
 
MSRs are subject to credit, prepayment and interest rate risk, in that their value will fluctuate as a result of changes in these economic variables. Interest rate risk is mitigated through an economic hedging program that uses securities and derivatives to offset changes in the fair value of MSRs. Since the hedging program involves trading activity, risk is quantified and managed using a number of risk assessment techniques, which are addressed in more detail in the 2010 Form 10-K.
 
Residential mortgage servicing rights Residential MSRs are initially measured at fair value at the time that the related loans are sold and are remeasured at fair value at each reporting date (the fair value measurement method). Changes in fair value of the asset are reflected in residential mortgage banking revenue in the period in which the changes occur. Fair value is determined based upon the application of valuation models and other inputs. The valuation models incorporate assumptions market participants would use in estimating future cash flows, including current costs of servicing. The reasonableness of these valuation models is periodically validated by reference to external independent broker valuations and industry surveys.
 
Fair value of residential MSRs is calculated using the following critical assumptions:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
Annualized constant prepayment rate ("CPR")
13.5%
14.1%
Constant discount rate
13.8%
13.6%
Weighted average life
5.1 years
4.9 years
 
Residential MSRs activity is summarized in the following table:
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Fair value of MSRs:
   
Beginning balance
$394
$450
Additions related to loan sales
16
16
Changes in fair value due to:
   
Change in valuation inputs or assumptions used in the valuation models
5
5
Realization of cash flows
(19)
(27)
Ending balance
$396
$444
 
 

Information regarding residential mortgage loans serviced for others, which are not included in the consolidated balance sheet, is summarized in the following table:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Outstanding principal balances at period end
$43,579
$44,407
Custodial balances maintained and included in noninterest bearing deposits at period end
$725
$960
 
Servicing fees collected are included in residential mortgage banking revenue and totaled $28 million and $32 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
Commercial Mortgage Servicing Rights Commercial MSRs, which are accounted for using the lower of cost or fair value method, totaled $8 million and $9 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
Other Intangible Assets Other intangible assets, which result from purchase business combinations, are comprised of favorable lease arrangements of $15 million and $16 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, and customer lists in the amount of $6 million and $5 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
 
9.  Goodwill
 
Goodwill was $2.6 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, and includes accumulated impairment losses of $54 million.
 
10.  Derivative Financial Instruments
 
In the normal course of business, we enter into derivative contracts for trading, market making and risk management purposes. For financial reporting purposes, a derivative instrument is designated in one of the following categories: (a) financial instruments held for trading, (b) hedging instruments designated as a qualifying hedge under derivative accounting principles or (c) a non-qualifying economic hedge. The derivative instruments held are predominantly swaps, futures, options and forward contracts. All freestanding derivatives, including bifurcated embedded derivatives, are stated at fair value. Where we enter into enforceable master netting arrangements with counterparties, the master netting arrangements permit us to net those derivative asset and liability positions and to offset cash collateral held and posted with the same counterparty.
 
Derivatives Held for Risk Management Purposes Our risk management policy requires us to identify, analyze and manage risks arising from the activities conducted during the normal course of business. We use derivative instruments as an asset and liability management tool to manage our exposures in interest rate, foreign currency and credit risks in existing assets and liabilities, commitments and forecasted transactions. The accounting for changes in fair value of a derivative instrument will depend on whether the derivative has been designated and qualifies for hedge accounting under derivative accounting principles.
 
Accounting principles for qualifying hedges require detailed documentation that describes the relationship between the hedging instrument and the hedged item, including, but not limited to, the risk management objectives and hedging strategy and the methods to assess the effectiveness of the hedging relationship. We designate derivative instruments to offset the fair value risk and cash flow risk arising from fixed-rate and floating-rate assets and liabilities as well as forecasted transactions. We assess the hedging relationships, both at the inception of the hedge and on an ongoing basis, using a regression approach to determine whether the designated hedging instrument is highly effective in offsetting changes in the fair value or cash flows of the hedged item. We discontinue hedge accounting when we determine that a derivative is not expected to be effective going forward or has ceased to be highly effective as a hedge, the hedging instrument is terminated, or when the designation is removed by us.
 

In the tables that follow below, the fair value disclosed does not include swap collateral that we either receive or deposit with our interest rate swap counterparties. Such swap collateral is recorded on our balance sheet at an amount which approximates fair value and is netted on the balance sheet with the fair value amount recognized for derivative instruments.
 
Fair Value Hedges In the normal course of business, we hold fixed-rate loans and securities and issue fixed-rate senior and subordinated debt obligations. The fair value of fixed-rate (USD and non-USD denominated) assets and liabilities fluctuates in response to changes in interest rates or foreign currency exchange rates. We utilize interest rate swaps, interest rate forward and futures contracts and foreign currency swaps to minimize the effect on earnings caused by interest rate and foreign currency volatility.
 
For reporting purposes, changes in fair value of a derivative designated in a qualifying fair value hedge, along with the changes in the fair value of the hedged asset or liability that is attributable to the hedged risk, are recorded in current period earnings. We recognized net gains of $10 million and $5 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, which are reported in other income in the consolidated statement of income which represents the ineffective portion of all fair value hedges. The interest accrual related to the derivative contract is recognized in interest income.
 
The changes in fair value of the hedged item designated in a qualifying hedge are captured as an adjustment to the carrying value of the hedged item (basis adjustment). If the hedging relationship is terminated and the hedged item continues to exist, the basis adjustment is amortized over the remaining life of the hedged item. We recorded basis adjustments for active fair value hedges which decreased the carrying value of our debt by $40 million and increased the carrying value of our debt by $27 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. We amortized $3 million and $2 million of basis adjustments related to terminated and/or re-designated fair value hedge relationships during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. The total accumulated unamortized basis adjustment amounted to an increase in the carrying value of our debt of $64 million and $73 million as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. Basis adjustments for active fair value hedges of available-for-sale securities decreased the carrying value of the securities by $36 million and increased the carrying value of the securities by $23 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. Total accumulated unamortized basis adjustments amounted to a decrease in carrying value of $31 million and an increase in carrying value of $71 million as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
 
The following table presents the fair value of derivative instruments that are designated and qualifying as fair value hedges and their location on the balance sheet.
 
 
Derivative Assets(1)
Derivative Liabilities(1)
   
Fair Value as of
 
Fair Value as of
 
Balance Sheet
Location
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
Balance Sheet
Location
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Interest rate contracts
Other assets
    $146
$140
Interest, taxes & other liabilities
$114
$164
 
 
(1)
The derivative asset and derivative liabilities presented above may be eligible for netting and consequently may be shown net against a different line item on the consolidated balance sheet. Balance sheet categories in the above table represent the location of the assets and liabilities absent the netting of the balances.
 

 

The following table presents the gains and losses on derivative instruments designated and qualifying as hedging instruments in fair value hedges and their locations on the consolidated statement of income.
 
   
Amount of Gain
   
(Loss)
   
Recognized
 
Location of Gain (Loss)
in Income on
 
Recognized in Income on
Derivatives
Three Months Ended March 31,
Derivatives
2011
2010
   
(in millions)
Interest rate contracts
Other income
$45
$(13)
Interest rate contracts
Interest income
(3)
18
Total
 
$42
$5
 
The following table presents information on gains and losses on the hedged items in fair value hedges and their location on the consolidated statement of income.
 
 
Gain (Loss) on
Derivative
Gain (Loss) on
Hedged Items
Gain (Loss) on
Derivative
Gain (Loss) on
Hedged Items
 
Interest
Income
(Expense)
 
Other
Income
Interest
Income
(Expense)
 
Other
Income
Interest
Income
(Expense)
 
Other
Income
Interest
Income
(Expense)
 
Other
Income
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Interest rate contracts/AFS securities
$(9)
$52
$132
$(47)
$(2)
$(39)
$43
$38
Interest rate contracts/commercial loans
(5)
-
-
(1)
-
-
1
(1)
Interest rate contracts/subordinated debt
11
(7)
(18)
13
20
26
(40)
(19)
Total
$(3)
$45
$114
$(35)
$18
$(13)
$4
$18
 
Cash Flow Hedges We own or issue floating rate financial instruments and enter into forecasted transactions that give rise to variability in future cash flows. As a part of our risk management strategy, we use interest rate swaps, currency swaps and futures contracts to mitigate risk associated with variability in the cash flows. We also hedge the variability in interest cash flows arising from on-line savings deposits.
 
Changes in fair value associated with the effective portion of a derivative instrument designated as a qualifying cash flow hedge are recognized initially in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss). When the cash flows for which the derivative is hedging materialize and are recorded in income or expense, the associated gain or loss from the hedging derivative previously recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) is recognized in earnings. If a cash flow hedge of a forecasted transaction is de-designated because it is no longer highly effective, or if the hedge relationship is terminated, the cumulative gain or loss on the hedging derivative will continue to be reported in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) unless the hedged forecasted transaction is no longer expected to occur, at which time the cumulative gain or loss is released into earnings. As of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, active cash flow hedge relationships extend or mature through February 2031 and December 2012, respectively. During the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, $2 million and $3 million, respectively, of losses related to terminated and/or re-designated cash flow hedge relationships were amortized to earnings from accumulated other comprehensive income (loss). During the next twelve months, we expect to amortize $8 million of remaining losses to earnings resulting from these terminated and/or re-designated cash flow hedges. The interest accrual related to the derivative contract is recognized in interest income.
 

 

The following table presents the fair value of derivative instruments that are designated and qualifying as cash flow hedges and their location on the consolidated balance sheet.
 
 
Derivative Assets(1)
Derivative Liabilities(1)
   
Fair Value as of
 
Fair Value as of
 
Balance Sheet
Location
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
Balance Sheet
Location
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Interest rate contracts
Other assets
$-
$-
Interest, taxes & other liabilities
$27
$18
 
 
(1)
The derivative assets and derivative liabilities presented above may be eligible for netting and consequently may be shown net against a different line item on the consolidated balance sheet. Balance sheet categories in the above table represent the location of the assets and liabilities absent the netting of the balances.
 
The following table presents information on gains and losses on derivative instruments designated and qualifying as hedging instruments in cash flow hedges and their locations on the income statement.
 
         
Gain (Loss)
         
Recognized
       
Location of Gain
in Income
 
Gain (Loss)
 
Gain (Loss)
(Loss)
on the
 
Recognized
 
Reclassified
Recognized
Derivative
 
in AOCL on
Location of Gain
From AOCL
in Income
(Ineffective
 
Derivative
(Loss) Reclassified
into Income
on the Derivative
Portion and Amount
 
(Effective
from AOCL
(Effective
(Ineffective Portion and
Excluded from
 
Portion)
into Income (Effective
Portion)
Amount Excluded from
Effectiveness Testing)
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
Portion)
2011
2010
Effectiveness Testing)
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Interest rate contracts
    $(8)
     $7
Other income
    $(2)
    $(3)
Other income
     $-
     $-
 
Trading and Other Derivatives In addition to risk management, we enter into derivative instruments for trading and market making purposes, to repackage risks and structure trades to facilitate clients' needs for various risk taking and risk modification purposes. We manage our risk exposure by entering into offsetting derivatives with other financial institutions to mitigate the market risks, in part or in full, arising from our trading activities with our clients. In addition, we also enter into buy protection credit derivatives with other market participants to manage our counterparty credit risk exposure. Where we enter into derivatives for trading purposes, realized and unrealized gains and losses are recognized as trading revenue. Credit losses arising from counterparty risk on over-the-counter derivative instruments and offsetting buy protection credit derivative positions are recognized as an adjustment to the fair value of the derivatives and are recorded in trading revenue.
 
Derivative instruments designated as economic hedges that do not qualify for hedge accounting are recorded at fair value through profit and loss. Realized and unrealized gains and losses are recognized in other income while the derivative asset or liability positions are reflected as other assets or other liabilities. As of March 31, 2011, we have entered into credit default swaps which are designated as economic hedges against the credit risks within our loan portfolio. In the event of an impairment loss occurring in a loan that is economically hedged, the impairment loss is recognized as provision for credit losses while the gain on the credit default swap is recorded as other income (expense). In addition, we also from time to time have designated certain forward purchase or sale of to-be-announced ("TBA") securities to economically hedge mortgage servicing rights. Changes in the fair value of TBA positions, which are considered derivatives, are recorded in residential mortgage banking revenue.
 

 

The following table presents the fair value of derivative instruments held for trading purposes and their location on the consolidated balance sheet.
 
 
Derivative Assets(1)
Derivative Liabilities(1)
   
Fair Value as of
 
Fair Value as of
 
Balance Sheet
Location
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
Balance Sheet
Location
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Interest rate contracts
Trading assets
$27,564
$32,047
Trading liabilities
$28,216
$32,526
Foreign exchange contracts
Trading assets
17,249
16,367
Trading liabilities
17,523
16,742
Equity contracts
Trading assets
961
950
Trading liabilities
989
986
Precious Metals contracts
Trading assets
887
1,004
Trading liabilities
1,738
2,073
Credit contracts
Trading assets
11,676
12,766
Trading liabilities
11,380
12,506
Other
Trading assets
1
4
Trading liabilities
1
23
Total
 
$58,338
$63,138
 
$59,847
$64,856
 
 
(1)
The derivative assets and derivative liabilities presented above may be eligible for netting and consequently may be shown net against a different line item on the consolidated balance sheet. Balance sheet categories in the above table represent the location of the assets and liabilities absent the netting of the balances.
 
The following table presents the fair value of derivative instruments held for other purposes and their location on the balance sheet.
 
 
Derivative Assets(1)
Derivative Liabilities(1)
   
Fair Value as of
 
Fair Value as of
 
Balance Sheet
Location
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
Balance Sheet
Location
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Interest rate contracts
Other assets
$370
$420
Interest, taxes & other liabilities
$93
$82
Foreign exchange contracts
Other assets
75
96
Interest, taxes & other liabilities
6
4
Equity contracts
Other assets
153
221
Interest, taxes & other liabilities
5
10
Credit contracts
Other assets
2
2
Interest, taxes & other liabilities
16
17
Total
 
$600
$739
 
$120
$113
 
 
(1)
The derivative assets and derivative liabilities presented above may be eligible for netting and consequently may be shown net against a different line item on the consolidated balance sheet. Balance sheet categories in the above table represent the location of the assets and liabilities absent the netting of the balances.
 

 

The following table presents information on gains and losses on derivative instruments held for trading purposes and their locations on the statement of income.
 
   
Amount of Gain
   
(Loss)
   
Recognized in
   
Income on
   
Derivatives
 
Location of Gain (Loss)
Three Months
 
Recognized in Income on
Ended March 31,
 
Derivatives
2011
2010
   
(in millions)
Interest rate contracts
Trading revenue
$26
$(53)
Foreign exchange contracts
Trading revenue
175
(108)
Equity contracts
Trading revenue
1
14
Precious Metals contracts
Trading revenue
(31)
165
Credit contracts
Trading revenue
(12)
(33)
Other
Trading revenue
9
21
Total
 
$168
$6
 
The following table presents information on gains and losses on derivative instruments held for other purposes and their locations on the statement of income.
 
   
Amount of Gain (Loss)
   
Recognized in
   
Income on Derivatives
 
Location of Gain (Loss)
Three Months
 
Recognized in Income
Ended March 31,
 
on Derivatives
2011
2010
   
(in millions)
Interest rate contracts
Other income
$(6)
$57
Foreign exchange contracts
Other income
(24)
(10)
Equity contracts
Other income
102
142
Credit contracts
Other income
(2)
(9)
Other
Other income
-
-
Total
 
$70
$180
 
Credit-Risk Related Contingent Features We enter into total return swap, interest rate swap, cross-currency swap and credit default swap contracts, amongst others which contain provisions that require us to maintain a specific credit rating from each of the major credit rating agencies. Sometimes the derivative instrument transactions are a part of broader structured product transactions. If HSBC Bank USA's credit ratings were to fall below the current ratings, the counterparties to our derivative instruments could demand additional collateral to be posted with them. The amount of additional collateral required to be posted will depend on whether HSBC Bank USA is downgraded by one or more notches as well as whether the downgrade is in relation to long-term or short-term ratings. The aggregate fair value of all derivative instruments with credit-risk-related contingent features that are in a liability position as of March 31, 2011, is $4.6 billion for which we have posted collateral of $7.2 billion. The aggregate fair value of all derivative instruments with credit-risk-related contingent features that are in a liability position as of December 31, 2010, is $5.1 billion for which we have posted collateral of $7.3 billion. Substantially all of the collateral posted is in the form of cash which is reflected in either interest bearing deposits with banks or other assets. See Note 18, "Guarantee Arrangements and Pledged Assets," for further details.
 
In the event of a credit downgrade, we do not expect HSBC Bank USA's long-term ratings to go below A2 and A+ or the short-term ratings to go below P-2 and A-1 by Moody's and S&P, respectively. The following tables summarize
our obligation to post additional collateral (from the current collateral level) in certain hypothetical commercially reasonable downgrade scenarios. It is not appropriate to accumulate or extrapolate information presented in the table below to determine our total obligation because the information presented to determine the obligation in hypothetical rating scenarios is not mutually exclusive.
 
Moody's
Long-Term Ratings
Short-Term Ratings
Aa3
A1
A2
 
(in millions)
P-1
$-
$6
$69
P-2
57
59
117
 
S&P
Long-Term Ratings
Short-Term Ratings
AA
AA-
A+
 
(in millions)
A-1+
$-
$175
$178
A-1
79
255
257
 
We would be required to post $86 million of additional collateral on total return swaps and certain other transactions if HSBC Bank USA is downgraded by S&P and Moody's by two notches on our long term rating accompanied by one notch downgrade in our short term rating.
 
Notional Value of Derivative Contracts The following table summarizes the notional values of derivative contracts.
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in billions)
Interest rate:
   
Futures and forwards
$224.8
$356.9
Swaps
1,795.4
1,773.0
Options written
59.8
62.9
Options purchased
61.6
63.9
 
2,141.6
2,256.7
Foreign Exchange:
   
Swaps, futures and forwards
724.4
603.3
Options written
29.5
22.0
Options purchased
30.3
22.3
Spot
94.6
56.5
 
878.8
704.1
Commodities, equities and precious metals:
   
Swaps, futures and forwards
35.0
36.1
Options written
8.6
9.1
Options purchased
16.2
16.4
 
59.8
61.6
Credit derivatives
714.4
701.0
Total
$3,794.6
$3,723.4
 

 

11.  Fair Value Option
 
We report our results to HSBC in accordance with its reporting basis, International Financial Reporting Standards ("IFRSs"). We have elected to apply fair value option accounting to selected financial instruments in most cases to align the measurement attributes of those instruments under U.S. GAAP and IFRSs and to simplify the accounting model applied to those financial instruments. We elected to apply fair value option ("FVO") reporting to certain commercial loans including commercial leveraged acquisition finance loans and related unfunded commitments, certain fixed rate long-term debt issuances and hybrid instruments which include all structured notes and structured deposits. Changes in fair value for these assets and liabilities are reported as gain (loss) on instruments designated at fair value and related derivatives in the consolidated statement of income.
 
Loans We elected to apply FVO to all commercial leveraged acquisition finance loans held for sale and related unfunded commitments. The election allows us to account for these loans and commitments at fair value which is consistent with the manner in which the instruments are managed. As of March 31, 2011, commercial leveraged acquisition finance loans held for sale and related unfunded commitments of $542 million carried at fair value had an aggregate unpaid principal balance of $567 million. As of December 31, 2010, commercial leveraged acquisition finance loans held for sale and related unfunded commitments of $1.0 billion carried at fair value had an aggregate unpaid principal balance of $1.1 billion.
 
We provided foreign currency denominated loans to a third party for which we simultaneously entered into a series of derivative transactions to hedge certain risks associated with these loans. We elected to apply fair value option to these loans which allows us to account for them in a manner which is consistent with how the instruments are managed. At March 31, 2011, these commercial foreign currency denominated loans for which we elected fair value option had a fair value of $271 million and an unpaid principal balance of $270 million. At December 31, 2010, these commercial foreign currency denominated loans for which we elected fair value option had a fair value of $273 million and an unpaid principal balance of $270 million.
 
These loans are included in loans held for sale in the consolidated balance sheet. Interest from these loans is recorded as interest income in the consolidated statement of income. Because a substantial majority of the loans elected for the fair value option are floating rate assets, changes in their fair value are primarily attributable to changes in loan-specific credit risk factors. The components of gain (loss) related to loans designated at fair value are summarized in the table below. As of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, no loans for which the fair value option has been elected are 90 days or more past due or on nonaccrual status.
 
Long-Term Debt (Own Debt Issuances) We elected to apply FVO for certain fixed-rate long-term debt for which we had applied or otherwise would elect to apply fair value hedge accounting. The election allows us to achieve a similar accounting effect without meeting the rigorous hedge accounting requirements. We measure the fair value of these debt issuances based on inputs observed in the secondary market. Changes in fair value of these instruments are attributable to changes of our own credit risk and interest rates.
 
Fixed-rate debt accounted for under FVO at March 31, 2011 totaled $1.7 billion and had an aggregate unpaid principal balance of $1.8 billion. Fixed-rate debt accounted for under FVO at December 31, 2010 totaled $1.7 billion and had an aggregate unpaid principal balance of $1.8 billion. Interest on the fixed-rate debt accounted for under FVO is recorded as interest expense in the consolidated statement of income. The components of gain (loss) related to long-term debt designated at fair value are summarized in the table below.
 
Hybrid Instruments We elected to apply fair value option accounting principles to all of our hybrid instruments, inclusive of structured notes and structured deposits, issued after January 1, 2006. As of March 31, 2011, interest bearing deposits in domestic offices included $8.3 billion of structured deposits accounted for under FVO which had an unpaid principal balance of $8.3 billion. As of December 31, 2010, interest bearing deposits in domestic offices included $7.4 billion of structured deposits accounted for under FVO which had an unpaid principal balance of $7.4 billion. Long-term debt at March 31, 2011 included structured notes of $3.7 billion accounted for under FVO which had an unpaid principal balance of $3.5 billion. Long-term debt at December 31, 2010 included structured notes of $3.7 billion accounted for under FVO which had an unpaid principal balance of $3.4 billion. Interest on this
debt is recorded as interest expense in the consolidated statement of income. The components of gain (loss) related to hybrid instruments designated at fair value which reflect the instruments described above are summarized in the table below
 
Components of Gain on Instruments at Fair Value and Related Derivatives Gain (loss) on instruments designated at fair value and related derivatives includes the changes in fair value related to both interest and credit risk as well as the mark-to-market adjustment on derivatives related to the debt designated at fair value and net realized gains or losses on these derivatives. The components of gain (loss) on instruments designated at fair value and related derivatives related to the changes in fair value of fixed rate debt accounted for under FVO are as follows:
 
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
2011
2010
 
 
 
Loans
Long-
Term
Debt
 
Hybrid
Instruments
 
 
Total
 
 
Loans
Long-
Term
Debt
 
Hybrid
Instruments
 
 
Total
 
(in millions)
Interest rate component
$(1)
$36
$(119)
$(84)
$1
$(9)
$(174)
$(182)
Credit risk component
31
(29)
15
17
(6)
11
23
28
Total mark-to-market on financial instruments designated at fair value
30
7
(104)
(67)
(5)
2
(151)
(154)
Net realized gains on the financial instrument
4
-
-
4
-
-
-
-
Mark-to-market on the related derivatives
-
(39)
106
67
5
10
164
179
Net realized gain (losses) on the related long-term debt derivatives
-
17
-
17
-
21
-
21
Gain (loss) on instruments designated at fair value and related derivatives
$34
$(15)
$2
$21
$-
$33
$13
$46
 
12.  Income Taxes
 
The following table presents our effective tax rates.
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(dollars are in millions)
Tax expense (benefit) at the U.S. federal statutory income tax rate
$197
35.0%
$300
35.0%
Increase (decrease) in rate resulting from:
       
State and local taxes, net of federal benefit
21
3.6
4
.5
Adjustment of tax rate used to value deferred taxes
26
4.7
(1)
(.2)
Valuation allowance on deferred tax assets
(135)
(24.1)
13
1.5
Tax exempt interest income
(3)
(.5)
(1)
(.1)
Low income housing and other tax credits
(21)
(3.8)
(22)
(2.5)
Uncertain tax provision
-
-
22
2.5
Other
(3)
(.4)
(1)
(.1)
Effective tax rate
$82
14.5%
$314
36.6%
 
The effective tax rate for the three months ended March 31, 2011 was primarily impacted by a release of valuation allowance previously established on foreign tax credits, utilization of low income housing tax credits, state taxes and the change in state tax rates used to value deferred taxes. The effective tax rate for the three months ended March 31, 2010 reflects a substantially higher level of pre-tax income, an increased level of low income housing tax credits and an adjustment of uncertain tax positions.
 

 

HSBC North America Consolidated Income Taxes We are included in HSBC North America's consolidated Federal income tax return and in various combined state income tax returns. As such, we have entered into a tax allocation agreement with HSBC North America and its subsidiary entities ("the HNAH Group") included in the consolidated returns which govern the current amount of taxes to be paid or received by the various entities included in the consolidated return filings. As a result, we have looked at the HNAH Group's consolidated deferred tax assets and various sources of taxable income, including the impact of HSBC and HNAH Group tax planning strategies, in reaching conclusions on recoverability of deferred tax assets. Where a valuation allowance is determined to be necessary at the HSBC North America consolidated level, such allowance is allocated to principal subsidiaries within the HNAH Group as described below in a manner that is systematic, rational and consistent with the broad principles of accounting for income taxes.
 
The HNAH Group evaluates deferred tax assets for recoverability using a consistent approach which considers the relative impact of negative and positive evidence, including historical financial performance, projections of future taxable income, future reversals of existing taxable temporary differences, tax planning strategies and any available carryback capacity.
 
In evaluating the need for a valuation allowance, the HNAH Group estimates future taxable income based on management approved business plans, future capital requirements and ongoing tax planning strategies, including capital support from HSBC necessary as part of such plans and strategies. The HNAH Group has continued to consider the impact of the economic environment on the North American businesses and the expected growth of the deferred tax assets. This evaluation process involves significant management judgment about assumptions that are subject to change from period to period.
 
In conjunction with the HNAH Group deferred tax evaluation process, based on our forecasts of future taxable income, which include assumptions about the depth and severity of home price depreciation and the U.S. economic environment, including unemployment levels and their related impact on credit losses, we currently anticipate that our results of future operations will generate sufficient taxable income to allow us to realize our deferred tax assets. However, since these market conditions have created losses in the HNAH Group in recent periods and volatility on our pre-tax book income, our analysis of the realizability of the deferred tax assets significantly discounts any future taxable income expected from continuing operations and relies to a greater extent on continued capital support from our parent, HSBC, including tax planning strategies implemented in relation to such support. HSBC has indicated they remain fully committed and have the capacity and willingness to provide capital as needed to run operations, maintain sufficient regulatory capital, and fund certain tax planning strategies.
 
Only those tax planning strategies that are both prudent and feasible, and which management has the ability and intent to implement, are incorporated into our analysis and assessment. The primary and most significant strategy is HSBC's commitment to reinvest excess HNAH Group capital to reduce debt funding or otherwise invest in assets to ensure that it is more likely than not that the deferred tax assets will be utilized.
 
Currently, it has been determined that the HNAH Group's primary tax planning strategy, in combination with other tax planning strategies, provides support for the realization of the net deferred tax assets recorded for the HNAH Group. Such determination is based on HSBC's business forecasts and assessment as to the most efficient and effective deployment of HSBC capital, most importantly including the length of time such capital will need to be maintained in the U.S. for purposes of the tax planning strategy.
 
During the first quarter of 2011, the HNAH Group identified an additional tax planning strategy that provides support for the realization of the deferred tax assets recorded on its foreign tax credits and certain state related deferred tax assets. The use of foreign tax credits is limited by the HNAH Group's U.S. tax liability and the availability of foreign source income. The tax planning strategy includes the purchase of foreign bonds and REMIC residual interests. These purchases are expected to generate sufficient taxable foreign source income that will allow for the utilization of the foreign tax credits before the credits expire and recognition of certain state deferred tax assets.
 
Notwithstanding the above, the HNAH Group has valuation allowances against certain state tax loss carryforwards for which the aforementioned tax planning strategies do not provide appropriate support.

 
HNAH Group valuation allowances are allocated to the principal subsidiaries, including us. The methodology allocates the valuation allowance to the principal subsidiaries based primarily on the entity's relative contribution to the growth of the HSBC North America consolidated deferred tax asset against which the valuation allowance is being recorded.
 
If future results differ from the HNAH Group's current forecasts or the tax planning strategies were to change, a valuation allowance against some or all of the remaining net deferred tax assets may need to be established which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations, financial condition and capital position. The HNAH Group will continue to update its assumptions and forecasts of future taxable income, including relevant tax planning strategies, and assess the need for such incremental valuation allowances.
 
Absent the capital support from HSBC and implementation of the related tax planning strategies, the HNAH Group, including us, would be required to record a valuation allowance against the remaining deferred tax assets.
 
HSBC USA Inc. Income Taxes We recognize deferred tax assets and liabilities for the future tax consequences related to the differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases, and for tax credits and state net operating losses. Our net deferred tax assets, net of both deferred tax liabilities and valuation allowances, totaled $1.3 billion and $1.2 billion as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
 
The Internal Revenue Service began its audit of our 2006 and 2007 income tax returns in 2009, with an anticipated completion in 2011. We are currently under audit by various state and local tax jurisdictions. Uncertain tax positions are reviewed on an ongoing basis and are adjusted in light of changing facts and circumstances, including progress of tax audits, developments in case law and the closing of statute of limitations. Such adjustments are reflected in the tax provision. As a result of a recent state court decision in April 2011, we no longer believe that we can uphold the more likely than not conclusion taken on one of these uncertain tax positions. Therefore, tax reserves of approximately $123 million and related accrued interest expense of $63 million will be recorded in the second quarter of 2011 as required by U.S. GAAP to recognize the estimated tax exposure on this matter.
 
13.  Pensions and Other Postretirement Benefits
 
The components of pension expense for the defined benefit pension plan reflected in our consolidated statement of income are shown in the table below and reflect the portion of the pension expense of the combined HSBC North America Pension Plan (either the HSBC North America Pension Plan" or the "Plan") which has been allocated to HSBC USA Inc.:
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Service cost - benefits earned during the period
 $4
  $5
Interest cost on projected benefit obligation
 18
  17
Expected return on assets
(20)
(15)
Recognized losses
 10
   9
Amortization of prior service cost
(1)
(1)
Net periodic pension cost
$11
$15
 
Pension expense declined in 2011 due to higher returns on plan assets due to higher asset levels including additional contributions to the plan as well as lower service cost and interest cost as a result of a decrease in the number of active participants in the Plan.
 

Components of the net periodic benefit cost for our postretirement benefits other than pensions are as follows:
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Interest cost
$1
$1
Amortization of transition obligation
1
-
Net periodic postretirement benefit cost
$2
$1
 
14.  Related Party Transactions
 
In the normal course of business, we conduct transactions with HSBC and its subsidiaries. These transactions occur at prevailing market rates and terms and include funding arrangements, derivative execution, purchases and sales of receivables, servicing arrangements, information technology and some centralized services, item and statement processing services, banking and other miscellaneous services. All extensions of credit by HSBC Bank USA to other HSBC affiliates (other than FDIC-insured banks) are legally required to be secured by eligible collateral. The following table presents related party balances and the income and expense generated by related party transactions:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Assets:
   
Cash and due from banks
$262
$137
Interest bearing deposits with banks
1,526
1,287
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements
372
534
Trading assets(1)
15,190
16,575
Loans
2,247
1,060
Other
1,618
655
Total assets
$21,215
$20,248
Liabilities:
   
Deposits
$15,743
$10,337
Trading liabilities(1)
17,508
19,211
Short-term borrowings
5,301
3,326
Other
2,158
1,553
Total liabilities
$40,710
$34,427
 
 
(1)
Trading assets and liabilities exclude the impact of netting which allow the offsetting of amounts relating to certain contracts if certain conditions are met.

 

 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Income/(Expense):
   
Interest income
$13
$36
Interest expense
(13)
(10)
Net interest income
$-
$26
HSBC affiliate income:
   
Fees and commissions:
   
HSBC Finance
$19
$2
HSBC Markets (USA) Inc. ("HMUS")
2
3
Other HSBC affiliates
19
18
Fees on transfers of refund anticipation loans to HSBC Finance
-
4
Other HSBC affiliates income
6
6
Total affiliate income
$46
$33
Support services from HSBC affiliates:
   
HSBC Finance
$154
$224
HMUS
59
83
HSBC Technology & Services (USA) Inc. ("HTSU")
206
172
Other HSBC affiliates
42
31
Total support services from HSBC affiliates
$461
$510
Stock based compensation expense with HSBC
$9
$11
 
Transactions Conducted with HSBC Finance Corporation In connection with its acquisition of HSBC Finance, HSBC announced its expectation that funding costs for the HSBC Finance business would be lower as a result of the funding diversity of HSBC. As a result, we work with our affiliates under the oversight of HSBC North America to maximize opportunities and efficiencies in HSBC's operations in the U.S., including funding efficiencies. The purchases of the private label portfolio, the GM and UP Portfolios and certain auto finance loans from HSBC Finance as discussed in more detail below are indicative of such efficiencies contemplated.
 
 
•   In January 2009, we purchased the GM and UP Portfolios from HSBC Finance, with an outstanding principal balance of $12.4 billion at the time of sale, at a total net premium of $113 million. Premiums paid are amortized to interest income over the estimated life of the receivables purchased. HSBC Finance retained the customer account relationships associated with these credit card portfolios. On a daily basis we purchase all new credit card loan originations for the GM and UP Portfolios from HSBC Finance. HSBC Finance continues to service these credit card loans for us for a fee. Information regarding these loans is summarized in the table below.
 
 
•   In January 2009, we also purchased certain auto finance loans, with an outstanding principal balance of $3.0 billion from HSBC Finance at the time of sale, at a total net discount of $226 million. Discounts are amortized to interest income over the estimated life of the receivables purchased. In March 2010, we sold $379 million of auto finance receivables to HSBC Finance, including $353 million previously classified as held for sale, a substantial majority of which were comprised of the loans previously purchased from HSBC Finance, who immediately sold them to a third party. The remaining loans, which were previously serviced by HSBC Finance, were serviced by this third party provider until they were sold in August 2010. Information regarding these loans is summarized in the table below.
 
 
•   In July 2004, we sold the account relationships associated with $970 million of credit card receivables to HSBC Finance and on a daily basis, we purchase new originations on these credit card receivables. HSBC
    Finance continues to service these loans for us for a fee.  Information regarding these loans is summaried in the table below.
 
 
 
 
 
 
•   In December 2004, we purchased the private label credit card receivable portfolio as well as private label commercial and closed end loans from HSBC Finance. HSBC Finance retained the customer account relationships and by agreement we purchase on a daily basis substantially all new private label originations from HSBC Finance. HSBC Finance continues to service these loans for us for a fee. Information regarding these loans is summarized in the table below.
 
 
•   In 2003 and 2004, we purchased approximately $3.7 billion of residential mortgage loans from HSBC Finance. HSBC Finance continues to service these loans for us for a fee. Information regarding these loans is summarized in the table below.
 
The following table summarizes the private label card, private label commercial and closed end loans, credit card (including the GM and UP credit card portfolios) and real estate secured loans serviced for us by HSBC Finance as well as the daily loans purchased during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010:
 
 
Private Label
Credit Cards
 
 
 
 
Cards
Commercial and
Closed
End Loans(1)
 
General
Motors
 
Union
Privilege
 
 
Other
 
Residential
Mortgage
 
 
Total
 
(in billions)
Loans serviced by HSBC Finance:
             
March 31, 2011
$11.9
$.3
$4.1
$3.8
$1.8
$1.5
$23.4
December 31, 2010
13.1
.4
4.5
4.1
2.0
1.5
25.6
Total loans purchased on a daily basis from HSBC Finance during:
             
Three months ended March 31, 2011
3.2
-
3.1
.7
.9
-
7.9
Three months ended March 31, 2010
3.0
-
3.1
.7
1.0
-
7.8
 
 
(1)
Private label commercial are included in other commercial loans and private label closed end loans are included in other consumer loans in Note 5, "Loans."
 
Fees paid for servicing these loan portfolios totaled $150 million and $164 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
The GM and UP credit card receivables as well as the private label credit card receivables that are purchased from HSBC Finance on a daily basis at a sales price for each type of portfolio determined using a fair value calculated semi-annually in April and October by an independent third party based on the projected future cash flows of the receivables. The projected future cash flows are developed using various assumptions reflecting the historical performance of the receivables and adjusting for key factors such as the anticipated economic and regulatory environment. The independent third party uses these projected future cash flows and a discount rate to determine a range of fair values. We use the mid-point of this range as the sales price.
 
 
•   In the fourth quarter of 2009, an initiative was begun to streamline the servicing of real estate secured receivables across North America. As a result, certain functions that we had previously performed for our mortgage customers are now being performed by HSBC Finance for all North America mortgage customers, including our mortgage customers. Additionally, we are currently performing certain functions for all North America mortgage customers where these functions had been previously provided separately by each entity. During the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, we paid $2 million and $1 million, respectively, for services we received from HSBC Finance and received $2 million and $2 million, respectively, for services we provided to HSBC Finance.
 
 
•   In July 2010, certain employees in the real estate receivable default servicing department of HSBC Finance were transferred to the mortgage loan servicing department of a subsidiary of HSBC Bank USA. These employees continue to service defaulted real estate secured receivables for HSBC Finance and we receive a fee for providing
 
 
 
 
     these services. During the three months ended March 31, 2011, we received servicing revenue from HSBC Finance of $17 million.
 
 
•   Excluding the servicing fees paid for the loan portfolios discussed above, support services from HSBC affiliates also includes charges by HSBC Finance under various service level agreements for the servicing of certain tax refund anticipation loans as more fully discussed below, as well as other operational and administrative support. Fees paid for these services totaled $4 million and $60 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
 
•   Prior to 2011, our wholly-owned subsidiaries, HSBC Bank USA and HSBC Trust Company (Delaware), N.A. ("HTCD"), historically have been the originating lenders on behalf of HSBC Finance for a federal income tax refund anticipation loan program for clients of a single third party tax preparer which was managed by HSBC Finance. By agreement, HSBC Bank USA and HTCD historically processed applications, funded and subsequently transferred a portion of these loans to HSBC Finance. Prior to 2010, all loans were transferred to HSBC Finance. In 2010, we kept a portion of these loans on our balance sheet and earned a fee. The loans kept were transferred to HSBC Finance at par only upon reaching a defined delinquency status. We paid HSBC Finance a fee to service the loans we retained on our balance sheet and to assume the credit risk associated with these receivables. HSBC Bank USA and HTCD originated approximately $9.3 billion of loans during the three months ended March 31, 2010, of which $3.1 billion was transferred to HSBC Finance. During the three months ended March 31, 2010, we received fees of $4 million for the loans we originated and sold to HSBC Finance. Fees earned on the loans retained on balance sheet and fees paid to HSBC Finance for servicing and assuming the credit risk for these loans totaled $62 million and $56 million, respectively, during the three months ended March 31, 2010.
 
In December 2010, as a result of Internal Revenue Service decisions to stop providing information regarding certain unpaid taxpayer obligations which historically served as a significant part of the underwriting process, it was determined that tax refund anticipation loans could no longer be offered in a safe and sound manner and, therefore, we would no longer offer these loans and other related products going forward. These products have historically had an insignificant impact to our results of operations.
 
 
•   Certain of our consolidated subsidiaries have revolving lines of credit totaling $1.0 billion with HSBC Finance. There were no balances outstanding under any of these lines of credit at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
 
•   We extended a secured $1.5 billion uncommitted 364 day credit facility to certain subsidiaries of HSBC Finance in December 2009. This facility was renewed for an additional 364 days in December 2010. There were no balances outstanding at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
 
•   We extended a $1.0 billion committed unsecured 364 day credit facility to HSBC Bank Nevada, a subsidiary of HSBC Finance, in December 2009. This facility was renewed for an additional 364 days in December 2010. There were no balances outstanding at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
 
•   We serviced a portfolio of residential mortgage loans owned by HSBC Finance with an outstanding principal balance of $1.5 billion at December 31, 2009. During 2010, we transferred servicing of this portfolio back to HSBC Finance and, as a result, no longer service any loans for HSBC Finance. The servicing fee income for servicing this portfolio was $.3 million during the three months ended March 31, 2010 which is included in residential mortgage banking revenue in the consolidated statement of income.
 
 
•   In the third quarter of 2009, we purchased $106 million of Low Income Housing Tax Credit Investment Funds from HSBC Finance.
 
Transactions Conducted with HMUS
 
 
•   We utilize HSBC Securities (USA) Inc. ("HSI") for broker dealer, debt and preferred stock underwriting, customer referrals, loan syndication and other treasury and traded markets related services, pursuant to service level agreements. Fees charged by HSI for broker dealer, loan syndication services, treasury and traded markets related services are included in support services from HSBC affiliates. Debt underwriting fees charged by HSI are
 
 
deferred as a reduction of long-term debt and amortized to interest expense over the life of the related debt. Preferred stock issuance costs charged by HSI are recorded as a reduction of capital surplus. Customer referral fees paid to HSI are netted against customer fee income, which is included in other fees and commissions.
 
 
•   We have extended loans and lines, some of them uncommitted, to HMUS and its subsidiaries in the amount of $3.3 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010. At March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, $1.6 billion and $867 million, respectively, was outstanding on these loans and lines. Interest income on these loans and lines totaled $2 million and $5 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
Other Transactions with HSBC Affiliates
 
 
•   In January 2011, we agreed to acquire Halbis Capital Management (USA) Inc (Halbis), an asset management business, from an affiliate, Halbis Capital Management (UK) Ltd. as part of a reorganization which resulted in an increase to additional paid-in-capital of approximately $21 million.
 
 
•   In June 2010, we sold certain securities with a book value of $302 million to HSBC Bank plc and recognized a pre-tax loss of $40 million.
 
 
•   HNAH extended a $1.0 billion senior note to us in August 2009. This is a five year floating rate note which matures on August 28, 2014 with interest due quarterly beginning in November 2009. Interest expense on this note totaled $4 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010.
 
 
•   We have a committed unused line of credit with HSBC Bank plc of $2.5 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
 
•   We have an uncommitted unused line of credit with HSBC North America Inc. ("HNAI") of $150 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
 
•   We have extended loans and lines of credit to various other HSBC affiliates totaling $460 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010. At March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 there were no amounts outstanding on these loans and lines of credit. Interest income on these lines totaled $3 million during the three months ended March 31, 2010.
 
 
•   Historically, we have provided support to several HSBC affiliate sponsored asset-backed commercial paper ("ABCP") conduits by purchasing A-1/P-1 rated commercial paper issued by them. No such commercial paper was held at March 31, 2011. At December 31, 2010, we held $75 million of commercial paper issued by an HSBC affiliate sponsored ABCP conduit.
 
 
•   We routinely enter into derivative transactions with HSBC Finance and other HSBC affiliates as part of a global HSBC strategy to offset interest rate or other market risks associated with debt issues and derivative contracts with unaffiliated third parties. The notional value of derivative contracts related to these contracts was approximately $806.6 billion and $774.1 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. The net credit exposure (defined as the recorded fair value of derivative receivables) related to the contracts was approximately $15.2 billion and $16.6 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. Our Global Banking and Markets business accounts for these transactions on a mark to market basis, with the change in value of contracts with HSBC affiliates substantially offset by the change in value of related contracts entered into with unaffiliated third parties.
 
 
•   In December 2008, HSBC Bank USA entered into derivative transactions with another HSBC affiliate to offset the risk associated with the contingent "loss trigger" options embedded in certain leveraged super senior ("LSS") tranched credit default swaps. These transactions are expected to significantly reduce income volatility for HSBC Bank USA by transferring the volatility to the affiliate. The recorded fair value of derivative assets related to these derivative transactions was approximately $11 million and $25 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
 
 
•   Technology and some centralized operational services including human resources, finance, treasury, corporate affairs, compliance, legal, tax and other shared services in North America are centralized within HTSU.
 
 
 
Technology related assets and software purchased are generally purchased and owned by HTSU. HTSU also provides certain item processing and statement processing activities which are included in Support services from HSBC affiliates in the consolidated statement of income.
 
 
•   Our domestic employees participate in a defined benefit pension plan sponsored by HSBC North America. Additional information regarding pensions is provided in Note 13, "Pension and Other Postretirement Benefits."
 
 
•   Employees participate in one or more stock compensation plans sponsored by HSBC. Our share of the expense of these plans on a pre-tax basis was $9 million and $11 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
 
•   We use HSBC Global Resourcing (UK) Ltd., an HSBC affiliate located outside of the United States, to provide various support services to our operations including among other areas customer service, systems, collection and accounting functions. The expenses related to these services of $6 million and $7 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, are included as a component of Support services from HSBC affiliates in the consolidated statement of income and the table above. Prior to 2011, billing for these services was processed by HTSU.
 
 
•   We did not pay any dividends to our immediate parent, HNAI, on our common stock during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010.
 
15.  Regulatory Capital
 
Capital amounts and ratios of HSBC USA Inc. and HSBC Bank USA, calculated in accordance with current banking regulations, are summarized in the following table.
 
 
March 31, 2011
December 31, 2010
 
Capital
Amount
Well-Capitalized
Minimum Ratio(1)
Actual
Ratio
Capital
Amount
Well-Capitalized
Minimum Ratio(1)
Actual
Ratio
 
(dollars are in millions)
Total capital ratio:
           
 HSBC USA Inc. 
$22,880
10.00%
18.72%
$22,070
10.00%
18.14%
 HSBC Bank USA
23,217
10.00
19.22
22,177
10.00
18.41
Tier 1 capital ratio:
           
 HSBC USA Inc. 
15,158
6.00
12.40
14,355
6.00
11.80
 HSBC Bank USA
16,011
6.00
13.25
14,970
6.00
12.43
Tier 1 leverage ratio:
           
 HSBC USA Inc. 
15,158
3.00(2)
8.03
14,355
3.00(2)
7.87
 HSBC Bank USA
16,011
5.00
8.59
14,970
5.00
8.28
Risk weighted assets:
           
 HSBC USA Inc. 
122,247
   
121,645
   
 HSBC Bank USA
120,795
   
120,473
   
 
 
(1)
HSBC USA Inc and HSBC Bank USA are categorized as "well-capitalized", as defined by their principal regulators. To be categorized as well-capitalized under regulatory guidelines, a banking institution must have the minimum ratios reflected in the above table, and must not be subject to a directive, order, or written agreement to meet and maintain specific capital levels.
   
(2)
There is no Tier 1 leverage ratio component in the definition of a well-capitalized bank holding company. The ratio shown is the minimum required ratio.
 
We did not receive any cash capital contributions from our immediate parent, HNAI, during the first three months of 2011.
 
As part of the regulatory approvals with respect to the aforementioned receivable purchases completed in January 2009, HSBC Bank USA and HSBC made certain additional capital commitments to ensure that HSBC Bank USA
holds sufficient capital with respect to the purchased receivables that are or may become "low-quality assets," as defined by the Federal Reserve Act. These capital requirements, which require a risk-based capital charge of 100 percent for each "low-quality asset" transferred or arising in the purchased portfolios rather than the eight percent capital charge applied to similar assets that are not part of the transferred portfolios, are applied both for purposes of satisfying the terms of the commitments and for purposes of measuring and reporting HSBC Bank USA's risk-based capital and related ratios. This treatment applies as long as the low-quality assets are owned by an insured bank. During 2010, HSBC Bank USA sold low-quality auto finance loans with a net book value of approximately $178 million to a non-bank subsidiary of HSBC USA Inc. to reduce the capital requirement associated with these assets, of which $103 million was sold during the first quarter of 2010. Capital ratios and amounts at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 in the table above reflect this reporting. At March 31, 2011, the remaining purchased receivables subject to this requirement totaled $2.8 billion of which $583 million are considered to be low-quality assets.
 
Regulatory guidelines impose certain restrictions that may limit the inclusion of deferred tax assets in the computation of regulatory capital. We closely monitor the deferred tax assets for potential limitations or exclusions. At March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, deferred tax assets of $50 million and $360 million, respectively, were excluded in the computation of regulatory capital.
 
16.  Business Segments
 
As discussed in our 2010 Form 10-K, we initiated a process in late 2010 to re-evaluate the financial information used to manage our business including the scope and content of the financial data being reported to our management. During the first quarter of 2011, we completed our evaluation and decided we would no longer manage and evaluate the performance of the receivables purchased from HSBC Finance as a separate operating segment. Rather, we would manage and evaluate the performance of these assets as a component of our Personal Financial Services operating segment, consistent with HSBC's globally defined business segments. As a result, beginning in the first quarter of 2011, our management reporting was changed to reflect this decision and going forward we will now report our financial results under four reportable segments which are generally based upon customer groupings and the products and services offered: Personal Financial Services, Commercial Banking, Global Banking and Markets and Private Banking. Segment financial information has been restated for all periods presented to reflect this new segmentation. There have been no other changes in the basis of our segmentation or measurement of segment profit as compared with the presentation in our 2010 Form 10-K. Our segment results are reported on a continuing operations basis.
 
HSBC previously announced that with effect from March 1, 2011, Retail Banking and Wealth Management would be managed as a single global business. This business is the existing Personal Financial Services with Asset Management moving from Global Banking and Markets to this new single business. Therefore, to coincide with the change in our management reporting effective beginning in the second quarter of 2011, we will change the name of our Personal Financial Services segment to Retail Banking and Wealth Management and will include the results of Asset Management in this segment for all periods presented.
 
Net interest income of each segment represents the difference between actual interest earned on assets and interest incurred on liabilities of the segment, adjusted for a funding charge or credit. Segments are charged a cost to fund assets (e.g. customer loans) and receive a funding credit for funds provided (e.g. customer deposits) based on equivalent market rates. The objective of these charges/credits is to transfer interest rate risk from the segments to one centralized unit in Global Banking and Markets and more appropriately reflect the profitability of segments.
 
Certain other revenue and operating expense amounts are also apportioned among the business segments based upon the benefits derived from this activity or the relationship of this activity to other segment activity. These inter-segment transactions are accounted for as if they were with third parties.
 
Our segment results are presented under IFRSs (a non-U.S. GAAP financial measure) on a legal entity basis ("IFRS Basis") as operating results are monitored and reviewed, trends are evaluated and decisions about allocating resources, such as employees are made almost exclusively on an IFRSs basis since we report results to our parent,
 

HSBC in accordance with its reporting basis, IFRSs. We continue to monitor capital adequacy, establish dividend policy and report to regulatory agencies on a U.S. GAAP legal entity basis.
 
Reconciliation of our IFRS Basis segment results to the U.S. GAAP consolidated totals are as follows:
 
 
IFRS Consolidated Amounts
     
 
 
 
PFS
 
 
CMB
 
Global Banking
and Markets
 
 
PB
 
 
Other
Adjustments/
Reconciling
Items
 
 
Total
 
IFRS
Adjustments(4)
IFRS
Reclass-
ifications(5)
U.S. GAAP
Consolidated
Totals
 
(In millions)
Three Months Ended March 31, 2011
                   
Net interest income(1)
$656
$175
$132
$46
$(64)
$(8)
$937
$61
$46
$1,044
Other operating income
27
105
429
36
(36)
8
569
41
114
724
Total operating income
683
280
561
82
(100)
-
1,506
102
160
1,768
Loan impairment charges(3)
151
(30)
(17)
(9)
-
-
95
(1)
12
106
 
532
310
578
91
(100)
-
1,411
103
148
1,662
Operating expenses(2)
458
176
242
64
17
-
957
(5)
148
1,100
Profit before income tax expense
$74
$134
$336
$27
$(117)
$-
$454
$108
$-
$562
Balances at end of period:
                   
Total assets
$49,926
$19,495
$178,641
$6,139
$105
$-
$254,306
$(57,074)
$(769)
$196,463
Total loans, net
37,591
14,946
25,568
4,281
-
-
82,386
(2,725)
(9,775)
69,886
Goodwill
876
368
480
326
-
-
2,050
576
-
2,626
Total deposits
48,529
25,078
37,931
11,970
-
-
123,508
(3,206)
12,459
132,761
Three Months Ended March 31, 2010
                   
Net interest income(1)
$764
$188
$142
$46
$(9)
$(8)
$1,123
$59
$18
$1,200
Other operating income
66
154
412
35
12
8
687
27
209
923
Total operating income
830
342
554
81
3
-
1,810
86
227
2,123
Loan impairment charges(3)
207
1
(76)
(11)
2
-
123
100
(12)
211
 
623
341
630
92
1
-
1,687
(14)
239
1,912
Operating expenses(2)
300
150
200
55
15
-
720
95
239
1,054
Profit before income tax expense
$323
$191
$430
$37
$(14)
$-
$967
$(109)
$-
$858
Balances at end of period:
                   
Total assets
$48,592
$15,958
$169,518
$4,859
$15
$-
$238,942
$(52,678)
$(40)
$186,224
Total loans, net
41,746
14,312
18,538
4,162
-
-
78,758
(2,175)
(4,509)
72,074
Goodwill
876
368
480
326
-
-
2,050
576
-
2,626
Total deposits
49,273
23,097
30,602
10,990
-
-
113,962
(2,581)
13,313
124,694
 
 
(1)
Net interest income of each segment represents the difference between actual interest earned on assets and interest paid on liabilities of the segment adjusted for a funding charge or credit. Segments are charged a cost to fund assets (e.g. customer loans) and receive a funding credit for funds provided (e.g. customer deposits) based on equivalent market rates. The objective of these charges/credits is to transfer interest rate risk from the segments to one centralized unit in Treasury and more appropriately reflect the profitability of segments.
   
(2)
Expenses for the segments include fully apportioned corporate overhead expenses.
   
(3)
The provision assigned to the segments is based on the segments' net charge offs and the change in allowance for credit losses.
   
(4)
Represents adjustments associated with differences between IFRSs and U.S. GAAP basis of accounting.
   
(5)
Represents differences in financial statement presentation between IFRSs and U.S. GAAP.
 
Further discussion of the differences between IFRSs and U.S. GAAP are presented in Item 2, "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" of this Form 10-Q under the caption "Basis of Reporting." A summary of the significant differences between U.S. GAAP and IFRSs as they impact our results are presented below:
 
Net Interest Income
 
Effective interest rate - The calculation of effective interest rates under IFRS 39, "Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement ("IAS 39"), requires an estimate of changes in estimated contractual cash flows, including fees and points paid or recovered between parties to the contract that are an integral part of the effective interest rate be included. U.S. GAAP generally prohibits recognition of interest income to the extent the net interest in the loan would increase to an amount greater than the amount at which the borrower could settle the obligation. Under U.S. GAAP, prepayment penalties are generally recognized as received. U.S. GAAP also includes interest income on loans originated as held for sale which is included in other operating income for IFRSs.
 
Deferred loan origination costs and fees - Certain loan fees and incremental direct loan costs, which would not have been incurred but for the origination of loans, are deferred and amortized to earnings over the life of the loan under IFRSs. Certain loan fees and direct incremental loan origination costs, including internal costs directly attributable to the origination of loans in addition to direct salaries, are deferred and amortized to earnings under U.S. GAAP.
 
Loan origination deferrals under IFRSs are more stringent and result in lower costs being deferred than permitted under U.S. GAAP. In addition, all deferred loan origination fees, costs and loan premiums must be recognized based on the expected life of the receivables under IFRSs as part of the effective interest calculation while under U.S. GAAP they may be recognized on either a contractual or expected life basis.
 
Derivative interest expense Under IFRSs, net interest income includes the interest element for derivatives which corresponds to debt designated at fair value. For U.S. GAAP, this is included in gain on financial instruments designated at fair value and related derivatives which is a component of other revenues.
 
Other Operating Income (Total Other Revenues)
 
Derivatives - Effective January 1, 2008, U.S. GAAP removed the observability requirement of valuation inputs to recognize the difference between transaction price and fair value as profit at inception in the consolidated statement of income. Under IFRSs, recognition is permissible only if the inputs used in calculating fair value are based on observable inputs. If the inputs are not observable, profit and loss is deferred and is recognized: (1) over the period of contract, (2) when the data becomes observable, or (3) when the contract is settled. This causes the net income under U.S. GAAP to be different than under IFRSs.
 
Unquoted equity securities - Under IFRSs, equity securities which are not quoted on a recognized exchange (MasterCard Class B shares and Visa Class B shares), but for which fair value can be reliably measured, are required to be measured at fair value. Securities measured at fair value under IFRSs are classified as either available-for-sale securities, with changes in fair value recognized in shareholders' equity, or as trading securities, with changes in fair value recognized in income. Under U.S. GAAP, equity securities that are not quoted on a recognized exchange are not considered to have a readily determinable fair value and are required to be measured at cost, less any provisions for known impairment, and classified in other assets.
 
Loans held for sale - IFRSs requires loans originated with the intent to sell to be classified as trading assets and recorded at their fair market value. Under U.S. GAAP, loans designated as held for sale are reflected as loans and recorded at the lower of amortized cost or fair value. Under IFRSs, the income related to loans held for sale are reported in net interest income or trading revenue. Under U.S. GAAP, the income related to loans held for sale are reported similarly to loans held for investment.
 
For loans transferred to held for sale subsequent to origination, IFRSs requires these receivables to be reported separately on the balance sheet but does not change the measurement criteria. Accordingly, for IFRSs purposes such loans continue to be accounted for in accordance with IAS 39, with any gain or loss recorded at the time of sale.
 
U.S. GAAP requires loans that management intends to sell to be transferred to a held for sale category at the lower of cost or fair value. Under U.S. GAAP, the initial component of the lower of cost or fair value adjustment related to credit risk is recorded in the consolidated statement of income as provision for credit losses while the component related to interest rates and liquidity factors is reported in the consolidated statement of income in other revenues (losses).
 
Reclassification of financial assets - Certain securities were reclassified from "trading assets" to "loans and receivables" under IFRSs as of July 1, 2008 pursuant to an amendment to IAS 39 and are no longer marked to
market. In November 2008, additional securities were similarly transferred to loans and receivables. These securities continue to be classified as "trading assets" under U.S. GAAP.
 
Additionally, certain Leverage Acquisition Finance ("LAF") loans were classified as trading assets for IFRSs and to be consistent, an irrevocable fair value option was elected on these loans under U.S. GAAP on January 1, 2008. These loans were reclassified to "loans and advances" as of July 1, 2008 pursuant to the IAS 39 amendment discussed above. Under U.S. GAAP, these loans are classified as "held for sale" and carried at fair value due to the irrevocable nature of the fair value option.
 
Servicing assets - Under IAS 38, servicing assets are initially recorded on the balance sheet at cost and amortized over the projected life of the assets. Servicing assets are periodically tested for impairment with impairment adjustments charged against current earnings. Under U.S. GAAP, servicing assets are initially recorded on the balance sheet at fair value. All subsequent adjustments to fair value are reflected in current period earnings.
 
Securities - Effective January 1, 2009 under U.S. GAAP, the credit loss component of an other-than-temporary impairment of a debt security is recognized in earnings while the remaining portion of the impairment loss is recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income provided we have concluded we do not intend to sell the security and it is more-likely-than-not that we will not have to sell the security prior to recovery. Under IFRSs, there is no bifurcation of other-than temporary impairment and the entire decline in value is recognized in earnings. Also under IFRSs, recoveries in other-than-temporary impairment related to improvement in the underlying credit characteristics of the investment are recognized immediately in earnings while under U.S. GAAP, they are amortized to income over the remaining life of the security. There are also other less significant differences in measuring other-than-temporary impairment under IFRSs versus U.S. GAAP.
 
Under IFRSs, securities include HSBC shares held for stock plans at fair value. These shares held for stock plans are recorded at fair value through other comprehensive income. If it is determined these shares have become impaired, the fair value loss is recognized in profit and loss and any fair value loss recorded in other comprehensive income is reversed. There is no similar requirement under U.S. GAAP.
 
Loan Impairment Charges (Provision for Credit Losses)
 
IFRSs requires a discounted cash flow methodology for estimating impairment on pools of homogeneous customer loans which requires the discounting of cash flows including recovery estimates at the original effective interest rate of the pool of customer loans. The amount of impairment relating to the discounting of future cash flows unwinds with the passage of time, and is recognized in interest income. Also under IFRSs, if the recognition of a write-down to net realizable value on secure loans decreases because collateral values have improved and the improvement can be related objectively to an event occurring after recognition of the write-down, such write-down can be reversed, which is not permitted under U.S. GAAP. Additionally under IFRSs, future recoveries on charged-off loans or loans written down to net realizable value less cost to obtain title and sell are accrued for on a discounted basis and a recovery asset is recorded. Subsequent recoveries are recorded to earnings under U.S. GAAP, but are adjusted against the recovery asset under IFRSs. Under IFRSs, interest on impaired loans is recorded at the effective interest rate on the customer loans balance net of impairment allowances, and therefore reflects the collectibility of the loans.
 
As discussed above, under U.S. GAAP, the credit risk component of the lower of cost or fair value adjustment related to the transfer of receivables to held for sale is recorded in the consolidated statement of income as provision for credit losses. There is no similar requirement under IFRSs.
 
Operating Expenses
 
Pension costs - Costs under U.S. GAAP are higher than under IFRSs as a result of the amortization of the amount by which actuarial losses exceeded the higher of the projected benefit obligation or fair value of plan assets beyond the 10 percent "corridor." Furthermore, in 2010, changes to future accruals for legacy participants under the HSBC North America Pension Plan were accounted for as a plan curtailment under IFRSs, which resulted in immediate
income recognition. Under US GAAP, these changes were considered to be a negative plan amendment which resulted in no immediate income recognition.
 
Share-based bonus arrangements - Under IFRSs, the recognition of compensation expense related to share-based bonuses begins on January 1 of the current year for awards expected to be granted in the first quarter of the following year. Under U.S. GAAP, the recogntion of compensation expense related to share-based bonuses does not begin until the date the awards are granted.
 
Property - Under IFRSs, the value of property held for own use reflects revaluation surpluses recorded prior to January 1, 2004. Consequently, the values of tangible fixed assets and shareholders' equity are lower under U.S. GAAP than under IFRSs. There is a correspondingly lower depreciation charge and higher net income as well as higher gains (or smaller losses) on the disposal of fixed assets under U.S. GAAP. For investment properties, net income under U.S. GAAP does not reflect the unrealized gain or loss recorded under IFRSs for the period.
 
Assets
 
Customer loans (Loans) - On an IFRSs basis loans designated as held for sale at the time of origination and accrued interest are classified as trading assets. However, the accounting requirements governing when receivables previously held for investment are transferred to a held for sale category are more stringent under IFRSs than under U.S. GAAP.
 
Derivatives - Under U.S. GAAP, derivative receivables and payables with the same counterparty may be reported on a net basis in the balance sheet when there is an executed International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc. ("ISDA") Master Netting Arrangement. In addition, under U.S. GAAP, fair value amounts recognized for the obligation to return cash collateral received or the right to reclaim cash collateral paid are offset against the fair value of derivative instruments. Under IFRSs, these agreements do not necessarily meet the requirements for offset, and therefore such derivative receivables and payables are presented gross on the balance sheet.
 
Goodwill - IFRSs and U.S. GAAP require goodwill to be tested for impairment at least annually, or more frequently if circumstances indicate that goodwill may be impaired. For IFRSs, goodwill was amortized until 2005, however goodwill was amortized under U.S. GAAP until 2002, which resulted in a lower carrying amount of goodwill under IFRSs.
 
VIEs - The requirements for consolidation of variable interest entities under U.S. GAAP are based more on the power to control significant activities as opposed to the variability in cash flows. As a result, under U.S. GAAP we were determined to be the primary beneficiary and consolidated a commercial paper conduit effective January 1, 2010. However in 2011, changes involving liquidity asset purchase agreements were made which resulted in us no longer being considered the primary beneficiary and this commercial paper conduit was again deconsolidated at March 31, 2011. Under IFRSs this conduit is not consolidated.
 
17.  Variable Interest Entities
 
On January 1, 2010, we adopted new guidance issued by the Financial Accounting Standards Board in June 2009 which amends the accounting for the consolidation of variable interest entities ("VIEs"). The new guidance changed the approach for determining the primary beneficiary of a VIE from a quantitative approach focusing on risk and reward to a qualitative approach focusing on (a) the power to direct the activities of the VIE and (b) the obligation to absorb losses and/or the right to receive benefits that could be significant to the VIE. The adoption of the new guidance resulted in the consolidation of one commercial paper conduit managed by HSBC Bank USA effective January 1, 2010, however in March 2011, this commercial paper conduit was again deconsolidated as discussed more fully below.
 
In the ordinary course of business, we have organized special purpose entities ("SPEs") primarily to structure financial products to meet our clients' investment needs and to securitize financial assets held to meet our own funding needs. For disclosure purposes, we aggregate SPEs based on the purpose, risk characteristics and business activities of the SPEs. A SPE can be a VIE, which is an entity that lacks sufficient equity investment at risk to finance its activities without additional subordinated financial support or, as a group, the holders of the equity investment at risk lack either a) the power to direct the activities of an entity that most significantly impacts the entity's economic performance; b) the obligation to absorb the expected losses of the entity, the right to receive the expected residual returns of the entity, or both.
 
Variable Interest Entities We consolidate VIEs in which we hold a controlling financial interest as evidenced by the power to direct the activities of a VIE that most significantly impact its economic performance and the obligation to absorb losses of, or the right to receive benefits from, the VIE that could be potentially significant to the VIE and therefore are deemed to be the primary beneficiary. We take into account our entire involvement in a VIE (explicit or implicit) in identifying variable interests that individually or in the aggregate could be significant enough to warrant our designation as the primary beneficiary and hence require us to consolidate the VIE or otherwise require us to make appropriate disclosures. We consider our involvement to be significant where we, among other things, (i) provide liquidity put options or other liquidity facilities to support the VIE's debt issuances; (ii) enter into derivative contracts to absorb the risks and benefits from the VIE or from the assets held by the VIE; (iii) provide a financial guarantee that covers assets held or liabilities issued; (iv) design, organize and structure the transaction; and (v) retain a financial or servicing interest in the VIE.
 
We are required to evaluate whether to consolidate a VIE when we first become involved and on an ongoing basis. In almost all cases, a qualitative analysis of our involvement in the entity provides sufficient evidence to determine whether we are the primary beneficiary. In rare cases, a more detailed analysis to quantify the extent of variability to be absorbed by each variable interest holder is required to determine the primary beneficiary.
 
Consolidated VIEs The following table summarizes the assets and liabilities of our consolidated VIEs as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010:
 
 
March 31, 2011
December 31, 2010
 
Consolidated
Assets
Consolidated
Liabilities
Consolidated
Assets
Consolidated
Liabilities
 
(in millions)
Asset-backed commercial paper conduit:
       
Interest bearing deposits with banks
$-
$-
$676
$-
Held-to-maturity securities
-
-
881
-
Loans, net
-
-
1,220
-
Other assets
-
-
3
-
Short-term borrowings
-
-
-
3,022
Other liabilities
-
-
-
3
Subtotal
-
-
2,780
3,025
Securitization vehicles:
       
Loans, net
11,658
-
12,963
-
Other assets
189
-
(1,055)
-
Long-term debt
-
-
-
150
Deposits
-
23
-
20
Other liabilities
-
1,135
-
261
Subtotal
11,847
1,158
11,908
431
Low income housing limited liability partnership:
       
Interest bearing deposits with banks
90
-
83
-
Other assets
501
-
509
-
Long term debt
-
55
-
55
Other liabilities
-
116
-
109
Subtotal
591
171
592
164
Total
$12,438
$1,329
$15,280
$3,620
 

 

Asset-backed commercial paper conduit We provide liquidity facilities to a number of multi-seller and single-seller asset-backed commercial paper conduits ("ABCP conduits") sponsored by HSBC affiliates and third parties. These conduits support the financing needs of customers by facilitating the customers' access to commercial paper markets.
 
One of our commercial paper conduits, otherwise known as Bryant Park, was sponsored, organized and managed to facilitate clients in securing asset-backed financing collateralized by diverse pools of loan and lease receivables or investment securities. Bryant Park funds the purchase of the eligible assets by issuing short-term commercial paper notes to third party investors. One of our affiliates provides a program wide letter of credit enhancement ("PWE") to support the creditworthiness of the commercial paper issued up to a certain amount. We also entered into various liquidity asset purchase agreements ("LAPAs"), to provide liquidity support for the commercial paper notes issued to fund the asset purchases. Under the new VIE consolidation guidance effective in 2010, we began to consolidate Bryant Park in our financial statements on January 1, 2010 as we were considered to be the primary beneficiary because we have the power to direct the activities of the conduit that most significantly impact its economic performance including a) determining which eligible assets to acquire; b) risk managing the portfolio held; and c) managing the refinancing of commercial paper.
 
The liquidity facilities Bryant Park provided in the form of LAPAs can be drawn upon by the conduit in the event it cannot issue commercial paper notes or does not have sufficient funds available to pay maturing commercial paper. Under the LAPAs, we are obligated, subject to certain conditions, to purchase eligible assets previously funded for an amount not to exceed the face value of the commercial paper in order to provide the conduit with funds to repay the maturing notes. As such, we are exposed to the market risk and the credit risk of the underlying assets held by Bryant Park only to the extent the liquidity facility is drawn.
 
During the first quarter of 2011, in order to consolidate and streamline conduit administration across HSBC as well as to reduce risk and achieve operational and capital efficiencies, we assigned a significant majority all of our LAPAs to HSBC Bank plc. As a result, we no longer have a controlling financial interest in Bryant Park and beginning in March 2011, we no longer consolidate Bryant Park.
 
The deconsolidation of Bryant Park in March 2011 resulted in the removal of $2.4 billion of assets (primarily commercial loans and held-to-maturity securities) and $2.5 billion of liabilities (primarily short-term borrowings). In addition, $142 million of unrealized losses on held-to-maturity securities were reversed from accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), while a reserve of $94 million was established relating to the liquidity facilities still provided by HSBC Bank USA with respect to certain securities held by Bryant Park. The impact of deconsolidation on our results of operations was not significant.
 
Securitization vehicles We have historically utilized entities that are structured as trusts to securitize certain private label and other credit card receivables where securitization provides an attractive source of low cost funding. We transferred certain private label and other credit card receivables to these trusts which in turn issue debt instruments collateralized by the transferred receivables. As our affiliate is the servicer of the assets of these trusts we performed a detailed analysis and determined that we retain the benefits and risks and are the primary beneficiary of the trusts and, as a result, consolidate them.
 
Certain assets of the consolidated VIEs serve as collateral for the obligations of the VIE. These assets include loans of $233 million at December 31, 2010. There were no such assets at March 31, 2011. Debt securities issued by these VIEs are reported as secured financings in long-term debt. The holders of the debt securities issued by these vehicles have no recourse to our general credit. The securitization vehicles also held obligations to repay intercompany loans totaling $7.9 billion and $8.8 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, related to the transfer of receivables to the securitization vehicles which are eliminated in consolidation and therefore are not presented in the table above.
 
Low income housing limited liability partnership During the third quarter of 2009, all low income housing investments held by us were transferred to a Limited Liability Partnership ("LLP") in exchange for debt and equity while a non-affiliated third party invested cash for an equity interest that is mandatorily redeemable at a future date. The LLP was created in order to ensure the utilization of future tax benefits from these low income housing tax
projects. The LLP was deemed to be a VIE as it does not have sufficient equity investment at risk to finance its activities. Upon entering into this transaction, we concluded that we are the primary beneficiary of the LLP due to the nature of our continuing involvement and, as a result, consolidate the LLP and report the equity interest issued to the third party investor as other liabilities and the consolidated assets of the LLP in other assets in our consolidated financial statements. The investments held by the LLP represent equity investments in the underlying low income housing partnerships for which the LLP applies equity-method accounting. The LLP does not consolidate the underlying partnerships because it does not have the power to direct the activities of the partnerships that most significantly impact the economic performance of the partnerships.
 
Unconsolidated VIEs We also have variable interests with other VIEs that were not consolidated at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 because we were not the primary beneficiary. The following table provides additional information on those unconsolidated VIEs, the variable interests held by us and our maximum exposure to loss arising from our involvements in those VIEs as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010:
 
 
Variable Interests
Held Classified
as Assets
Variable Interests
Held Classified
as Liabilities
Total Assets in
Unconsolidated
VIEs
Maximum
Exposure
to Loss
 
(in millions)
As of March 31, 2011
       
Asset-backed commercial paper conduits
$-
$-
$14,045
$911
Structured note vehicles
575
84
6,815
764
Total
$575
$84
$20,860
$1,675
As of December 31, 2010
       
Asset-backed commercial paper conduits
$-
$-
$13,516
$1,856
Structured note vehicles
537
87
6,734
900
Total
$537
$87
$20,250
$2,756
 
Information on the types of variable interest entities with which we are involved, the nature of our involvement and the variable interests held in those entities is presented below.
 
Asset-backed commercial paper conduits Separately from the facility discussed above, we provide liquidity facilities to a number of multi-seller and single-seller asset-backed commercial paper conduits ("ABCP conduits") sponsored by HSBC affiliates and by third parties. These conduits support the financing needs of customers by facilitating the customers' access to commercial paper markets.
 
Customers sell financial assets, such as trade receivables, to ABCP conduits, which fund the purchases by issuing short-term highly-rated commercial paper collateralized by the assets acquired. In a multi-seller conduit, any number of companies may be originating and selling assets to the conduit whereas a single-seller conduit acquires assets from a single company. We, along with other financial institutions, provide liquidity facilities to ABCP conduits in the form of lines of credit or asset purchase commitments. Liquidity facilities provided to multi-seller conduits support transactions associated with a specific seller of assets to the conduit and we would only be required to provide support in the event of certain triggers associated with those transactions and assets. Liquidity facilities provided to single-seller conduits are not identified with specific transactions or assets and we would be required to provide support upon occurrence of certain triggers that generally affect the conduit as a whole. Our obligations are generally pari passu with those of other institutions that also provide liquidity support to the same conduit or for the same transactions. We do not provide any program-wide credit enhancements to ABCP conduits.
 
Each seller of assets to an ABCP conduit typically provides collateral in the form of excess assets and, therefore, bears the risk of first loss related to the specific assets transferred. We do not transfer our own assets to the conduits. We have no ownership interests in, perform no administrative duties for, and do not service any of the assets held by the conduits. We are not the primary beneficiary and do not consolidate any of the ABCP conduits to which we provide liquidity facilities, other than Bryant Park as discussed above. Credit risk related to the liquidity facilities provided is managed by subjecting them to our normal underwriting and risk management processes. The $911 million maximum exposure to loss presented in the table above represents the maximum amount of loans and asset purchases we could be required to fund under the liquidity facilities. The maximum loss exposure is estimated assuming the facilities are fully drawn and the underlying collateralized assets are in default with zero recovery value.
 
Structured note vehicles Our involvement in structured note vehicles includes entering into derivative transactions such as interest rate and currency swaps, and investing in their debt instruments. With respect to several of these VIEs, we hold variable interests in the form of total return swaps entered into in connection with the transfer of certain assets to the VIEs. In these transactions, we transferred financial assets from our trading portfolio to the VIEs and entered into total return swaps under which we receive the total return on the transferred assets and pay a market rate of return. The transfers of assets in these transactions do not qualify as sales under the applicable accounting literature and are accounted for as secured borrowings. Accordingly, the transferred assets continue to be recognized as trading assets on our balance sheet and the funds received are recorded as liabilities in long-term debt. As of March 31, 2011, we recorded approximately $118 million of trading assets and $139 million of long-term liabilities on our balance sheet as a result of "failed sale" accounting treatment for certain transfers of financial assets. As of December 31, 2010, we recorded approximately $126 million of trading assets and $147 million of long-term liabilities on our balance sheet as a result of "failed sale" accounting treatment for certain transfers of financial assets. The financial assets and financial liabilities were not legally ours and we have no control over the financial assets which are restricted solely to satisfy the liability.
 
In addition to our variable interests, we also hold credit default swaps with these structured note VIEs under which we receive credit protection on specified reference assets in exchange for the payment of a premium. Through these derivatives, the VIEs assume the credit risk associated with the reference assets which are then passed on to the holders of the debt instruments they issue. Because they create rather than absorb variability, the credit default swaps we hold are not considered variable interests.
 
We record all investments in, and derivative contracts with, unconsolidated structured note vehicles at fair value on our consolidated balance sheet. Our maximum exposure to loss is limited to the recorded amounts of these instruments.
 
Beneficial interests issued by third-party sponsored securitization entities We hold certain beneficial interests issued by third-party sponsored securitization entities which may be considered VIEs. The investments are transacted at arm's-length and decisions to invest are based on credit analysis on underlying collateral assets or the issuer. We are a passive investor in these issuers and do not have the power to direct the activities of these issuers. As such, we do not consolidate these securitization entities. Additionally, we do not have other involvements in servicing or managing the collateral assets or provide financial or liquidity support to these issuers that potentially give rise to risk of loss exposure. These investments are an integral part of the disclosure in Note 4, "Securities" and Note 20, "Fair Value Measurements" and, therefore, are not disclosed in this note to avoid redundancy.
 
18.  Guarantee Arrangements and Pledged Assets
 
Guarantee Arrangements As part of our normal operations, we enter into credit derivatives and various off-balance sheet guarantee arrangements with affiliates and third parties. These arrangements arise principally in connection with our lending and client intermediation activities and include standby letters of credit and certain credit derivative transactions. The contractual amounts of these arrangements represent our maximum possible credit exposure in the event that we are required to fulfill the maximum obligation under a guarantee.
 

The following table presents total carrying value and contractual amounts of our sell protection credit derivatives and major off-balance sheet guarantee arrangements as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010. Following the table is a description of the various arrangements.
 
 
March 31, 2011
December 31, 2010
 
Carrying
Value
Notional/Maximum
Exposure to Loss
Carrying
Value
Notional/Maximum
Exposure to Loss
 
(in millions)
Credit derivatives(1)(4)
$561
$359,611
$(831)
$354,780
Financial standby letters of credit, net of participations(2)(3)
-
4,441
-
4,264
Performance (non-financial) guarantees(3)
-
3,414
-
2,895
Liquidity asset purchase agreements(3)
-
911
-
1,856
Total
$561
$368,377
$(831)
$363,795
 
 
(1)
Includes $52.3 billion and $49.4 billion issued for the benefit of HSBC affiliates at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
   
(2)
Includes $582 million and $486 million issued for the benefit of HSBC affiliates at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
   
(3)
For standby letters of credit and liquidity asset purchase agreements, maximum loss represents losses to be recognized assuming the letter of credit and liquidity facilities have been fully drawn and the obligors have defaulted with zero recovery.
   
(4)
For credit derivatives, the maximum loss is represented by the notional amounts without consideration of mitigating effects from collateral or recourse arrangements.
 
Credit-Risk Related Arrangements:
 
Credit derivatives Credit derivatives are financial instruments that transfer the credit risk of a reference obligation from the credit protection buyer to the credit protection seller who is exposed to the credit risk without buying the reference obligation. We sell credit protection on underlying reference obligations (such as loans or securities) by entering into credit derivatives, primarily in the form of credit default swaps, with various institutions. We account for all credit derivatives at fair value. Where we sell credit protection to a counterparty that holds the reference obligation, the arrangement is effectively a financial guarantee on the reference obligation. Under a credit derivative contract, the credit protection seller will reimburse the credit protection buyer upon occurrence of a credit event (such as bankruptcy, insolvency, restructuring or failure to meet payment obligations when due) as defined in the derivative contract, in return for a periodic premium. Upon occurrence of a credit event, we will pay the counterparty the stated notional amount of the derivative contract and receive the underlying reference obligation. The recovery value of the reference obligation received could be significantly lower than its notional principal amount when a credit event occurs.
 
Certain derivative contracts are subject to master netting arrangements and related collateral agreements. A party to a derivative contract may demand that the counterparty post additional collateral in the event its net exposure exceeds certain predetermined limits and when the credit rating falls below a certain grade. We set the collateral requirements by counterparty such that the collateral covers various transactions and products, and is not allocated to specific individual contracts.
 
We manage our exposure to credit derivatives using a variety of risk mitigation strategies where we enter into offsetting hedge positions or transfer the economic risks, in part or in entirety, to investors through the issuance of structured credit products. We actively manage the credit and market risk exposure in the credit derivative portfolios on a net basis and, as such, retain no or a limited net sell protection position at any time. The following table summarizes our net credit derivative positions as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010:
 
 
March 31, 2011
December 31, 2010
 
Carrying (Fair)
Value
 
Notional
Carrying (Fair)
Value
 
Notional
 
(in millions)
Sell-protection credit derivative positions
$561
$359,611
$(831)
$354,780
Buy-protection credit derivative positions
222
354,837
1,631
346,246
Net position(1)
$783
$4,774
$800
$8,534
 
 
(1)
Positions are presented net in the table above to provide a complete analysis of our risk exposure and depict the way we manage our credit derivative portfolio. The offset of the sell-protection credit derivatives against the buy-protection credit derivatives may not be legally binding in the absence of master netting agreements with the same counterparty. Furthermore, the credit loss triggering events for individual sell protection credit derivatives may not be the same or occur in the same period as those of the buy protection credit derivatives thereby not providing an exact offset.
 
Standby letters of credit A standby letter of credit is issued to a third party for the benefit of a customer and is a guarantee that the customer will perform or satisfy certain obligations under a contract. It irrevocably obligates us to pay a specified amount to the third party beneficiary if the customer fails to perform the contractual obligation. We issue two types of standby letters of credit: performance and financial. A performance standby letter of credit is issued where the customer is required to perform some nonfinancial contractual obligation, such as the performance of a specific act, whereas a financial standby letter of credit is issued where the customer's contractual obligation is of a financial nature, such as the repayment of a loan or debt instrument. As of March 31, 2011, the total amount of outstanding financial standby letters of credit (net of participations) and performance guarantees were $4.4 billion and $3.4 billion, respectively. As of December 31, 2010, the total amount of outstanding financial standby letters of credit (net of participations) and performance guarantees were $4.3 billion and $2.9 billion, respectively.
 
The issuance of a standby letter of credit is subject to our credit approval process and collateral requirements. We charge fees for issuing letters of credit commensurate with the customer's credit evaluation and the nature of any collateral. Included in other liabilities are deferred fees on standby letters of credit, which represent the value of the stand-ready obligation to perform under these guarantees, amounting to $49 million and $47 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. Also included in other liabilities is an allowance for credit losses on unfunded standby letters of credit of $27 million and $26 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
 
Below is a summary of the credit ratings of credit risk related guarantees including the credit ratings of counterparties against which we sold credit protection and financial standby letters of credit as of March 31, 2011 as an indicative proxy of payment risk:
 
 
Average
Credit Ratings of the Obligors or the Transactions
 
Life
Investment
Non-Investment
 
Notional/Contractual Amounts
(in years)
Grade
Grade
Total
 
(dollars are in millions)
Sell-protection Credit Derivatives(1)
       
Single name CDS
2.9
$151,780
$70,598
$222,378
Structured CDS
2.4
71,299
4,693
75,992
Index credit derivatives
3.3
47,176
1,268
48,444
Total return swaps
9.0
12,460
337
12,797
Subtotal
 
282,715
76,896
359,611
Standby Letters of Credit(2)
1.4
7,161
694
7,855
Total
 
$289,876
$77,590
$367,466

 
(1)
The credit ratings in the table represent external credit ratings for classification as investment grade and non-investment grade.
   
(2)
External ratings for most of the obligors are not available. Presented above are the internal credit ratings which are developed using similar methodologies and rating scale equivalent to external credit ratings for purposes of classification as investment grade and non-investment grade.
 
Our internal groupings are determined based on HSBC's risk rating systems and processes which assign a credit grade based on a scale which ranks the risk of default of a customer. The groupings are determined and used for managing risk and determining level of credit exposure appetite based on the customer's operating performance, liquidity, capital structure and debt service ability. In addition, we also incorporate subjective judgments into the risk rating process concerning such things as industry trends, comparison of performance to industry peers and perceived quality of management. We compare our internal risk ratings to outside external rating agency benchmarks, where possible, at the time of formal review and regularly monitor whether our risk ratings are comparable to the external ratings benchmark data.
 
A non-investment grade rating of a referenced obligor has a negative impact to the fair value of the credit derivative and increases the likelihood that we will be required to perform under the credit derivative contract. We employ market-based parameters and, where possible, use the observable credit spreads of the referenced obligors as measurement inputs in determining the fair value of the credit derivatives. We believe that such market parameters are more indicative of the current status of payment/performance risk than external ratings by the rating agencies which may not be forward-looking in nature and, as a result, lag behind those market-based indicators.
 
Written Put Options, Non Credit-Risk Related and Indemnity Arrangements:
 
Liquidity asset purchase agreements We provide liquidity facilities to a number of multi-seller and single-seller asset-backed commercial paper conduits sponsored by affiliates and third parties. The conduits finance the purchase of individual assets by issuing commercial paper to third party investors. Each liquidity facility is transaction specific and has a maximum limit. Pursuant to the liquidity agreements, we are obligated, subject to certain limitations, to purchase the eligible assets from the conduit at an amount not to exceed the face value of the commercial paper in the event the conduit is unable to refinance its commercial paper. A liquidity asset purchase agreement is essentially a conditional written put option issued to the conduit where the exercise price is the face value of the commercial paper. As of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, we have issued $911 million and $1.9 billion, respectively, of liquidity facilities to provide liquidity support to the commercial paper issued by various conduits. The decline since December 31, 2010 reflects the assignment of a significant majority of these facilities to HSBC Bank plc during the first quarter of 2011. See Note 17, "Variable Interest Entities," for further information.
 
Structured products We structure and sell products that provide for the return of principal to investors on a future date. These structured products have various reference assets and we are obligated to cover any shortfall between the market value of the underlying reference portfolio and the principal amount due at maturity. We manage such shortfall risk by, among other things, establishing structural and investment constraints. Additionally, the structures require liquidation of the underlying reference portfolio when certain pre-determined triggers are breached and the proceeds from liquidation are required to be invested in zero-coupon bonds that would generate sufficient funds to repay the principal amount upon maturity. We may be exposed to market (gap) risk at liquidation and, as such, may be required to make up the shortfall between the liquidation proceeds and the purchase price of the zero coupon bonds. These structured products are accounted for on a fair value basis. The notional amounts of these structured products were not material as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010. We have not made any payments under the terms of these structured products and we consider the probability of such payments to be remote.
 
Visa Covered Litigation We are an equity member of Visa Inc. ("Visa"). Prior to its initial public offering ("IPO") on March 19, 2008, Visa completed a series of transactions to reorganize and restructure its operations and to convert membership interests into equity interests. Pursuant to the restructuring, we, along with all the Class B shareholders, agreed to indemnify Visa for the claims and obligations arising from certain specific covered litigations. Class B shares are convertible into listed Class A shares upon (i) settlement of the covered litigations or

 
(ii) the third anniversary of the IPO, whichever is later. The indemnification is subject to the accounting and disclosure requirements. Visa used a portion of the IPO proceeds to establish a $3.0 billion escrow account to fund future claims arising from those covered litigations (the escrow was subsequently increased to $4.1 billion). In 2009 and 2010, Visa exercised its rights to sell shares of existing Class B shareholders in order to increase the escrow account and announced that it had deposited collectively an additional $2.0 billion into the escrow account. As a result, we re-evaluated our contingent liability recorded relating to this litigation and reduced our liability by $24 million during 2009 and 2010. In March 2011, Visa again exercised its rights to sell shares of existing Class B shareholders and funded an additional $400 million into the escrow account and we reduced our liability by $5 million. At March 31, 2011, the net contingent liability recorded was $4 million. We do not expect these changes to result in a material adverse effect on our results of operations.
 
Clearinghouses and exchanges We are a member of various exchanges and clearinghouses that trade and clear securities and/or futures contracts. As a member, we may be required to pay a proportionate share of the financial obligations of another member who defaults on its obligations to the exchange or the clearinghouse. Our guarantee obligations would arise only if the exchange or clearinghouse had exhausted its resources. Any potential contingent liability under these membership agreements cannot be estimated. However, we believe that any potential requirement to make payments under these agreements is remote.
 
Mortgage Loan Repurchase Obligations
 
Sale of mortgage loans In the ordinary course of business, we originate and sell mortgage loans primarily to government sponsored entities ("GSEs") and provide various representations and warranties related to, among other things, the ownership of the loans, the validity of the liens, the loan selection and origination process, and the compliance to the origination criteria established by the agencies. In the event of a breach of our representations and warranties, we may be obligated to repurchase the loans with identified defects or to indemnify the buyers. Our contractual obligation arises only when the breach of representations and warranties are discovered and repurchase is demanded.
 
We typically first become aware that a GSE or other third party is evaluating a particular loan for repurchase when we receive a request to review the underlying loan file. Generally, the reviews focus on severely delinquent loans to identify alleged fraud, misrepresentation or file documentation issues. Upon completing its review, the GSE or other third party may submit a repurchase demand. Historically, most file requests have not resulted in repurchase demands. After receipt of a repurchase demand, we perform a detailed evaluation of the substance of the request and appeal any claim that we believe is either unsubstantiated or contains errors, leveraging both dedicated internal as well as retained external resources. In many cases, we ultimately are not required to repurchase a loan as we are able to resolve the purported defect. From initial inquiry to ultimate resolution, a typical case is usually resolved within 12 months. Acceptance of a repurchase demand will involve either a) repurchase of the loan at the unpaid principal balance plus accrued interest or b) reimbursement for any realized loss on a liquidated property ("make-whole" payment).
 
To date, repurchase demands we have received primarily relate to prime loans sourced during 2004 through 2008 from the legacy broker channel which we exited from in late 2008. Loans sold to GSEs and other third parties originated in 2004 through 2008 subject to representations and warranties for which we may be liable had an outstanding principal balance of approximately $21.8 billion and $23.0 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, including $13.6 billion and $14.3 billion, respectively, of loans sourced from our legacy broker channel.

The following table shows the trend in repurchase demands received on loans sold to GSEs and other third parties by loan origination vintage during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively:
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Pre- 2004
$1
$3
2004
4
4
2005
8
6
2006
14
11
2007
40
47
2008
29
31
Post 2008
24
2
Total repurchase demands received(1)
$120
$104
 
 
(1)
Includes repurchase demands on loans sourced from our legacy broker channel of $85 million and $93 million at March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
The following table provides information about outstanding repurchase demands received from GSEs and other third parties at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
GSEs
$91
$92
Others
30
23
Total(1)
$121
$115
 
 
(1)
Includes repurchase demands on loans sourced from our legacy broker channel of $86 million and $87 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
 
In estimating our repurchase liability arising from breaches of representations and warranties, we consider the following:
 
 
•   The level of outstanding repurchase demands in inventory and our historical defense rate;
 
 
•   The level of outstanding requests for loan files and the related historical repurchase request conversion rate and defense rate on such loans; and
 
 
•   The level of potential future demands based on historical conversion rates of loans which we have not received a loan file request but are two or more payments delinquent or expected to become delinquent at an estimated conversion rate.
 
The following table summarizes the change in our estimated repurchase liability for loans sold to the GSEs and other third parties during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010 for obligations arising from the breach of representations and warranties associated with the sale of these loans:
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Balance at beginning of period
$262
$66
Increase in liability recorded through earnings
44
73
Realized losses
(36)
(22)
Balance at end of period
$270
$117
 
 
Our reserve for potential repurchase liability exposures relates primarily to previously originated mortgages through broker channels. Our mortgage repurchase liability of $270 million at March 31, 2011 represents our best estimate of the loss that has been incurred resulting from various representations and warranties in the contractual provisions of our mortgage loan sales. Because the level of mortgage loan repurchase losses are dependent upon economic factors, investor demand strategies and other external risk factors such as housing market trends that may change, the level of the liability for mortgage loan repurchase losses requires significant judgment. As these estimates are influenced by factors outside our control, there is uncertainty inherent in these estimates making it reasonably possible that they could change.
 
Pledged Assets Pledged assets included in the consolidated balance sheet are summarized in the following table.
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Interest bearing deposits with banks
$1,835
$1,463
Trading assets(1)
304
319
Securities available-for-sale(2)
18,332
19,765
Securities held to maturity
391
1,004
Loans(3)
1,169
2,691
Other assets(4)
5,334
5,598
Total
$27,365
$30,840
 
 
(1)
Trading assets are primarily pledged against liabilities associated with consolidated variable interest entities.
   
(2)
Securities available-for-sale are primarily pledged against public fund deposits and various short-term and long term borrowings, as well as providing capacity for potential secured borrowings from the Federal Home Loan Bank and the Federal Reserve Bank.
   
(3)
Loans are primarily residential mortgage loans pledged against long-term borrowings from the Federal Home Loan Bank. At December 31, 2010, loans also include private label and credit card receivables pledged against long-term secured borrowings and the loans of a consolidated commercial paper conduit that collateralize the conduit's outstanding commercial paper.
   
(4)
Other assets represent cash on deposit with non-banks related to derivative collateral support agreements.
 
19.  Litigation and Regulatory Matters
 
In addition to the matters described below, in the ordinary course of business, we are routinely named as defendants in, or as parties to, various legal actions and proceedings relating to activities of our current and/or former operations. These actual or threatened legal actions and proceedings may include claims for substantial or indeterminate compensatory or punitive damages, or for injunctive relief. In the ordinary course of business, we also are subject to governmental and regulatory examinations, information-gathering requests, investigations and proceedings (both formal and informal), certain of which may result in adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties, injunctions or other relief. In connection with formal and informal inquiries by these regulators, we receive numerous requests, subpoenas and orders seeking documents, testimony and other information in connection with various aspects of our regulated activities.
 
In view of the inherent unpredictability of litigation and regulatory matters, particularly where the damages sought are substantial or indeterminate or when the proceedings or investigations are in the early stages, we cannot determine with any degree of certainty the timing or ultimate resolution of litigation and regulatory matters or the eventual loss, fines, penalties or business impact, if any, that may result. We established reserves for litigation and regulatory matters when those matters present loss contingencies that are both probable and can be reasonably estimated. The actual costs of resolving litigation and regulatory matters, however, may be substantially higher or lower than the amounts reserved for those matters.
 
We believe that the eventual outcome of litigation and regulatory matters, unless otherwise noted below, would not be likely to have a material adverse effect on our consolidated financial condition. However, given the substantial or indeterminate amounts sought in certain of these matters, and the inherent unpredictability of such matters, an adverse outcome in certain of these matters could have a material adverse effect on our consolidated results of operations or cash flows in particular quarterly or annual periods.
 
Litigation
 
Credit Card Litigation Since June 2005, HSBC Bank USA, HSBC Finance Corporation, HSBC North America and HSBC, as well as other banks and Visa Inc. and MasterCard Incorporated, were named as defendants in four class actions filed in Connecticut and the Eastern District of New York: Photos Etc. Corp. et al. v. Visa U.S.A., Inc., et al.(D. Conn. No. 3:05-CV-01007 (WWE)); National Association of Convenience Stores, et al. v. Visa U.S.A., Inc., et al.(E.D.N.Y. No. 05-CV 4520 (JG)); Jethro Holdings, Inc., et al. v. Visa U.S.A., Inc. et al. (E.D.N.Y. No. 05-CV-4521(JG)); and American Booksellers Asps' v. Visa U.S.A., Inc. et al. (E.D.N.Y. No. 05-CV-5391 (JG)). Numerous other complaints containing similar allegations (in which no HSBC entity is named) were filed across the country against Visa Inc., MasterCard Incorporated and other banks. These actions principally allege that the imposition of a no-surcharge rule by the associations and/or the establishment of the interchange fee charged for credit card transactions causes the merchant discount fee paid by retailers to be set at supracompetitive levels in violation of the Federal antitrust laws. These suits have been consolidated and transferred to the Eastern District of New York. The consolidated case is: In re Payment Card Interchange Fee and Merchant Discount Antitrust Litigation, MDL 1720, E.D.N.Y. ("MDL 1720"). A consolidated, amended complaint was filed by the plaintiffs on April 24, 2006 and a second consolidated amended complaint was filed on January 29, 2009. The parties are engaged in discovery, motion practice and mediation. On February 7, 2011, MasterCard Incorporated, Visa Inc., the other defendants, including HSBC Bank USA, and certain affiliates of the defendants entered into settlement and judgment sharing agreements (the "Agreements") that provide for the apportionment of certain defined costs and liabilities that the defendants, including HSBC Bank USA and our affiliates, may incur, jointly and/or severally, in the event of an adverse judgment or global settlement of one or all of these actions. The Agreements also cover any other potential or future actions that are transferred for coordinated pre-trial proceedings with MDL 1720. We continue to defend the claims in this action vigorously and our entry into the Agreements in no way serves as an admission as to the validity of the allegations in the complaints. Similarly, the Agreements have had no impact on our ability to quantify the potential impact from this action, if any, and we are unable to do so at this time.
 
Account Overdraft Litigation In February 2011, an action captioned Ofra Levin et al. v. HSBC Bank USA, N.A. et al.  (E.D.N.Y. 11-CV-0701) was filed in the Eastern District of New York against HSBC Bank USA, HSBC USA and HSBC North America on behalf of a putative nationwide class and New York sub-class of customers who allegedly incurred overdraft fees due to the posting of debit card transactions to deposit accounts in high-to-low order. Levin asserts claims for breach of contract and the implied covenant of good faith and fair dealing, conversion, unjust enrichment, and violation of the New York deceptive acts and practices statute. The plaintiffs dismissed the Federal court action after the case was transferred to the multi-district litigation pending in Miami, Florida, and re-filed the case in New York state court on March 1, 2011. The action, captioned Ofra Levin et al. v. HSBC Bank USA et al. (N.Y. Sup. Ct. 650562/11), alleges a variety of common law claims and violations on behalf of a New York class, including breach of contract and implied covenant of good faith and fair dealing, conversion, unjust enrichment and a violation of the New York deceptive acts and practices statute. We filed a motion to dismiss the complaint on May 2, 2011. At this time we are unable to reasonably estimate the liability, if any, that might arise as a result of this action and will defend the claims vigorously.
 
Madoff Litigation In December 2008, Bernard L. Madoff ("Madoff") was arrested for running a Ponzi scheme and a trustee was appointed for the liquidation of his firm, Bernard L. Madoff Investment Securities LLC ("Madoff Securities"), an SEC-registered broker-dealer and investment adviser. In December 2010, the Madoff Securities trustee commenced suits against various HSBC companies in U.S. bankruptcy court and in the English High Court. The U.S. action, captioned Picard v. HSBC et al (Bankr, S.D.N.Y. No. 09-01364), which also names certain funds, investment managers, and other entities and individuals, seeks $9 billion in damages and additional recoveries from HSBC Bank USA, certain of our foreign affiliates and the various other codefendants. It seeks damages against the HSBC defendants for allegedly aiding and abetting Madoff's fraud and breach of fiduciary duty. It also seeks, pursuant to U.S. bankruptcy law, recovery of unspecified amounts received by the HSBC defendants from funds invested with Madoff, including amounts that the HSBC defendants received when they redeemed units held in the various funds. The HSBC defendants acquired those fund units in connection with financing transactions the HSBC defendants had entered into with various clients. The trustee's U.S. bankruptcy law claims also seek recovery of fees earned by the HSBC defendants for providing custodial, administration and similar services to the funds. The trustee's English action seeks recovery of unspecified transfers of money from Madoff Securities to or through HSBC on the ground that the HSBC defendants actually or constructively knew of Madoff's fraud.
 
Between October 2009 and March 2011, Fairfield Sentry Limited and Fairfield Sigma Limited ("Fairfield"), funds whose assets were directly or indirectly invested with Madoff Securities, commenced multiple suits in the British Virgin Islands and the U.S. against numerous fund shareholders, including various HSBC companies that acted as nominees for clients of HSBC's private banking business and other clients who invested in the Fairfield funds. The Fairfield actions, including an action captioned Fairfield Sentry Ltd. v. Zurich Capital Markets et al. (Bankr. S.D.N.Y. No. 10-03634), in which HSBC Bank USA is a defendant, seek restitution of amounts paid to the defendants in connection with share redemptions, on the ground that such payments were made by mistake, based on inflated values resulting from Madoff's fraud.
 
These actions are at an early stage. There are many factors that may affect the range of possible outcomes, and the resulting financial impact, of the various Madoff-related proceedings including, but not limited to, the circumstances of the fraud, the multiple jurisdictions in which proceeding have been brought and the number of different plaintiffs and defendants in such proceedings. For these reasons, among others, we are unable to reasonably estimate the aggregate liability or ranges of liability that might arise as a result of these claims but it could be significant. In any event, we consider that we have good defenses to these claims and will continue to defend them vigorously.
 
Governmental and Regulatory Matters
 
Foreclosure Practices As previously reported, HSBC Bank USA and certain of our affiliates were among the servicers subject to the joint examination by the Federal Reserve Board (the "Federal Reserve") and the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (the "OCC") as part of their broad horizontal review of industry foreclosure practices. As a result of that review, HSBC Bank USA has entered into a consent cease and desist order with the OCC, (the OCC Servicing Consent Order") and our affiliate, HSBC Finance Corporation and our common indirect parent, HSBC North America, have entered into a similar consent order with the Federal Reserve (together with the OCC Servicing Consent Order, the "Servicing Consent Orders"). The OCC Servicing Consent Order requires HSBC Bank USA to take prescribed actions to address the deficiencies noted in the joint examination and described in the consent order. These actions include the submission of plans, programs, policies and procedures for:
 
 
•   strengthening board oversight of servicing operations, including oversight of risk management, internal audit and compliance programs;
 
 
•   coordinating communications with borrowers regarding loss mitigation and foreclosure;
 
 
•   governance of outsourcing of servicing, loss mitigation and foreclosure functions;
 
 
•   enhancing HSBC Bank USA's servicing compliance program;
 
 
•   enhancing control and oversight of the Mortgage Electronic Registration System related activities;
 
 
•   review and remediation, as necessary, of management information systems for servicing, loss mitigation and foreclosure activities;
 
 
•   improving compliance training regarding servicing, loss mitigation and foreclosure activities and communications with borrowers; and
 
 
•   enhancing internal audit of servicing, loss mitigation and foreclosure operations.
 
The OCC Servicing Consent Order also requires HSBC Bank USA to retain a consultant to review specified foreclosure proceedings and report on various aspects of our foreclosure processes, including whether any borrower was injured financially as a result of any identified deficiencies. HSBC Bank USA will be required to remediate deficiencies identified in any foreclosure filings or proceedings and reimburse or otherwise remediate borrowers where required. The OCC Servicing Consent Order also requires HSBC Bank USA to perform a comprehensive assessment of risk management in our servicing operations and to submit a risk management program to address, among other things, any findings of weaknesses in the risk assessment. HSBC Bank USA is required to submit quarterly progress reports to the OCC.
 
The Servicing Consent Orders do not preclude additional enforcement actions against HSBC Bank USA or HSBC North America by bank regulatory, governmental or law enforcement agencies, such as state Attorneys General, which could include the imposition of fines and actions to recover civil money penalties and other financial penalties relating to the activities that were the subject of the Servicing Consent Orders. We may also see an increase in private litigation concerning our practices. The Federal Reserve has indicated that it believes monetary sanctions are appropriate for the enforcement actions it recently announced and that it plans to announce monetary penalties. While we believe it is possible that civil money penalties will be imposed on HSBC Bank USA, we are unable at this time to estimate reliably the amounts, or range of possible amounts, of any such penalties.
 
Other Compliance Matters As previously disclosed, HSBC Bank USA has also entered into a consent cease and desist order with the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency and our indirect parent, HSBC North America, entered into a consent cease and desist order with the Federal Reserve in the first week of October 2010 (together, the "AML/BSA Consent Orders"). These actions require improvements for an effective compliance risk management program across our U.S. businesses, including Bank Secrecy Act ("BSA") and Anti-Money Laundering ("AML") compliance. Steps continue to be taken to address the requirements of these AML/BSA Consent Orders and to ensure that compliance and effective policies and procedures are maintained.
 
We are the subject of ongoing investigations, including Grand Jury subpoenas and other requests for information, by U.S. Government agencies, including the U.S. Attorney's Office, the U.S. Department of Justice and the New York County District Attorney's Office. These investigations pertain to, among other matters, our bank note business and dollar clearing services and their compliance with BSA and AML controls, as well as our compliance with Office of Foreign Assets Control ("OFAC") requirements, and adherence by certain customers to U.S. tax reporting requirements. On April 11, 2011, HSBC Bank USA received a "John Doe" summons from the Internal Revenue Service directing us to produce records identifying U.S. taxpayers with bank accounts at the India offices of our affiliate, The Hongkong and Shanghai Banking Corporation. In all cases, we are cooperating fully and engaging in efforts to resolve these matters.
 
The AML/BSA Consent Orders do not preclude additional enforcement actions against HSBC Bank USA or HSBC North America by bank regulatory or law enforcement agencies, including actions to recover civil money penalties, fines and other financial penalties relating to activities which were the subject of the AML/BSA Consent Orders and these could be significant. In addition, it is likely that there could be some form of formal enforcement action in respect to some or all of the ongoing investigations. Actual or threatened enforcement actions against other financial institutions for breaches of BSA, AML and OFAC requirements have resulted in settlements involving fines and penalties, some of which have been significant depending upon the individual circumstances of each action. The ongoing investigations are at an early stage. Based on the facts currently known, we are unable at this time to determine the terms on which the ongoing investigations will be resolved or the timing of such resolution or for us to estimate reliably the amounts, or range of possible amounts, of any fines and/or penalties. As matters progress, it is possible that any fines and/or penalties could be material to our financial statements.
 
Securitization Activity In addition to the repurchase risk described in Note 27, "Guarantee Arrangements," we have also been involved as a sponsor/seller of loans used to facilitate whole loan securitizations underwritten by our affiliate, HSBC Securities (USA) Inc. ("HSI"). In this regard, we began acquiring residential mortgage loans beginning in 2005 which were warehoused on our balance sheet with the intent of selling them to HSI to facilitate HSI's whole loan securitization program which was discontinued in the second half of 2007. During 2005-2007, we purchased and sold $24 billion of such loans to HSI which were subsequently securitized and sold by HSI to third parties. Based on the specifics of these transactions, the obligation to repurchase loans in the event of a breach of loan level representations and warranties resides predominantly with the organization that originated the loan.

 
While certain of these originators are or may become financially impaired and, therefore, unable to fulfill their repurchase obligations, we do not believe we have significant exposure for repurchases on these loans.
 
We have received three subpoenas from the SEC seeking production of documents and information relating to our involvement, and the involvement of our affiliates, in specified private-label residential mortgage-backed securities ("RMBS") transactions as an issuer, sponsor, underwriter, depositor, trustee or custodian as well as our involvement as a servicer. The first subpoena was received in December 2010, the second was received in February 2011 and the third was received in April 2011. In February 2011, we also received a subpoena from the U.S. Department of Justice (U.S. Attorneys Office, Southern District of New York) seeking production of documents and information relating to loss mitigation efforts with respect to HUD-insured mortgages on residential properties located in the State of New York.
 
20.  Fair Value Measurements
 
Accounting principles related to fair value measurements provide a framework for measuring fair value and focuses on an exit price in the principal (or alternatively, the most advantageous) market accessible in an orderly transaction between willing market participants (the "Fair Value Framework"). The Fair Value Framework establishes a three-tiered fair value hierarchy with Level 1 representing quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. Fair values determined by Level 2 inputs are inputs that are observable for the identical asset or liability, either directly or indirectly. Level 2 inputs include quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar assets or liabilities in markets that are inactive, and inputs other than quoted prices that are observable for the asset or liability, such as interest rates and yield curves that are observable at commonly quoted intervals. Level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs for the asset or liability and include situations where there is little, if any, market activity for the asset or liability. Transfers between leveling categories are recognized at the end of each reporting period.
 
Fair Value of Financial Instruments The fair value estimates, methods and assumptions set forth below for our financial instruments, including those financial instruments carried at cost, are made solely to comply with disclosures required by generally accepted accounting principles in the United States and should be read in conjunction with the financial statements and notes included in this quarterly report.

The following table summarizes the carrying value and estimated fair value of our financial instruments at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
 
March 31, 2011
December 31, 2010
 
Carrying
Value
Fair
Value
Carrying
Value
Fair
Value
 
(in millions)
Financial assets:
       
Short-term financial assets
$30,696
$30,696
$10,665
$10,665
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements
6,774
6,774
8,236
8,236
Non-derivative trading assets
26,448
26,448
26,390
26,390
Derivatives
7,278
7,278
6,891
6,891
Securities
42,797
43,004
48,713
48,923
Commercial loans, net of allowance for credit losses
30,575
31,073
29,735
30,154
Commercial loans designated under fair value option and held for sale
845
845
1,356
1,356
Consumer loans, net of allowance for credit losses
39,311
34,307
41,164
36,238
Consumer loans held for sale:
       
Residential mortgages
763
767
954
957
Other consumer
80
80
80
80
Financial liabilities:
       
Short-term financial liabilities
$17,853
$17,853
$18,031
$18,031
Deposits:
       
Without fixed maturities
103,397
103,397
95,457
95,457
Fixed maturities
21,053
21,076
17,808
17,845
Deposits designated under fair value option
8,311
8,311
7,386
7,386
Non-derivative trading liabilities
5,726
5,726
5,538
5,538
Derivatives
5,699
5,699
5,285
5,285
Long-term debt
11,607
11,764
11,862
12,026
Long-term debt designated under fair value option
5,379
5,379
5,368
5,368
 
Loan values presented in the table above were determined using the Fair Value Framework for measuring fair value, which is based on our best estimate of the amount within a range of value we believe would be received in a sale as of the balance sheet date (i.e. exit price). The secondary market demand and estimated value for our loans has been heavily influenced by the prevailing economic conditions during the past few years, including house price depreciation, rising unemployment, changes in consumer behavior, and changes in discount rates. Many investors are non-bank financial institutions or hedge funds with high equity levels and a high cost of debt. For certain consumer loans, investors incorporate numerous assumptions in predicting cash flows, such as higher charge-off levels and/or slower voluntary prepayment speeds than we, as the servicer of these loans, believe will ultimately be the case. The investor discount rates reflect this difference in overall cost of capital as well as the potential volatility in the underlying cash flow assumptions, the combination of which may yield a significant pricing discount from our intrinsic value. The estimated fair values at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 reflect these market conditions.
 

Assets and Liabilities Recorded at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis The following table presents information about our assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, and indicates the fair value hierarchy of the valuation techniques utilized to determine such fair value.
 
 
Fair Value Measurements on a Recurring Basis as of March 31, 2011
 
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
Gross
Balance
 
Netting(1)
Net
Balance
 
(in millions)
Assets:
           
Trading Securities, excluding derivatives:
           
U.S. Treasury, U.S. Government agencies and sponsored enterprises
$2,257
$126
$-
$2,383
$-
$2,383
Collateralized debt obligations
-
-
800
800
-
800
Asset-backed securities:
           
Residential mortgages
-
328
-
328
-
328
Home equity
-
2
-
2
-
2
Student loans
-
3
-
3
-
3
Corporate and other domestic debt securities
-
7,281
866
8,147
-
8,147
Debt Securities issued by foreign entities:
           
Corporate
-
443
269
712
-
712
Government
-
430
-
430
-
430
Equity securities
-
33
16
49
-
49
Precious metals trading
-
13,594
-
13,594
-
13,594
Derivatives(2):
           
Interest rate contracts
183
27,893
4
28,080
-
28,080
Foreign exchange contracts
19
17,094
211
17,324
-
17,324
Equity contracts
-
989
125
1,114
-
1,114
Precious metals contracts
-
867
20
887
-
887
Credit contracts
-
9,877
1,801
11,678
-
11,678
Other
-
1
-
1
-
1
Derivatives netting
-
-
-
-
(51,806)
(51,806)
Total derivatives
202
56,721
2,161
59,084
(51,806)
7,278
Securities  available-for-sale:
           
U.S. Treasury, U.S. Government agencies and sponsored enterprises
23,413
12,188
-
35,601
-
35,601
Obligations of U.S. states and political subdivisions
-
575
-
575
-
575
Asset-backed securities:
           
Residential mortgages
-
11
-
11
-
11
Commercial mortgages
-
514
-
514
-
514
Home equity
-
334
-
334
-
334
Student loans
-
25
-
25
-
25
Other
-
103
-
103
-
103
Corporate and other domestic debt securities
-
581
-
581
-
581
Debt Securities issued by foreign entities:
           
Corporate
-
967
-
967
-
967
Government
42
1,688
-
1,730
-
1,730
Equity securities
-
134
-
134
-
134
Loans(3)
-
802
12
814
-
814
Intangible(4)
-
-
396
396
-
396
Total assets
$25,914
$96,883
$4,520
$127,317
$(51,806)
$75,511
Liabilities:
           
Deposits in domestic offices(5)
$-
$4,233
$4,078
$8,311
$-
$8,311
Trading liabilities, excluding derivatives
240
5,486
-
5,726
-
5,726
Derivatives(2):
           
Interest rate contracts
96
28,354
-
28,450
-
28,450
Foreign exchange contracts
18
17,297
214
17,529
-
17,529
Equity contracts
-
825
169
994
-
994
Precious metals contracts
55
1,663
20
1,738
-
1,738
Credit contracts
-
10,671
725
11,396
-
11,396
Other
-
1
-
1
-
1
Derivatives netting
-
-
-
-
(54,409)
(54,409)
Total derivatives
169
58,811
1,128
60,108
(54,409)
5,699
Long-term debt(6)
-
5,183
196
5,379
-
5,379
Total liabilities
$409
$73,713
$5,402
$79,524
$(54,409)
$25,115
 
 
Fair Value Measurements on a Recurring Basis as of December 31, 2010
 
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
Gross
Balance
 
Netting(1)
Net
Balance
 
(in millions)
Assets:
           
Trading Securities, excluding derivatives:
           
U.S. Treasury, U.S. Government agencies and sponsored enterprises
$1,874
$694
$-
$2,568
$-
$2,568
Collateralized debt obligations
-
-
793
793
-
793
Asset-backed securities:
           
Residential mortgages
-
344
-
344
-
344
Home equity
-
6
-
6
-
6
Student loans
-
5
-
5
-
5
Corporate and other domestic debt securities
-
4,257
833
5,090
-
5,090
Debt Securities issued by foreign entities:
           
Corporate
-
133
243
376
-
376
Government
-
430
-
430
-
430
Equity securities
-
36
17
53
-
53
Precious metals trading
-
16,725
-
16,725
-
16,725
Derivatives(2):
           
Interest rate contracts
214
32,393
-
32,607
-
32,607
Foreign exchange contracts
23
16,233
207
16,463
-
16,463
Equity contracts
-
997
174
1,171
-
1,171
Precious metals contracts
-
982
22
1,004
-
1,004
Credit contracts
-
10,682
2,086
12,768
-
12,768
Other
-
-
4
4
-
4
Derivatives netting
-
-
-
-
(57,126)
(57,126)
Total derivatives
237
61,287
2,493
64,017
(57,126)
6,891
Securities  available-for-sale:
           
U.S. Treasury, U.S. Government agencies and sponsored enterprises
25,632
14,850
-
40,482
-
40,482
Obligations of U.S. states and political subdivisions
-
579
-
579
-
579
Asset-backed securities:
           
Residential mortgages
-
11
-
11
-
11
Commercial mortgages
-
552
-
552
-
552
Home equity
-
352
-
352
-
352
Student loans
-
27
-
27
-
27
Other
-
104
-
104
-
104
Corporate and other domestic debt securities
-
683
-
683
-
683
Debt Securities issued by foreign entities:
           
Government
41
2,564
-
2,605
-
2,605
Equity securities
-
128
-
128
-
128
Loans(3)
-
1,277
11
1,288
-
1,288
Intangible(4)
-
-
394
394
-
394
Total assets
$27,784
$105,044
$4,784
$137,612
$(57,126)
$80,486
Liabilities:
           
Deposits in domestic offices(5)
$-
$3,774
$3,612
$7,386
$-
$7,386
Trading liabilities, excluding derivatives
173
5,365
-
5,538
-
5,538
Derivatives(2):
           
Interest rate contracts
90
32,701
-
32,791
-
32,791
Foreign exchange contracts
15
16,520
211
16,746
-
16,746
Equity contracts
-
833
163
996
-
996
Precious metals contracts
101
1,951
21
2,073
-
2,073
Credit contracts
-
11,639
884
12,523
-
12,523
Other
8
10
5
23
-
23
Derivatives netting
-
-
-
-
(59,867)
(59,867)
Total derivatives
214
63,654
1,284
65,152
(59,867)
5,285
Long-term debt(6)
-
5,067
301
5,368
-
5,368
Total liabilities
$387
$77,860
$5,197
$83,444
$(59,867)
$23,577

 

____________
 
(1)
Represents counterparty and cash collateral netting which allow the offsetting of amounts relating to certain contracts if certain conditions are met.
   
(2)
Includes trading derivative assets of $6.5 billion and $6.0 billion and trading derivative liabilities of $5.4 billion and $5.0 billion as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, as well as derivatives held for hedging and commitments accounted for as derivatives.
   
(3)
Includes leveraged acquisition finance and other commercial loans held for sale or risk-managed on a fair value basis for which we have elected to apply the fair value option. See Note 7, "Loans Held for Sale," for further information.
   
(4)
Represents residential mortgage servicing rights. See Note 8, "Intangible Assets," for further information on residential mortgage servicing rights.
   
(5)
Represents structured deposits risk-managed on a fair value basis for which we have elected to apply the fair value option.
   
(6)
Includes structured notes and own debt issuances which we have elected to measure on a fair value basis.
 
Significant Transfers into/out of Levels 1 and 2 There were no significant transfers between levels 1 and 2 for the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010.
 
Information on Level 3 assets and liabilities The following table summarizes additional information about changes in the fair value of Level 3 assets and liabilities during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010. As a risk management practice, we may risk manage the Level 3 assets and liabilities, in whole or in part, using securities and derivative positions that are classified as Level 1 or Level 2 measurements within the fair value hierarchy. Since those Level 1 and Level 2 risk management positions are not included in the table below, the information provided does not reflect the effect of such risk management activities related to the Level 3 assets and liabilities.
 
   
Total Gains and (Losses) Included in(1)
             
 
 
Jan. 1,
2011
Trading
Revenue
(Loss)
 
Other
Revenue
Other
Comprehensive
Income
 
 
Purchases
 
 
Issuances
 
 
Settlements
Transfers
Into
Level 3
Transfers
Out of
Level 3
 
Mar. 31,
2011
Current Period
Unrealized
Gains (Losses)
 
(in millions)
Assets:
                     
Trading assets, excluding derivatives:
                     
Collateralized debt obligations
$793
$11
$-
$-
$-
$-
$(4)
$-
$-
$800
$4
Corporate and other domestic debt securities
833
12
-
-
21
-
-
-
-
866
12
Corporate debt securities issued by foreign entities
243
26
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
269
26
Equity securities
17
(1)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
16
(1)
Derivatives(2):
                     
Interest rate contracts
(1)
-
5
-
-
-
-
-
-
4
5
Foreign exchange contracts
(4)
1
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
(3)
1
Equity contracts
12
24
-
-
-
-
(71)
-
(10)
(45)
(35)
Credit contracts
1,202
(159)
-
-
-
-
(28)
-
62
1,077
(193)
Loans(3)
11
-
-
-
-
-
1
-
-
12
-
Other assets, excluding derivatives(4)
394
-
(14)
-
-
-
16
-
-
396
(14)
Total assets
$3,500
$(86)
$(9)
$-
$21
$-
$(86)
$-
$52
$3,392
$(195)
Liabilities:
                     
Deposits in domestic offices
$3,612
$18
$-
$-
$-
$553
$(98)
$8
$(15)
4,078
$13
Long-term debt
301
9
-
-
-
74
(115)
-
(73)
196
(2)
Total liabilities
$3,913
$27
$-
$-
$-
$627
$(213)
$8
$(88)
$4,274
$11
 
   
Total Gains and (Losses) Included in(1)
           
Current
   
Trading
 
Other
     
Transfers
Transfers
 
Period
 
Jan. 1,
Revenue
Other
Comprehensive
     
Into
Out of
Mar. 31,
Unrealized
 
2010
(Loss)
Revenue
Income
Purchases
Issuances
Settlements
Level 3
Level 3
2010
Gains (Losses)
 
(in millions)
Assets:
                     
Trading assets, excluding derivatives:
                     
Collateralized debt obligations
$831
$25
$-
$-
$222
$-
$(324)
$-
$-
$754
$11
Asset-backed securities:
                     
Residential mortgages
817
13
-
-
94
-
(119)
21
-
826
15
Commercial mortgages
4
-
-
-
-
-
(1)
-
(3)
-
-
Home equity
25
-
-
-
-
-
(2)
3
-
26
(2)
Corporate and other domestic debt securities
1,202
(31)
-
-
25
-
(368)
-
(184)
644
15
Corporate debt securities issued by foreign entities
196
27
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
223
27
Equity securities
21
(1)
-
-
-
-
(1)
-
-
19
(1)
Derivatives(2):
                     
Foreign exchange contracts
(95)
(25)
-
-
-
-
1
-
-
(119)
(24)
Equity contracts
81
83
-
-
-
-
(57)
(58)
1
50
45
Credit contracts
1,311
(181)
-
-
-
-
(70)
218
66
1,344
(425)
Other
(4)
-
6
-
-
-
(1)
-
-
1
2
Securities  available-for-sale:
                     
U.S. Treasury, U.S. Government agencies and sponsored enterprises
3
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
(3)
-
-
Asset-backed securities:
                     
Residential mortgages
515
-
-
16
-
-
(71)
73
(4)
529
11
Commercial mortgages
8
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
8
-
Home equity
175
-
-
45
-
-
(5)
-
-
215
42
Auto
42
-
-
-
-
-
(14)
-
-
28
-
Student loans
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
12
-
12
-
Loans(3)
4
-
-
-
-
-
-
11
(3)
12
-
Other assets, excluding derivatives(4)
450
-
21
-
-
-
(27)
-
-
444
21
Total assets
$5,586
$(90)
$27
$61
$341
$-
$(1,059)
$280
$(130)
$5,016
$(263)
Liabilities:
                     
Deposits in domestic offices
$1,643
$71
$-
$-
$-
$310
$(74)
$7
$(17)
$1,940
$(53)
Long-term debt
419
12
-
-
-
209
(29)
-
(7)
604
(13)
Total liabilities
$2,062
$83
$-
$-
$-
$519
$(103)
$7
$(24)
$2,544
$(66)
____________
 
(1)
Includes realized and unrealized gains and losses.
   
(2)
Level 3 net derivatives included derivative assets of $2.2 billion and $3.0 billion and derivative liabilities of $1.1 billion and $1.8 billion as of March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
   
(3)
Includes Level 3 corporate lending activities risk-managed on a fair value basis for which we have elected the fair value option.
   
(4)
Represents residential mortgage servicing activities. See Note 8, "Intangible Assets," for additional information.
 
Material Additions to and Transfers Into (Out of) Level 3 Measurements During the three months ended March 31, 2011, we transferred $62 million of credit derivatives from Level 3 to Level 2 as a result of a qualitative analysis of the foreign exchange and credit correlation attributes of our model used for certain credit default swaps.
 
During the three months ended March 31, 2010, we transferred $218 million of credit derivatives from Level 2 to Level 3 as a result of a qualitative analysis of the foreign exchange and credit correlation attributes of our model used for certain credit default swaps. In addition, we transferred $109 million of mortgage and other asset-backed securities from Level 2 to Level 3 as the availability of observable inputs declined and the discrepancy in valuation per independent pricing services increased. We transferred $184 million of corporate bonds from Level 3 to Level 2 due to the availability of observable inputs in the market including broker and independent pricing service valuations.
 
Assets and Liabilities Recorded at Fair Value on a Non-recurring Basis Certain financial and non-financial assets are measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis and therefore, are not included in the tables above. These assets include (a) mortgage and consumer loans classified as held for sale reported at the lower of cost or fair value and (b) impaired loans or assets that are written down to fair value based on the valuation of underlying collateral during the period. These instruments are not measured at fair value on an ongoing basis but are subject to fair value adjustment in certain circumstances (e.g., impairment). The following table presents the fair value hierarchy level within which the fair value of the financial and non-financial assets has been recorded as of March 31, 2011 and 2010. The gains (losses) during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010 are also included.
 
   
Total Gains
   
(Losses)
   
For the
 
Non-Recurring Fair Value Measurements
Three Months
 
as of March 31, 2011
Ended Mar. 31,
 
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total
2011
 
(in millions)
Residential mortgage loans held for sale(1)
$-
$175
$328
$503
$5
Other consumer loans held for sale(1)
-
-
80
80
-
Impaired loans(2)
-
-
457
457
1
Real estate owned(3)
-
73
-
73
(3)
Commercial loans held for sale
-
33
-
33
-
Impairment of certain previously capitalized software development costs(4)
-
-
-
-
(78)
Building held for use
-
-
13
13
-
Total assets at fair value on a non-recurring basis
$-
$281
$878
$1,159
$(75)
 
   
Total Gains
   
(Losses)
   
For the
 
Non-Recurring Fair Value Measurements
Three Months
 
as of March 31, 2010
Ended Mar. 31,
 
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total
2010
 
(in millions)
Residential mortgage loans held for sale(1)
$-
$150
$761
$911
$(5)
Other consumer loans held for sale(1)
-
-
28
28
-
Impaired loans(2)
-
-
718
718
5
Real estate owned(3)
-
63
-
63
1
Repossessed vehicles(3)
-
5
-
5
-
Commercial loans held for sale
-
3
-
3
-
Held-to-maturity asset-backed securities held by consolidated VIE(5)
-
-
254
254
(5)
Building held for use
-
-
15
15
-
Total assets at fair value on a non-recurring basis
$-
$221
$1,776
$1,997
$(4)
____________
 
(1)
As of March 31, 2011 and 2010, the fair value of the loans held for sale was below cost. Certain residential mortgage loans held for sale have been classified as a Level 3 fair value measurement within the fair value hierarchy as the underlying real estate properties which determine fair value are illiquid assets as a result of market conditions and significant inputs in estimating fair value were unobservable. Additionally, the fair value of these properties is affected by, among other things, the location, the payment history and the completeness of the loan documentation.
   
(2)
Represents impaired commercial loans. Certain commercial loans have undergone troubled debt restructurings and are considered impaired. As a matter of practical expedient, we measure the credit impairment of a collateral-dependent loan based on the fair value of the collateral asset. The collateral often involves real estate properties that are illiquid due to market conditions. As a result, these commercial loans are classified as a Level 3 fair value measurement within the fair value hierarchy.
   
(3)
Real estate owned and repossessed vehicles are required to be reported on the balance sheet net of transactions costs. The real estate owned and repossessed vehicle amounts in the table above reflect the fair value unadjusted for transaction costs.
   
(4)
In the first quarter of 2011 it was determined that certain previously capitalized software development costs were no longer realizable as a result of the decision to cancel certain projects and, therefore, we recorded an impairment charge of $78 million representing the full amount of the developed software capitalized associated with these projects. The impairment charge was recorded in other expenses in our consolidated statement of income and is included in the results of our PFS segment.
   
(5)
Represent held-to-maturity securities which were held at fair value at March 31, 2010. See Note 17, "Variable Interest Entities," for additional information.
 
Valuation Techniques Following is a description of valuation methodologies used for assets and liabilities recorded at fair value and for estimating fair value for those financial instruments not recorded at fair value for which fair value disclosure is required.
 
Short-term financial assets and liabilities - The carrying value of certain financial assets and liabilities recorded at cost is considered to approximate fair value because they are short-term in nature, bear interest rates that approximate market rates, and generally have negligible credit risk. These items include cash and due from banks, interest bearing deposits with banks, accrued interest receivable, customer acceptance assets and liabilities and short-term borrowings.
 
Federal funds sold and purchased and securities purchased and sold under resale and repurchase agreements - Federal funds sold and purchased and securities purchased and sold under resale and repurchase agreements are recorded at cost. A significant majority of these transactions are short-term in nature and, as such, the recorded amounts approximate fair value. For transactions with long-dated maturities, fair value is based on dealer quotes for instruments with similar terms and collateral.
 
Loans - Except for leveraged loans, selected residential mortgage loans and certain foreign currency denominated commercial loans, we do not record loans at fair value on a recurring basis. From time to time, we record on a non-recurring basis negative adjustment to loans. The write-downs can be based on observable market price of the loan or the underlying collateral value. In addition, fair value estimates are determined based on the product type, financial characteristics, pricing features and maturity. Where applicable, similar loans are grouped based on loan types and maturities and fair values are estimated on a portfolio basis.
 
 
•   Mortgage Loans Held for Sale - Certain residential mortgage loans are classified as held for sale and are recorded at the lower of cost or fair value. The fair value of these mortgage loans is determined based on the valuation information observed in alternative exit markets, such as the whole loan market, adjusted for portfolio specific factors. These factors include the location of the collateral, the loan-to-value ratio, the estimated rate and timing of default, the probability of default or foreclosure and loss severity if foreclosure does occur.
 
 
•   Leveraged Loans - We record leveraged loans and revolvers held for sale at fair value. Where available, market consensus pricing obtained from independent sources is used to estimate the fair value of the leveraged loans and revolvers. In determining the fair value, we take into consideration the number of participants submitting pricing information, the range of pricing information and distribution, the methodology applied by the pricing services to cleanse the data and market liquidity. Where consensus pricing information is not available, fair value is estimated using observable market prices of similar instruments or inputs, including bonds, credit derivatives, and loans with similar characteristics. Where observable market parameters are not available, fair value is determined based on contractual cash flows, adjusted for the probability of default and estimated recoveries where applicable, discounted at the rate demanded by market participants under current market conditions. In those cases, we also consider the loan specific attributes and inherent credit risk and risk mitigating factors such as collateral arrangements in determining fair value.
 
 
•   Commercial Loans - Commercial loans and commercial real estate loans are valued by discounting the contractual cash flows, adjusted for prepayments and the borrower's credit risk, using a discount rate that

 
  reflects the current rates offered to borrowers of similar credit standing for the remaining term to maturity and our own estimate of liquidity premium.
 
 
•   Commercial impaired loans - Fair value is determined based on the pricing quotes obtained from an independent third party appraisal.
 
 
•   Consumer Loans - The estimated fair value of our consumer loans were determined by developing an approximate range of value from a mix of various sources as appropriate for the respective pool of assets. These sources included, among other things, value estimates from an HSBC affiliate which reflect over-the-counter trading activity, forward looking discounted cash flow models using assumptions we believe are consistent with those which would be used by market participants in valuing such receivables; trading input from other market participants which includes observed primary and secondary trades; where appropriate, the impact of current estimated rating agency credit tranching levels with the associated benchmark credit spreads; and general discussions held directly with potential investors.
 
Model inputs include estimates of future interest rates, prepayment speeds, loss curves and market discount rates reflecting management's estimate of the rate that would be required by investors in the current market given the specific characteristics and inherent credit risk of the receivables. Some of these inputs are influenced by home price changes and unemployment rates. To the extent available, such inputs are derived principally from or corroborated by observable market data by correlation and other means. We perform periodic validations of our valuation methodologies and assumptions based on the results of actual sales of such receivables. In addition, from time to time, we may engage a third party valuation specialist to measure the fair value of a pool of receivables. Portfolio risk management personnel provide further validation through discussions with third party brokers and other market participants. Since an active market for these receivables does not exist, the fair value measurement process uses unobservable significant inputs specific to the performance characteristics of the various receivable portfolios.
 
Lending-related commitments - The fair value of commitments to extend credit, standby letters of credit and financial guarantees are not included in the table. The majority of the lending related commitments are not carried at fair value on a recurring basis nor are they actively traded. These instruments generate fees, which approximate those currently charged to originate similar commitments, which are recognized over the term of the commitment period. Deferred fees on commitments and standby letters of credit totaled $49 million and $47 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
 
Precious metals trading - Precious metals trading primarily include physical inventory which are valued using spot prices.
 
Securities - Where available, debt and equity securities are valued based on quoted market prices. If a quoted market price for the identical security is not available, the security is valued based on quotes from similar securities, where possible. For certain securities, internally developed valuation models are used to determine fair values or validate quotes obtained from pricing services. The following summarizes the valuation methodology used for our major security classes:
 
 
•   U.S. Treasury, U.S. Government agency issued or guaranteed and Obligations of U.S. state and political subdivisions - As these securities transact in an active market, fair value measurements are based on quoted prices for the identical security or quoted prices for similar securities with adjustments as necessary made using observable inputs which are market corroborated.
 
 
•   U.S. Government sponsored enterprises - For certain government sponsored mortgage-backed securities which transact in an active market, fair value measurements are based on quoted prices for the identical security or quoted prices for similar securities with adjustments as necessary made using observable inputs which are market corroborated. For government sponsored mortgage-backed securities which do not transact in an active market, fair value is determined primarily based on pricing information obtained from pricing services and is verified by internal review processes.
 
 
•   Asset-backed securities, including collateralized debt obligations - Fair value is primarily determined based on pricing information obtained from independent pricing services adjusted for the characteristics and the performance of the underlying collateral.
 
Additional information relating to asset-backed securities and collateralized debt obligations is presented in the following tables:
 
Trading asset-backed securities and related collateral:
 
   
Prime
Alt-A
Sub-prime
 
Rating of Securities:
Collateral Type:
Level 2
Level 3
Level 2
Level 3
Level 2
Level 3
Total
 
(in millions)
AAA -A
Residential mortgages
$3
$-
$82
$-
$236
$-
$321
 
Home equity
-
-
2
-
-
-
2
 
Student loans
-
-
3
-
-
-
3
 
Other
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Total AAA -A
3
-
87
-
236
-
326
BBB -B
Residential mortgages
-
-
3
-
-
-
3
 
Home equity
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Total BBB -B
-
-
3
-
-
-
3
CCC-Unrated
Residential mortgages
-
-
-
-
4
-
4
 
Home equity
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Other
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Total CCC -Unrated
-
-
-
-
4
-
4
   
$3
$-
$90
$-
$240
$-
$333
 
Trading collateralized debt obligations and related collateral:
 
Rating of Securities:
Collateral Type:
Level 3
 
(in millions)
AAA -A
Commercial mortgages
$-
 
Residential mortgages
9
 
Other
-
 
Total AAA -A
9
BBB -B
Commercial mortgages
195
 
Corporate loans
315
 
Other
153
 
Total BBB -B
663
CCC -Unrated
Commercial mortgages
65
 
Corporate loans
-
 
Residential mortgages
-
 
Other
63
 
Total CCC -Unrated
128
   
$800
 

 

Available-for-sale securities backed by collateral:
 
   
Commercial
Mortgages
 
Prime
 
Alt-A
 
Sub-prime
 
Rating of Securities:
Collateral Type:
Level 2
Level 3
Level 2
Level 3
Level 2
Level 3
Level 2
Level 3
Total
 
                                                  (in millions)
AAA -A
Residential mortgages
$-
$-
$-
$-
$6
$-
$-
$-
$6
 
Commercial mortgages
514
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
514
 
Home equity
-
-
-
-
147
-
2
-
149
 
Student loans
-
-
-
-
25
-
-
-
25
 
Other
-
-
-
-
103
-
-
-
103
 
Total AAA -A
514
-
-
-
281
-
2
-
797
BBB -B
Residential mortgages
-
-
-
-
1
-
-
-
1
 
Home equity
-
-
-
-
100
-
1
-
101
 
Total BBB -B
-
-
-
-
101
-
1
-
102
CCC -Unrated
Residential mortgages
-
-
-
-
4
-
-
-
4
 
Home equity
-
-
-
-
84
-
-
-
84
 
Total CCC -Unrated
-
-
-
-
88
-
-
-
88
   
$514
$-
$-
$-
$470
$-
$3
$-
$987
 
 
•   Other domestic debt and foreign debt securities (corporate and government) - For non-callable corporate securities, a credit spread scale is created for each issuer. These spreads are then added to the equivalent maturity U.S. Treasury yield to determine current pricing. Credit spreads are obtained from the new market, secondary trading levels and dealer quotes. For securities with early redemption features, an option adjusted spread ("OAS") model is incorporated to adjust the spreads determined above. Additionally, we survey the broker/dealer community to obtain relevant trade data including benchmark quotes and updated spreads.
 
 
•   Equity securities - Since most of our securities are transacted in active markets, fair value measurements are determined based on quoted prices for the identical security. For mutual fund investments, we receive monthly statements from the investment manager with the estimated fair value.
 
We perform validations of the fair values obtained from independent pricing services. Such validations primarily include sourcing security prices from other independent pricing services or broker quotes. As the pricing for mortgage and other asset-backed securities became less transparent during the credit crisis, we further developed internal valuation techniques to validate the fair value. The internal validation techniques utilize inputs derived from observable market data, incorporate external analysts' estimates of probability of default, loss recovery and prepayments speeds and apply the discount rates that would be demanded by market participants under the current market conditions. Depending on the results of the validation, additional information may be gathered from other market participants to support the fair value measurements. A determination is made as to whether adjustments to the observable inputs are necessary after investigations and inquiries about the reasonableness of the inputs used and the methodologies employed by the independent pricing services.
 
Derivatives - Derivatives are recorded at fair value. Asset and liability positions in individual derivatives that are covered by legally enforceable master netting agreements, including cash collateral are offset and presented net in accordance with accounting principles which allow the offsetting of amounts relating to certain contracts.
 
Derivatives traded on an exchange are valued using quoted prices. OTC derivatives, which comprise a majority of derivative contract positions, are valued using valuation techniques. The fair value for the majority of our derivative instruments are determined based on internally developed models that utilize independently corroborated market parameters, including interest rate yield curves, option volatilities, and currency rates. For complex or long-dated derivative products where market data is not available, fair value may be affected by the choice of valuation model and the underlying assumptions about, among other things, the timing of cash flows and credit spreads. The fair
values of certain structured derivative products are sensitive to unobservable inputs such as default correlations of the referenced credit and volatilities of embedded options. These estimates are susceptible to significant change in future periods as market conditions change.
 
Significant inputs related to derivative classes are broken down as follows:
 
 
•   Credit Derivatives - Use credit default curves and recovery rates which are generally provided by broker quotes and various pricing services. Certain credit derivatives may also use correlation inputs in their model valuation. Correlation is derived using market quotes from brokers and various pricing services.
 
 
•   Interest Rate Derivatives - Swaps use interest rate curves based on currency that are actively quoted by brokers and other pricing services. Options will also use volatility inputs which are also quoted in the broker market.
 
 
•   Foreign Exchange ("FX") Derivatives - FX transactions use spot and forward FX rates which are quoted in the broker market.
 
 
•   Equity Derivatives - Use listed equity security pricing and implied volatilities from equity traded options position.
 
 
•   Precious Metal Derivative - Use spot and forward metal rates which are quoted in the broker market.
 
We may adjust valuations derived using the methods described above in order to ensure that those values represent appropriate estimates of fair value. These adjustments, which are applied consistently over time, are generally required to reflect factors such as bid-ask spreads and counterparty credit risk that can affect prices in arms-length transactions with unrelated third parties. Such adjustments are based on management judgment and may not be observable.
 
Real estate owned - Fair value is determined based on third party appraisals obtained at the time we take title to the property and, if less than the carrying value of the loan, the carrying value of the loan is adjusted to the fair value. The carrying value is further reduced, if necessary, on a quarterly basis to reflect observable local market data including local area sales data.
 
Repossessed autos - Fair value is determined based on current Black Book values, which represent current observable prices in the wholesale auto auction market.
 
Mortgage servicing rights - We elected to measure residential mortgage servicing rights, which are classified as intangible assets, at fair value. The fair value for the residential mortgage servicing rights is determined based on an option adjusted approach which involves discounting servicing cash flows under various interest rate projections at risk-adjusted rates. The valuation model also incorporates our best estimate of the prepayment speed of the mortgage loans, current cost to service and discount rates which are unobservable. As changes in interest rates is a key factor affecting the prepayment speed and hence the fair value of the mortgage servicing rights, we use various interest rate derivatives and forward purchase contracts of mortgage-backed securities to risk-manage the mortgage servicing rights.
 
Structured notes - Certain structured notes were elected to be measured at fair value in their entirety under fair value option accounting principles. As a result, derivative features embedded in the structured notes are included in the valuation of fair value. The valuation of embedded derivatives may include significant unobservable inputs such as correlation of the referenced credit names or volatility of the embedded option. Other significant inputs include interest rates (yield curve), time to maturity, expected loss and loss severity.
 
Cash flows of the funded notes are discounted at the appropriate rate for the applicable duration of the instrument adjusted for our own credit spreads. The credit spreads applied to these instruments are derived from the spreads at which institutions of similar credit standing would offer for issuing similar structured instruments as of the measurement date. The market spreads for structured notes are generally lower than the credit spreads observed for plain vanilla debt or in the credit default swap market.

 
Long-term debt - We elected to apply fair value option to certain own debt issuances for which fair value hedge accounting otherwise would have been applied. These own debt issuances elected under FVO are traded in secondary markets and, as such, the fair value is determined based on observed prices for the specific instrument. The observed market price of these instruments reflects the effect of our own credit spreads. The credit spreads applied to these instruments were derived from the spreads recognized in the secondary market for similar debt as of the measurement date.
 
For long-term debt recorded at cost, fair value is determined based on quoted market prices where available. If quoted market prices are not available, fair value is based on dealer quotes, quoted prices of similar instruments, or internally developed valuation models adjusted for own credit risks.
 
Deposits - For fair value disclosure purposes, the carrying amount of deposits with no stated maturity (e.g., demand, savings, and certain money market deposits), which represents the amount payable upon demand, is considered to approximate fair value. For deposits with fixed maturities, fair value is estimated by discounting cash flows using market interest rates currently offered on deposits with similar characteristics and maturities.
 
Valuation adjustments - Where applicable, we make valuation adjustments to the measurements of financial instruments to ensure that they are recorded at fair value. Management judgment is required in determining the appropriate level of valuation adjustments. The level of valuation adjustments reflects the risks and the characteristics of a specific type of product, related contractual terms and the liquidity associated with the product and the market in which the product transacts. Valuation adjustments for complex instruments are unobservable. Such valuation adjustments, which have been consistently applied, include the following:
 
 
•   Credit risk adjustment - an adjustment to reflect the creditworthiness of the counterparty for OTC products where the market parameters may not be indicative of the creditworthiness of the counterparty. For derivative instruments, the market price implies parties to the transaction have credit ratings equivalent to AA. Therefore, we will make an appropriate credit risk adjustment to reflect the counterparty credit risk if different from an AA credit rating.
 
 
•   Market data/model uncertainty - an adjustment to reflect uncertainties in the fair value measurements determined based on unobservable market data inputs. Since one or more significant parameters may be unobservable and must be estimated, the resultant fair value estimates have inherent measurement risk. In addition, the values derived from valuation techniques are affected by the choice of valuation model. When different valuation techniques are available, the choice of valuation model can be subjective and in those cases, an additional valuation adjustment may be applied to mitigate the potential risk of measurement error. In most cases, we perform analysis on key unobservable inputs to determine the appropriate parameters to use in estimating the fair value adjustments.
 
 
•   Liquidity adjustment - a type of bid-offer adjustment to reflect the difference between the mark-to-market valuation of all open positions in the portfolio and the close out cost. The liquidity adjustment is a portfolio level adjustment and is a function of the liquidity and volatility of the underlying risk positions.
 
21.  New Accounting Pronouncements
 
Clarifications to Accounting for Troubled Debt Restructurings by Creditors In April 2011, the FASB issued an Accounting Standards Update which provides additional guidance to assist creditors in determining whether a restructuring of a receivable meets the criteria to be considered a troubled debt restructuring, for purposes of the identification and disclosure of troubled debt restructurings, as well as for recording impairment. For purposes of identifying and disclosing troubled debt restructurings, the new guidance would be effective for interim and annual reporting periods beginning on or after June 15, 2011, and would be applied retrospectively to restructurings occurring on or after January 1, 2011. For purposes of measuring impairment of a receivable restructured in a troubled debt restructuring, the proposed clarifications would be effective on a prospective basis for interim and annual periods beginning on or after June 15, 2011, with retrospective application permitted. If an entity applies the proposed clarifications prospectively for impairment measurement, it must disclose the total amount of receivables and the allowance for credit losses as of the end of the period of adoption related to those receivables that have now been identified as troubled debt restructurings. We currently believe the impact of adopting this Accounting Standards Update will not result in significant changes to either our reported troubled debt restructures or our allowance for credit losses.
 
This Accounting Standards Update also clarified the effective date for new disclosure requirements for troubled debt restructurings. The new disclosure requirements for trouble debt restructurings will also be effective for interim and annual periods beginning on or after June 15, 2011.
 
Accounting for Costs Associated with Acquiring or Renewing Insurance Contracts In October 2010, the FASB issued guidance which amends the accounting rules that define which costs associated with acquiring or renewing insurance contracts qualify as deferrable acquisition costs by insurance entities. The guidance is effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those fiscal years, beginning after December 15, 2011. Early adoption is permitted, but must be applied as of the beginning of an entity's annual reporting period. The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on our financial position or results of operations.
 

 

Item 2. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
 
Forward-Looking Statements
 
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations ("MD&A") should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements, notes and tables included elsewhere in this report and with our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2010 (the "2010 Form 10-K"). MD&A may contain certain statements that may be forward-looking in nature within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. In addition, we may make or approve certain statements in future filings with the SEC, in press releases, or oral or written presentations by representatives of HSBC USA Inc. that are not statements of historical fact and may also constitute forward-looking statements. Words such as "may," "will," "should," "would," "could," "appears," "believe," "intends," "expects," "estimates," "targeted," "plans," "anticipates," "goal" and similar expressions are intended to identify forward-looking statements but should not be considered as the only means through which these statements may be made. These matters or statements will relate to our future financial condition, economic forecast, results of operations, plans, objectives, performance or business developments and will involve known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other factors that may cause our actual results, performance or achievements to be materially different from that which was expressed or implied by such forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements are based on our current views and assumptions and speak only as of the date they are made. HSBC USA Inc. undertakes no obligation to update any forward-looking statement to reflect subsequent circumstances or events.
 
Executive Overview
 
HSBC USA Inc. is an indirect wholly owned subsidiary of HSBC Holdings plc ("HSBC"). HSBC USA Inc. may also be referred to in MD&A as "we", "us", or "our".
 
The following discussion of our financial condition and results of operations excludes the results of our discontinued operations from all periods presented unless otherwise noted. See Note 2, "Discontinued Operations," in the accompanying consolidated financial statement for further discussion of these operations.
 
Current Environment During the first three months of 2011, economic conditions in the United States continued to improve. While the pace of improvement has generally been slow, there are signs the recovery is gaining momentum as job growth in the first quarter showed moderate improvement. However, serious threats to economic growth remain including rising oil prices, continued pressure and uncertainty in the housing market and elevated unemployment levels. Marketplace liquidity continues to remain ample and companies in the financial sector continue to be able to issue debt with credit spreads approaching levels historically seen prior to the financial crisis, despite the expiration of some of the U.S. government's support programs. The prolonged period of low Federal funds rates continues to put pressure on spreads earned on our deposit base. During the first quarter of 2011, we continued to see home prices decline in many markets as housing prices remain under pressure due to elevated foreclosure levels. How sustainable these improvements will be in the absence of government actions remains to be seen.
 
While job creation in the private sector improved during the first quarter of 2011, there continues to be uncertainty as to how pronounced the economic recovery will be. Despite an increasing trend in consumer spending, consumer confidence continues to be low based on historical standards and after posting five consecutive months of improvement, fell again during March raising questions about the continued willingness by consumers to spend in the coming months, particularly if oil prices continue to rise. U.S. unemployment rates, which have been a major factor in the deterioration of credit quality in the U.S., improved but remained high at 8.8 percent in March 2011, decreasing from a rate of 9.4 percent at December 2010. However, a significant number of U.S. residents are no longer looking for work and, therefore, are not reflected in the U.S. unemployment rates. Unemployment rates in 23 states are at or above the U.S. national average and unemployment rates in four states are at or above 11 percent while in New York, where approximately 27 percent of our loan portfolio is concentrated, unemployment remained lower than the national average at 8 percent. High unemployment rates have generally been most pronounced in the markets which had previously experienced the highest appreciation in home values. Unemployment has continued to have an impact on the provision for credit losses in our loan portfolio and in loan portfolios across the industry.
 
Concerns about the future of the U.S. economy, including the pace and magnitude of recovery from the recent economic recession, consumer confidence, volatility in energy prices, credit market volatility and trends in corporate earnings will continue to influence the U.S. economic recovery and the capital markets. In particular, continued improvement in unemployment rates, a sustained recovery of the housing markets and stabilization in energy prices remain critical components of a broader U.S. economic recovery. Further weakening in these components as well as in consumer confidence may result in additional deterioration in consumer payment patterns and credit quality. Weak consumer fundamentals including declines in wage income, wealth and a difficult job market continue to depress consumer confidence. Additionally, there is uncertainty as to the future course of monetary policy and uncertainty as to the impact on the economy and consumer confidence when the remaining actions taken by the government to restore faith in the capital markets and stimulate consumer spending end. These conditions in combination with the impact of recent regulatory changes, including the continued implementation of the "Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010" ("Dodd-Frank") will continue to impact our results through 2011 and beyond, the degree of which is largely dependent upon the nature and extent of the economic recovery.
 
Due to the significant slow-down in foreclosures, and in some instances, cessation of all foreclosure processing by numerous loan servicers, including us, for some period of time during the remainder of 2011 there may be a reduction in the number of properties being marketed following foreclosure. The impact of that decrease may increase demand for properties currently on the market resulting in a stabilization of home prices but could also result in a larger number of vacant properties in communities creating downward pressure on general property values. As a result, the short term impact of the foreclosure processing delay is highly uncertain. However, the longer term impact is even more uncertain as eventually servicers will again begin to foreclose and market properties in large numbers which is likely to create a significant over-supply of housing inventory. This could lead to an increase in loss severity on owned real estate properties.
 
Recent Regulatory Developments As previously reported, HSBC Bank USA and certain of our affiliates were among the servicers subject to the joint examination by the Federal Reserve Board (the "Federal Reserve") and the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (the "OCC") as part of their broad horizontal review of industry foreclosure practices. As a result of that review, HSBC Bank USA has entered into a consent cease and desist order with the OCC, (the OCC Servicing Consent Order") and our affiliate and our common indirect parent, HSBC Finance Corporation and HSBC North America Holdings Inc. ("HSBC North America"), respectively, have entered into a similar consent order with the Federal Reserve (together with the OCC Servicing Consent Order, the "Servicing Consent Orders"). The OCC Servicing Consent Order requires HSBC Bank USA to take prescribed actions to address the deficiencies noted in the joint examination and described in the consent order. See Note 19, "Litigation and Regulatory Matters" in the accompanying consolidated financial statements for further discussion of these actions.
 
The requirements of the Servicing Consent Orders will increase our operational, reputational and legal risk profiles and implementation of its provisions will require additional financial and managerial resources. In addition, the Servicing Consent Orders do not preclude additional enforcement actions against HSBC Bank USA or HSBC North America by bank regulatory, governmental or law enforcement agencies, including the imposition of fines and actions to recover civil money penalties and other financial penalties relating to the activities that were the subject of the Servicing Consent Orders. We may also see an increase in private litigation concerning our practices.
 
HSBC Bank USA and its affiliates take these regulatory matters very seriously, and we have been working closely with our regulators to address these issues quickly and efficiently. Additionally, we have already made several key procedural improvements to enhance our foreclosure processes as a result of our own internal reviews. We have resumed foreclosures on a limited basis in certain geographies. It will be a number of months before we resume foreclosures in all jurisdictions as we need to ensure we are satisfied that applicable enhanced processes have been implemented.
 
HSBC Bank USA remains committed to assisting customers who are experiencing financial difficulties, and we will continue to review our policies and processes to make modification and other account management alternatives for the
benefit of our customers more easily accessible to those in need of assistance. Home preservation continues to be a cornerstone of our business, and foreclosure is viewed as a last resort. Foreclosure proceedings are only instituted when other reasonable alternatives have been exhausted and where the borrower is seriously delinquent. We also offer assistance, including financial, to those wishing to leave a property without having to go through the foreclosure process.
 
Performance, Developments and Trends Income from continuing operations was $480 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 compared to $544 million during the three months ended March 31, 2010. Income from continuing operations before income tax was $562 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 compared to $858 million in the prior year quarter, driven by lower net interest income, lower other revenues and higher operating expenses, partially offset by lower provisions for credit losses. Our results in both periods were impacted by the change in the fair value of our own debt and the related derivatives for which we have elected fair value option and certain other non-recurring items which distort the ability of investors to compare the underlying performance trends of our business. The following table summarizes the collective impact of these items on our income from continuing operations before income tax for all periods presented:
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Income from continuing operations before income tax, as reported
$562
$858
Change in value of our own fair value option debt and related derivatives
15
(33)
Impairment of software development costs
78
-
Gain relating to resolution of lawsuit(1)
-
(5)
Gain on sale of equity interest in Wells Fargo HSBC Trade Bank
-
(66)
Revenue associated with whole loan purchase settlement(2)
-
(89)
Income from continuing operations before income tax, excluding above items(3)
$655
$665
____________
 
(1)
The proceeds of the resolution of this lawsuit were used to in 2009 to redeem 100 preferred shares held by CT Financial Services, Inc. as provided under the terms of the preferred shares. The proceeds received in 2010 represent the final judgment.
   
(2)
Represents loans previously purchased for resale from a third party.
   
(3)
Represents a non-U.S. GAAP financial measure.
 
Excluding the collective impact of the items in the table above, our income from continuing operations before tax for the three months ended March 31, 2011 was slightly lower compared to the prior year quarter as lower net interest income was partially offset by lower provisions for credit losses and lower operating expenses, while other revenues remained relatively flat. During the three months ended March 31, 2011, we continued to reduce legacy and other risk positions as opportunities arose, including the sale of $474 million and $71 million in leveraged acquisition finance loans and subprime residential mortgage loans previously held for sale and continued reductions in monoline counterparty exposures. Improved market conditions and reduced outstanding exposure have resulted in a stabilization of valuation adjustments recorded. A summary of the significant valuation adjustments that impacted revenue for the three month periods ended March 31, 2011 and 2010 are presented in the following table.
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Gains (Losses)
   
Insurance monoline structured credit products(1)
$16
$56
Other structured credit products(1)
81
37
Mortgage whole loans held for sale including whole loan purchase settlement (predominantly subprime)(2)
(5)
77
Other-than-temporary impairment on securities available-for-sale and held-to-maturity(3)
-
(28)
Leverage acquisition finance loans held for sale(4)
34
(1)
Total gains (losses)
$126
$141

 

____________
 
(1)
Reflected in Trading revenue in the consolidated statement of income.
   
(2)
Reflected in Other income in the consolidated statement of income.
   
(3)
Reflected in Net other-than-temporary impairment losses in the consolidated statement of income.
   
(4)
Reflected in Gain (loss) on instruments designated at fair value and related derivatives in the consolidated statement of income.
 
The market turmoil experienced over the past few years has created stress for certain counterparties with whom we conduct business as part of our lending and client intermediation activities. We assess, monitor and manage credit risk with formal standards, policies and procedures that are designed to ensure credit risks are assessed accurately, approved properly, monitored regularly and managed actively. Consequently, we believe any loss exposure related to counterparties with whom we conduct business has been adequately reflected in our financial statements as of March 31, 2011.
 
Other revenues in both periods reflect the impact of changes in value of our own debt and related derivatives for which we elected fair value option as well as several non-recurring items as presented in the first table above. Excluding the impact of all these items, other revenue increased $9 million during the first quarter of 2011 due primarily to higher trading revenue, higher securities gains and lower other-than-temporary impairment losses, partially offset by lower credit card and other fees and commissions. The higher trading revenue and improvement in other-than-temporary impairment losses were driven by continuing improvements in market conditions and as it relates to trading revenue, continued reductions in counterparty exposure. Securities gains were higher due to increased security sales for risk management purposes. Lower credit card fees were due to lower levels of credit card and private label receivables, changes in customer behavior, lower delinquency levels and the continuing impact of certain provisions of the Credit Card Accountability Responsibility and Disclosure Act of 2009 (the "Card Act") which resulted in lower over limit, late and payment processing fees. Lower other fees and commissions were driven by lower refund anticipation loan fees as we did not offer this product in 2011 as well as lower loan syndication fees. See "Results of Operations" for a more detailed discussion of other revenues.
 
Net interest income was $1.0 billion during the three months ended March 31, 2011 compared to $1.2 billion during the prior year quarter. The decrease reflects the impact of lower average loan balances and rates earned on these balances. These reductions were partially offset by a lower cost of funds, including lower overall average rates on deposits. See "Results of Operations" for a more detailed discussion of net interest income.
 
Our provision for credit losses decreased $105 million during the first quarter of 2011 compared to the year-ago quarter primarily due to declines in loan balances and improvements in economic and credit conditions, including lower dollars of delinquency and improvements in early stage consumer loan delinquency roll rates. These conditions have resulted in improved outlook on future loss estimates for our consumer loan portfolio as compared with the prior year quarter. While the provision for credit losses increased for loans in the commercial loan portfolio, it remained a net recovery in both periods as managed reductions in certain exposures and improvements in the financial circumstances of several customer relationships which led to credit upgrades on certain problem credits and lower levels of nonperforming loans and criticized assets resulted in a higher overall release in loss reserves during the year-ago quarter. See "Results of Operations" for a more detailed discussion of our provision for credit losses.
 
Operating expenses totaled $1.1 billion during the first quarter of 2011, an increase of 4 percent from the year-ago quarter. The increase was driven by a $78 million impairment of certain previously capitalized software development costs which are no longer realizable as a result of decisions made in March 2011 to cancel certain projects. Excluding the impact of this impairment, operating expenses fell $32 million or 3 percent from the year-ago quarter reflecting lower servicing fees paid to HSBC Finance due to lower levels of receivables being serviced and lower tax refund anticipation loan expenses partially offset by increased salaries associated with the transfer of certain employees of HSBC Finance to our default mortgage loan servicing department in July 2010 (which cost is offset in other revenues) and higher compliance costs. We continue to focus attention on cost mitigation efforts in order to ensure realization of optimal cost efficiencies. See "Results of Operations" for a more detailed discussion of our operating expenses.
 
Our efficiency ratio from continuing operations was 62.22 percent during the there months ended March 31, 2011 compared to 49.66 percent during the year-ago quarter. The deterioration in the efficiency ratio reflects higher operating expenses driven by impairment of certain software development costs, while total net interest income and other revenues declined. Excluding the impact of the software development cost impairment, our efficiency ratio for the first quarter of 2011 was 57.79 percent.
 
The effective tax rate for the three months ended March 31, 2011 was primarily impacted by a release of valuation allowance previously established on foreign tax credits, utilization of low income housing tax credits, state taxes and the change in state tax rates used to value deferred taxes. During the first quarter of 2011, HSBC North America identified an additional tax planning strategy which is expected to generate sufficient taxable foreign source income to allow us to recognize and utilize foreign tax credits currently on our balance sheet before they expire. See Note 12, "Income Taxes," in the accompanying consolidated financial statements for further discussion.
 
At December 31, 2010, we consolidated a commercial paper conduit known as Bryant Park Funding LLC ("Bryant Park") in our financial statements as we were considered to be the primary beneficiary because we had the power to direct the activities of the conduit that most significantly impact its economic performance including a) determining which eligible assets to acquire; b) risk managing the portfolio held; and c) managing the refinancing of commercial paper. During the first quarter of 2011, in order to consolidate and streamline conduit administration across HSBC to reduce risk and achieve operational and capital efficiencies, we completed the assignment of a significant majority of our liquidity asset purchase agreements to HSBC Bank plc. As a result, we no longer have a controlling financial interest in Bryant Park and, beginning in March 2011, we are no longer consolidating Bryant Park. The deconsolidation of Bryant Park resulted in the removal of approximately $2.4 billion of assets from our balance sheet in March 2011 and did not have a significant financial impact on our results of operations. See Note 17, "Variable Interest Entities" for further discussion.
 
As discussed in our 2010 Form 10-K, we have been building several new retail banking platforms as part of an initiative to build common platforms across HSBC. Certain of these retail banking platforms were rolled out in 2010 and additional platforms continued to be under development. During the first quarter of 2011, we decided to cancel certain projects underway that were developing software for these new platforms as alternative information technology platforms are being pursued. As a result of this decision, we recorded a charge of $78 million during the first quarter of 2011 relating to the impairment of certain previously capitalized software development costs which are now no longer realizable. While development of other banking platforms continues, further development of certain platforms is under review. At March 31, 2011, $32 million of software in the process of development on projects which have not been put into service remains capitalized.
 
In August 2010, we announced to employees that we are considering strategic options for our mortgage operations, with the objective of recommending the future course of our prime mortgage lending and mortgage servicing platforms. Strategic options may include, but are not limited to, the sale or outsourcing of all, or part, of these platforms. Under all options being explored, we plan to continue offering mortgages to our customers. Our review of strategic options is continuing.
 
We continue to evaluate our operations as we seek to optimize our risk profile and cost efficiencies as well as our liquidity, capital and funding requirements. This could result in further strategic actions that may include changes to our legal structure, asset levels, cost structure or product offerings in support of HSBC's strategic priorities. As part of this continuing evaluation, a strategic review of HSBC's U.S. credit card and private label businesses is underway as HSBC seeks to redistribute resources and reallocate capital to support core businesses. In addition, we are reviewing the markets in which we operate in an effort to determine the optimal size and geographic spread of our branch network as we concentrate on areas with strong international connectivity, consistent with HSBC's core strategy.
 
We also continue to focus on cost optimization efforts to ensure realization of cost efficiencies. During the first quarter of 2011, in an effort to create a more sustainable cost structure, we initiated a formal review to identify areas where we may be able to streamline or redesign operations within certain functions to reduce or eliminate costs. To date, we have identified various opportunities to reduce costs through organizational structure redesign, vendor spending, discretionary spending and other general efficiency initiatives. This review will continue throughout 2011 and, as a result, we may incur restructuring charges during the remainder of 2011, the amount of which will depend on the actions that are ultimately implemented.
 
The financial information set forth below summarizes selected financial highlights of HSBC USA Inc. as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 and for the three month periods ended March 31, 2011 and 2010.
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(dollars are in millions)
Income from continuing operations
$480
$544
Rate of return on average :
   
Total assets
1.02%
1.20%
Total common shareholder's equity
12.18
15.49
Net interest margin to average earning assets
2.55
3.01
Efficiency ratio
62.22
49.66
Commercial loan net charge-off ratio(1)
.17
1.28
Consumer loan net charge-off ratio(1)
4.21
6.43
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(dollars are in millions)
Loans:
   
Commercial loans
$31,057
$30,274
Consumer loans
40,661
42,795
Total loans
$71,718
$73,069
Loans held for sale
$1,688
$2,390
Commercial allowance as a percent of loans(1)
1.55%
1.77%
Commercial two-months-and-over contractual delinquency
2.06
2.42
Consumer allowance as a percent of loans(1)
3.32
3.82
Consumer two-months-and-over contractual delinquency
4.75
5.04
Loan-to-deposits ratio(2)
75.92
80.56
Total shareholders' equity to total assets
8.76
9.10
Total capital to risk weighted assets
18.72
18.14
Tier 1 capital to risk weighted assets
12.40
11.80
____________
 
(1)
Excludes loans held for sale.
   
(2)
Represents period end loans, net of loss reserves, as a percentage of domestic deposits less certificate of deposits equal to or less than $100 thousand.
 
Loans Loans, excluding loans held for sale, were $71.7 billion at March 31, 2011 compared to $73.1 billion at December 31, 2010. The decrease in loans as compared to December 31, 2010 reflects the deconsolidation of the Bryant Park commercial paper conduit which contributed $1.2 billion to outstanding commercial loans at December 31, 2010, as well as run-off in all consumer portfolios with the exception of residential mortgages which remained relatively flat. We continue to sell the majority of new residential mortgage loan originations to government sponsored enterprises. The decline in credit card and private label receivables reflects fewer active customer accounts, an increased focus by customers to reduce outstanding credit card debt and seasonal improvements in our collection activities during the first quarter of the year as some customers use their tax refunds to make payments. Excluding the impact to loans from the deconsolidation of Bryant Park, commercial loans increased $2.0 billion since December 31, 2010, driven by a $1.2 billion increase in affiliate loans, including loans to HSBC Markets and its subsidiaries as well as new business activity. These increases were partially offset by paydowns and managed reductions in certain exposures. See "Balance Sheet Review" for a more detailed discussion of the changes in loan balances.
 
Credit Quality Our allowance for credit losses as a percentage of total loans decreased to 2.55 percent at March 31, 2011 as compared to 2.97 percent at December 31, 2010. The decrease in our allowance ratio reflects a lower allowance on all of our consumer loan portfolios due to improved credit quality, lower delinquency levels and continuing improvements in economic conditions. Our commercial loan allowance for credit losses ratio also fell as economic conditions continued to stabilize and related credit quality and future loss estimates improved.
 
Our consumer two-months-and-over contractual delinquency as a percentage of loans and loans held for sale ("delinquency ratio") decreased to 4.75 percent at March 31, 2011 as compared to 5.04 percent at December 31, 2010. Dollars of delinquency decreased across virtually all consumer portfolios while outstanding loan balances also declined in all portfolios except residential mortgage loans. The decrease in the consumer delinquency ratio was primarily in our residential mortgage, private label card and credit card portfolios. See "Credit Quality" for a more detailed discussion of the increase in our delinquency ratios.
 
Net charge-offs as a percentage of average loans ("net charge-off ratio") decreased 61 basis points compared to the quarter ended December 31, 2010 primarily due to lower commercial, private label card and credit card charge-offs driven by lower receivable levels and improved credit quality. As it relates to private label card and credit card receivables, these favorable trends were partially offset by the impact from continued high unemployment levels. See "Credit Quality" for a more detailed discussion of the increase in net charge-offs and the net charge-off ratio.
 
Funding and Capital Capital amounts and ratios are calculated in accordance with current banking regulations. Our Tier 1 capital ratio was 12.40 percent and 11.80 percent at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. Our capital levels remain well above levels established by current banking regulations as "well capitalized." We received no cash capital contributions from our immediate parent, HSBC North America Inc. ("HNAI") during the first quarter of 2011.
 
As part of the regulatory approvals with respect to the affiliate receivable purchases completed in January 2009, HSBC Bank USA and HSBC made certain additional capital commitments to ensure that HSBC Bank USA holds sufficient capital with respect to the purchased receivables that are or may become "low-quality assets," as defined by the Federal Reserve Act. These capital requirements, which require a risk-based capital charge of 100 percent for each "low-quality asset" transferred or arising in the purchased portfolios rather than a typical eight percent capital charge applied to similar assets that are not part of the transferred portfolios, are applied both for purposes of satisfying the terms of the commitments and for purposes of measuring and reporting HSBC Bank USA's risk-based capital and related ratios. This treatment applies as long as the low-quality assets are owned by HSBC Bank USA. At March 31, 2011, the remaining purchased receivables subject to this requirement totaled $2.8 billion, of which $583 million were considered low-quality assets. We have exceeded the minimum capital ratios required at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
As discussed in previous filings, HSBC North America is required to implement Basel II provisions in accordance with current regulatory timelines. While HSBC USA Inc. will not report separately under the new rules, HSBC Bank USA will report under the new rules on a stand-alone basis. Prior to adoption of Basel II, we are required to successfully complete a parallel run by measuring regulatory capital under both the new regulatory capital rules and the existing general risk-based rules for a period of at least four quarters. Successful completion of the parallel run period requires the approval of U.S. regulators. We began the parallel run period in January 2010 which encompasses enhancements to a number of risk policies, processes and systems to align HSBC Bank USA with the Basel II final rule requirements. We are uncertain as to when we will receive approval from our primary regulator. Regulatory approval may not occur until later in 2011 or in 2012. We have integrated Basel II metrics into our management reporting and decision making process.
 

Income Before Income Tax Expense - Significant Trends Income from continuing operations before income tax expense, and various trends and activity affecting operations, are summarized in the following table.
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Income (loss) from continuing operations before income tax for prior year
$858
$(58)
Increase (decrease) in income from continuing operations before income tax attributable to:
   
Balance sheet management activities(1)
65
(192)
Trading revenue(2)
45
346
Credit card fees(3)
(64)
(124)
Loans held for sale(4)
(82)
163
Residential mortgage banking related revenue (loss)(5)
2
(102)
Loss on own debt designated at fair value and related derivatives(6)
(48)
(16)
Gain (loss) on instruments designated at fair value and related derivatives, excluding own debt(6)
23
(50)
Provision for credit losses(7)
105
963
All other activity(8)
(342)
(72)
Income from continuing operations before income tax for current period
$562
$858
____________
 
(1)
Balance sheet management activities are comprised primarily of net interest income and, to a lesser extent, gains or losses on sales of investments, resulting from management of interest rate risk associated with the repricing characteristics of balance sheet assets and liabilities. For additional discussion regarding Global Banking and Markets net interest income, trading revenues, and the Global Banking and Markets business segment see the caption "Business Segments" section in this MD&A.
   
(2)
For additional discussion regarding trading revenue, see the caption "Results of Operations" in this MD&A.
   
(3)
For additional discussion regarding credit card fees, see the caption "Results of Operations" in this MD&A.
   
(4)
For additional discussion regarding loans held for sale, see the caption "Balance Sheet Revenue" in this MD&A.
   
(5)
For additional discussion regarding residential mortgage banking revenue, see the caption "Results of Operations" in this MD&A.
   
(6)
For additional discussion regarding fair value option and fair value measurement, see Note 11, "Fair Value Option," in the accompanying consolidated financial statements.
   
(7)
For additional discussion regarding provision for credit losses, see the caption "Results of Operations" in this MD&A.
   
(8)
Represents other banking activities, including the impact of certain non-recurring items such as the impaired software development costs in 2011 and in 2010, the gain on the sale of Wells Fargo HSBC Trade Bank and the whole loan repurchase settlement.
 
Basis of Reporting
 
Our consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States ("U.S. GAAP"). Unless noted, the discussion of our financial condition and results of operations included in MD&A are presented on a continuing operations basis of reporting. Certain reclassifications have been made to prior year amounts to conform to the current year presentation.
 
In addition to the U.S. GAAP financial results reported in our consolidated financial statements, MD&A includes reference to the following information which is presented on a non-U.S. GAAP basis:
 
International Financial Reporting Standards ("IFRSs") Because HSBC reports results in accordance with IFRSs and IFRSs results are used in measuring and rewarding performance of employees, our management also separately
monitors net income under IFRSs (a non-U.S. GAAP financial measure). The following table reconciles our net income on a U.S. GAAP basis to net income on an IFRSs basis.
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
Net income (loss) - U.S. GAAP basis
$479
$554
Adjustments, net of tax:
   
Reclassification of financial assets
(31)
(10)
Securities
11
34
Derivatives
2
2
Loan impairment
7
7
Property
(2)
-
Pension costs
6
57
Purchased loan portfolios
(20)
(26)
Servicing assets
-
1
Return of capital
-
(3)
Release of tax valuation allowances
39
-
Uncertain tax positions
(160)
-
Other
3
11
Net income (loss) - IFRSs basis
334
627
Tax benefit (expense) - IFRSs basis
(120)
(356)
Profit (loss) before tax - IFRSs basis
$454
$983
 
A summary of the significant differences between U.S. GAAP and IFRSs as they impact our results are presented below:
 
Reclassification of financial assets - Certain securities were reclassified from "trading assets" to "loans and receivables" under IFRSs as of July 1, 2008 pursuant to an amendment to IAS 39, "Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement" ("IAS 39"), and are no longer marked to market under IFRSs. In November 2008, additional securities were similarly transferred to loans and receivables. These securities continue to be classified as "trading assets" under U.S. GAAP.
 
Additionally, certain Leverage Acquisition Finance ("LAF") loans were classified as "Trading Assets" for IFRSs and to be consistent, an irrevocable fair value option was elected on these loans under U.S. GAAP on January 1, 2008. These loans were reclassified to "loans and advances" as of July 1, 2008 pursuant to the IAS 39 amendment discussed above. Under U.S. GAAP, these loans are classified as "held for sale" and carried at fair value due to the irrevocable nature of the fair value option.
 
Securities - Under U.S. GAAP, the credit loss component of an other-than-temporary impairment of a debt security is recognized in earnings while the remaining portion of the impairment loss is recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income provided we have concluded we do not intend to sell the security and it is more-likely-than-not that we will not have to sell the security prior to recovery. Under IFRSs, there is no bifurcation of other-than-temporary impairment and the entire amount is recognized in earnings. Also under IFRSs, recoveries in other-than-temporary impairment related to improvement in the underlying credit characteristics of the investment are recognized immediately in earnings while under U.S. GAAP, they are amortized to income over the remaining life of the security. There are also less significant differences in measuring other-than-temporary impairment under IFRSs versus U.S. GAAP.
 
Under IFRSs, securities include HSBC shares held for stock plans at fair value. These shares held for stock plans are recorded at fair value through other comprehensive income. If it is determined these shares have become impaired, the fair value loss is recognized in profit and loss and any fair value loss recorded in other comprehensive income is reversed. There is no similar requirement under U.S. GAAP. During 2009 under IFRSs, we recorded income for the value of additional shares attributed to HSBC shares held for stock plans as a result of HSBC's rights offering. The additional shares are not recorded under U.S. GAAP.
 
Derivatives - Effective January 1, 2008, U.S. GAAP removed the observability requirement of valuation inputs to allow up-front recognition of the difference between transaction price and fair value in the consolidated statement of income. Under IFRSs, recognition is permissible only if the inputs used in calculating fair value are based on observable inputs. If the inputs are not observable, profit and loss is deferred and is recognized (1) over the period of contract, (2) when the data becomes observable, or (3) when the contract is settled.
 
Loan impairment - IFRSs requires a discounted cash flow methodology for estimating impairment on pools of homogeneous customer loans which requires the discounting of cash flows including recovery estimates at the original effective interest rate of the pool of customer loans. The amount of impairment relating to the discounting of future cash flows unwinds with the passage of time, and is recognized in interest income. Also under IFRSs, if the recognition of a write-down to net realizable value on secure loans decreases because collateral values have improved and the improvement can be related objectively to an event occurring after recognition of the write-down, such write-down can be reversed, which is not permitted under U.S. GAAP. Additionally under IFRSs, future recoveries on charged-off loans or loans written down to net realizable value less cost to obtain title and sell are accrued for on a discounted basis and a recovery asset is recorded. Subsequent recoveries are recorded to earnings under U.S. GAAP, but are adjusted against the recovery asset under IFRSs. Under IFRSs, interest on impaired loans is recorded at the effective interest rate on the customer loans balance net of impairment allowances, and therefore reflects the collectibility of the loans.
 
Property - The sale of our 452 Fifth Avenue property, including the 1 W. 39th Street building in April 2010, resulted in the recognition of a gain under IFRSs while under US GAAP, such gain is deferred and recognized over ten years due to our continuing involvement.
 
Pension costs - Net income under U.S. GAAP is lower than under IFRSs as a result of the amortization of the amount by which actuarial losses exceeded the higher of the projected benefit obligation or fair value of plan assets beyond the 10 percent "corridor." Furthermore, in 2010, changes to future accruals for legacy participants under the HSBC North America Pension Plan were accounted for as a plan curtailment under IFRSs, which resulted in immediate income recognition. Under US GAAP, these changes were considered to be a negative plan amendment which resulted in no immediate income recognition.
 
Purchased loan portfolios - Under U.S. GAAP, purchased loans for which there has been evidence of credit deterioration at the time of acquisition are recorded at an amount based on the net cash flows expected to be collected. This generally results in only a portion of the loans in the acquired portfolio being recorded at fair value. Under IFRSs, the entire purchased portfolio is recorded at fair value. When recording purchased loans at fair value, the difference between all estimated future cash collections and the purchase price paid is recognized into income using the effective interest method. An allowance for loan loss is not established unless the original estimate of expected future cash collections declines.
 
Servicing assets - Under IAS 38, servicing assets are initially recorded on the balance sheet at cost and amortized over the projected life of the assets. Servicing assets are periodically tested for impairment with impairment adjustments charged against current earnings. Under U.S. GAAP, we generally record servicing assets on the balance sheet at fair value. Subsequent adjustments to fair value are generally reflected in current period earnings.
 
Return of capital - Reflects payments to CT Financial Services, Inc. in connection with the resolution of a lawsuit which for IFRSs was treated as the satisfaction of a liability and not as revenue and a subsequent capital transaction as was the case under U.S. GAAP.
 
Release of tax valuation allowances - Reflects differences in the timing of amounts of deferred tax assets that can be realized between U.S. GAAP and IFRSs.
 
Uncertain tax positions - Under U.S. GAAP, developments regarding uncertain tax positions that occur after the balance sheet date but before issuance of the financial statements are considered to be an unrecognized subsequent
event for which no impact is recorded in the current period. Under IFRSs, financial statements are adjusted to reflect a material event that occurs after the end of the reporting period but before the financial statements are authorized for issuance if the event provides additional evidences relating to conditions that existed at the end of the reporting period.
 
Other - Other includes the net impact of certain adjustments which represent differences between U.S. GAAP and IFRSs that were not individually material, including deferred loan origination costs and fees, discounting repurchase liabilities on sold loans, restructuring costs, depreciation expense and loans held for sale.
 
Balance Sheet Review
 
We utilize deposits and borrowings from various sources to provide liquidity, fund balance sheet growth, meet cash and capital needs, and fund investments in subsidiaries. Balance sheet totals at March 31, 2011 and increases (decreases) since December 31, 2010, are summarized in the table below.
 
   
Increase (Decrease) From
 
March 31,
December 31, 2010
 
2011
Amount
%
 
(dollars are in millions)
Period end assets:
     
Short-term investments
$36,580
$18,566
100+%
Loans, net
69,886
(1,013)
(1.4)
Loans held for sale
1,688
(702)
(29.4)
Trading assets
32,980
578
1.8
Securities
42,797
(5,916)
(12.1)
Other assets
12,656
1,261
11.1
 
$196,587
$12,774
6.9%
Funding sources:
     
Total deposits
$132,761
$12,110
10.0%
Trading liabilities
11,165
637
6.1
Short-term borrowings
13,820
(1,367)
(9.0)
All other liabilities
4,634
1,150
33.0
Long-term debt
16,986
(244)
(1.4)
Shareholders' equity
17,221
488
2.9
 
$196,587
$12,774
6.9%
 
Short-Term Investments Short-term investments include cash and due from banks, interest bearing deposits with banks, federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements. Balances will fluctuate between periods depending upon our liquidity position at the time. Increases during the first quarter of 2011 reflect increased liquidity driven by higher deposit levels.
 

Loans, Net Loan balances at March 31, 2011 and increases (decreases) since December 31, 2010 are summarized in the table below:
 
   
Increase (Decrease) From
 
March 31,
December 31, 2010
 
2011
Amount
%
 
(dollars are in millions)
Commercial loans:
     
Construction and other real estate
$8,281
$53
.6%
Business banking and middle market enterprises
8,054
109
1.4
Large corporate
11,878
1,133
10.5
Other commercial loans
2,844
(512)
(15.3)
Total commercial loans
31,057
783
2.6
Consumer loans:
     
Residential mortgages, excluding home equity mortgages
13,868
171
1.2
Home equity mortgages
3,678
(142)
(3.7)
Total residential mortgages
17,546
29
.2
Private label
12,014
(1,282)
(9.6)
Credit Card
10,014
(797)
(7.4)
Other consumer
1,087
(84)
(7.2)
Total consumer loans
40,661
(2,134)
(5.0)
Total loans
71,718
(1,351)
(1.9)
Allowance for credit losses
1,832
(338)
(15.6)
Loans, net
$69,886
$(1,013)
(1.4)%
 
Commercial loan balances at December 31, 2010 reflect $1.2 billion of loans relating to the Bryant Park commercial paper conduit which we no longer consolidate at March 31, 2011. Excluding the impact of Bryant Park, commercial loan balances increased $2.0 billion since December 31, 2010, driven by a $1.2 billion increase in affiliate loans, including loans to HSBC Markets and its subsidiaries, as well as new business activity. These increases were partially offset by paydowns and managed reductions in certain exposures.
 
Residential mortgage loans have remained relatively flat since December 31, 2010. As a result of balance sheet initiatives to manage interest rate risk and improve the structural liquidity of HSBC Bank USA, we continue to sell a majority of our new residential loan originations through the secondary markets and have allowed the existing loan portfolio to run off, resulting in reductions in loan balances. The balances reflect increases to the portfolio associated with originations targeted at our Premier customer relationships.

 
As previously discussed, real estate markets in a large portion of the United States have been and continue to be affected by stagnation or declines in property values. As such, the loan-to-value ("LTV") ratios for our mortgage loan portfolio have generally deteriorated since origination. Refreshed loan-to-value ratios for our mortgage loan portfolio, excluding subprime residential mortgage loans held for sale, are presented in the table below.
 
 
Refreshed LTVs(1)(2)
at March 31, 2011
Refreshed LTVs(1)(2)
at December 31, 2010
 
First Lien
Second Lien
First Lien
Second Lien
LTV < 80%
75.6%
64.2%
75.1%
64.1%
80% ≤ LTV < 90%
11.5
13.4
11.9
13.5
90% ≤ LTV < 100%
6.7
9.8
6.8
9.8
LTV ≥ 100%
6.3
12.6
6.2
12.6
Average LTV for portfolio
67.1%
73.6%
67.1%
73.6%
____________
 
(1)
Refreshed LTVs for first liens are calculated using the loan balance as of the reporting date. Refreshed LTVs for second liens are calculated using the loan balance as of the reporting date plus the senior lien amount at origination. Current estimated property values are derived from the property's appraised value at the time of loan origination updated by the change in the Federal Housing Finance Agency's (formerly known as the Office of Federal Housing Enterprise Oversight) house pricing index ("HPI") at either a Core Based Statistical Area ("CBSA") or state level. The estimated value of the homes could vary from actual fair values due to changes in condition of the underlying property, variations in housing price changes within metropolitan statistical areas and other factors. As a result, actual property values associated with loans which end in foreclosure may be significantly lower than the estimates used for purposes of this disclosure.
   
(2)
Current property values are calculated using the most current HPI's available and applied on an individual loan basis, which results in an approximately three month delay in the production of reportable statistics. Therefore, the information in the table above reflects current estimated property values using HPIs as of December 31, 2010 and September 30, 2010, respectively.
 
Credit card and private label receivable balances decreased due to fewer active customer accounts, an increased focus by customers to reduce outstanding credit card debt and, as it relates to the private label portfolio, the continued impact associated with the exit of certain merchant relationships. Decreases also reflect seasonal improvements in our collection activities during the first quarter of the year as some customers use their tax refunds to make payments. At March 31, 2011, private label receivables include $743 million associated with merchants for which we no longer finance new purchases.
 
Other consumer loans have decreased primarily due to the discontinuation of originations of student loans and run-off of our installment loan portfolio.
 
Loans Held for Sale Loans held for sale at March 31, 2011 and increases (decreases) since December 31, 2010 are summarized in the table below.
 
     
   
Increase (Decrease) From
   
December 31,
 
March 31,
2010
 
2011
Amount
%
 
(dollars are in millions)
Total commercial loans
$845
$(511)
(37.7)%
Consumer loans:
     
Residential mortgages
763
(191)
(20.0)
Other consumer
80
-
-
Total consumer loans
843
(191)
(18.5)
Total loans held for sale
$1,688
$(702)
(29.4)%
 
We originate commercial loans in connection with our participation in a number of leveraged acquisition finance syndicates. A substantial majority of these loans were originated with the intent of selling them to unaffiliated third parties and are classified as commercial loans held for sale. Commercial loans held for sale under this program were $542 million and $1.0 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, all of which are recorded at fair value as we have elected to designate these loans under fair value option. Commercial loan balances under this program decreased during the first quarter of 2011 due to loan sales. In addition beginning in 2010, we provided foreign currency denominated loans to third parties which are classified as commercial loans held for sale and for which we also elected to apply fair value option. The fair value of commercial loans held for sale under this program was $271 million and $273 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. See Note 11, "Fair Value Option," in the accompanying consolidated financial statements for further information.
 
Residential mortgage loans held for sale include subprime residential mortgage loans of $304 million and $391 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, which were acquired from unaffiliated third parties and from HSBC Finance with the intent of securitizing or selling the loans to third parties. Also included in residential mortgage loans held for sale are first mortgage loans originated and held for sale primarily to various government sponsored enterprises. We retained the servicing rights in relation to the mortgages upon sale. Balances declined in the first quarter of 2011 due to subprime residential mortgage loan sales.
 
Other consumer loans held for sale consist of student loans which we no longer originate.
 
Consumer loans held for sale are recorded at the lower of cost or market value. While the book value of loans held for sale continued to exceed fair value at March 31, 2011, we experienced a decrease in the valuation allowance during the first quarter of 2011 primarily due to lower balances driven by loan sales.
 
Trading Assets and Liabilities Trading assets and liabilities balances at March 31, 2011 and increases (decreases) since December 31, 2010, are summarized in the table below.
 
   
Increase (Decrease) From
   
December 31,
 
March 31,
2010
 
2011
Amount
%
 
(dollars are in millions)
Trading assets:
     
Securities(1)
$12,854
$3,189
33.0%
Precious metals
13,594
(3,131)
(18.7)
Derivatives(2)
6,532
520
8.6
 
$32,980
$578
1.8%
Trading liabilities:
     
Securities sold, not yet purchased
$349
$137
64.6%
Payable for precious metals
5,377
51
1.0
Derivatives(3)
5,439
449
9.0
 
$11,165
$637
6.1%
____________
 
(1)
Includes U.S. Treasury securities, securities issued by U.S. Government agencies and U.S. Government sponsored enterprises, other asset-backed securities, corporate bonds and debt securities.
   
(2)
At March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, the fair value of derivatives included in trading assets has been reduced by $3.2 billion and $3.1 billion, respectively, relating to amounts recognized for the obligation to return cash collateral received under master netting agreements with derivative counterparties.
   
(3)
At March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, the fair value of derivatives included in trading liabilities has been reduced by $5.8 billion, relating to amounts recognized for the right to reclaim cash collateral paid under master netting agreements with derivative.
 
Securities balances as well as balances of securities sold, not yet purchased increased at March 31, 2011 due to an increase in Treasury positions related to hedges for derivative positions in both the interest rate and emerging market trading portfolio.

 
Precious metals trading assets decreased at March 31, 2011 primarily due to a reduction in gold inventory. The higher payable for precious metals compared to December 31, 2010 was primarily due to higher metal balances, mainly for price increases in silver.
 
Derivative assets and liabilities balances as compared to December 31, 2010 were impacted by market movements as valuations of credit derivatives increased from spread widening and increased value in foreign exchange and interest rate derivatives. This was partially offset by the continued decrease in credit derivative positions as a number of transaction unwinds and commutations reduced the outstanding market value as management continues to actively reduce exposure.
 
Deposits Deposit balances by major depositor categories at March 31, 2011 and increases since December 31, 2010, are summarized in the table below.
 
   
Increase (Decrease) From
   
December 31,
 
March 31,
2010
 
2011
Amount
%
 
(dollars are in millions)
Individuals, partnerships and corporations
$112,608
$8,620
8.3%
Domestic and foreign banks
14,018
2,106
17.7
U.S. government, states and political subdivisions
5,047
754
17.6
Foreign governments and official institutions
1,088
630
100+
Total deposits
$132,761
$12,110
10.0%
Total core deposits(1)
$94,276
$3,305
3.6%
____________
 
(1)
We monitor "core deposits" as a key measure for assessing results of our core banking network. Core deposits generally include all domestic demand, money market and other savings accounts, as well as time deposits with balances not exceeding $100,000.
 
Deposits continued to be a significant source of funding during the first quarter of 2011. Deposits at March 31, 2011 have increased since December 31, 2010 as higher deposits from affiliates, increases in foreign placed deposits, growth in branch-based deposit products driven primarily by our Premier and branch expansion strategies as well as seasonal increases in deposits was partially offset by our efforts to manage down low margin wholesale deposits in order to maximize profitability. Our relative liquidity strength has also allowed us to lower rates to be in line with our competition on several low margin deposit products. Core domestic deposits, which are a substantial source of our core liquidity, increased during the first quarter of 2011 driven by continuing growth in our Premier balances and increases in institutional transaction account balances.
 
Our strategy for our core retail banking business, includes building deposits and wealth management across multiple markets, channels and segments. This strategy includes various initiatives, such as:
 
 
  HSBC Premier, HSBC's global banking service that offers internationally minded mass affluent customers unique international services seamlessly delivered through HSBC's global network coupled with a premium local service with a dedicated premier relationship manager. Total Premier deposits have grown to $30.9 billion at March 31, 2011 as compared to $29.5 billion at December 31, 2010;
 
 
•  Deepening our existing customer relationships by needs-based sales of wealth, banking and mortgage products.
 
Short-Term Borrowings Balances at March 31, 2011 decreased as compared to December 31, 2010 as a result of the deconsolidation of the Bryant Park commercial paper conduit during the first quarter of 2011 which held $3.0 billion of commercial paper at December 31, 2010, partially offset by increased levels of securities sold under agreements to repurchase.

 
Long-Term Debt Long-term debt at March 31, 2011 decreased as compared to December 31, 2010 due to an increased mix of lower rate short-term funding (excluding the impact of Bryant Park), the impact of long-term debt retirements and continued focus on deposit gathering activities.
 
Incremental issuances from the $40.0 billion HSBC Bank USA Global Bank Note Program totaled $236 million and $176 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. Total debt outstanding under this program was $5.1 billion and $4.9 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
 
Incremental long-term debt issuances from our shelf registration statement with the Securities and Exchange Commission totaled $540 million and $502 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. Total long-term debt outstanding under this shelf was $6.5 billion and $6.5 billion at both March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
Borrowings from the Federal Home Loan Bank of New York ("FHLB") totaled $1.0 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010. At March 31, 2011, we had the ability to access further borrowings of up to $3.1 billion based on the amount pledged as collateral with the FHLB.
 
We have entered into transactions with VIEs organized by HSBC affiliates and unrelated third parties. We are the primary beneficiary of certain of these VIEs under the applicable accounting literature and, accordingly, we have consolidated the assets and the debt of these VIEs. Debt obligations of VIEs totaling $55 million were included in long-term debt at March 31, 2011. Debt obligations of VIEs totaling $3.0 billion and $205 million were included in short-term borrowings and long-term debt, respectively, at December 31, 2010. The decrease in short-term borrowings during the first quarter of 2011 reflects the deconsolidation in the first quarter of 2011 of Bryant Park. See Note 17, "Variable Interest Entities," in the accompanying consolidated financial statements for additional information regarding VIE arrangements.
 
Real Estate Owned
 
We obtain real estate by taking possession of the collateral pledged as security for residential mortgage loans. REO properties are made available for sale in an orderly fashion with the proceeds used to reduce or repay the outstanding receivable balance. The following table provides quarterly information regarding our REO properties:
 
 
Three Months Ended
March 31,
2011
Number of REO properties at end of period
607
Number of properties added to REO inventory in the period
265
Average loss on sale of REO properties(1)
9.1%
Average total loss on foreclosed properties(2)
45.9%
Average time to sell REO properties (in days)
213
____________
 
(1)
Property acquired through foreclosure is initially recognized at its fair value less estimated costs to sell ("Initial REO Carrying Value"). The average loss on sale of REO properties is calculated as cash proceeds less the Initial REO Carrying Value divided by the Initial REO Carrying Value. At March 31, 2011, the fair value of our residential mortgage REO totaled $73 million.
   
(2)
The average total loss on foreclosed properties sold each quarter includes both the loss on sale of the REO property as discussed above and the cumulative write-downs recognized on the loans up to the time we took title to the property. This calculation of the average total loss on foreclosed properties uses the unpaid loan principal balance prior to write-down plus any other ancillary amounts owed (e.g., real estate tax advances) which were incurred prior to our taking title to the property.
 
Results of Operations
 
Net Interest Income Net interest income is the total interest income on earning assets less the total interest expense on deposits and borrowed funds. In the discussion that follows, interest income and rates are presented and analyzed on a taxable equivalent basis to permit comparisons of yields on tax-exempt and taxable assets. An analysis of consolidated average balances and interest rates on a taxable equivalent basis is presented in this MD&A under the caption "Consolidated Average Balances and Interest Rates."
 
The significant components of net interest margin are summarized in the following table:
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
Yield on total earning assets
3.26%
3.82%
Rate paid on interest bearing liabilities
.87
.97
Interest rate spread
2.39
2.85
Benefit from net non-interest earning or paying funds
.16
.16
Net interest margin
2.55%
3.01%
 
Significant trends affecting the comparability of net interest income and interest rate spread for the three months ended March 31, 2011 are summarized in the following table. Net interest income in the table is presented on a taxable equivalent basis.
 
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
Amount
Interest Rate
Spread
 
(dollars are in millions)
Net interest income/interest rate spread from prior year period
$1,205
2.85%
Increase (decrease) in net interest income associated with:
   
Trading related activities
15
 
Balance sheet management activities(1)
23
 
Private label card portfolio
(41)
 
Credit card portfolio
(122)
 
Commercial loans
(17)
 
Deposits
41
 
Residential mortgage banking
4
 
Other activity
(60)
 
Net interest income/interest rate spread for current year period
$1,048
2.39%
____________
 
(1)
Represents our activities to manage interest rate risk associated with the repricing characteristics of balance sheet assets and liabilities. Interest rate risk, and our approach to manage such risk, are described under the caption "Risk Management" in this Form 10-Q.
 
Trading related activities Net interest income for trading related activities increased during the first quarter of 2011 primarily due to higher balances on interest earning trading assets, such as trading bonds, which was partially offset by lower rates earned on these assets.
 
Balance sheet management activities Higher net interest income from balance sheet management activities during the first quarter of 2011 reflects positions taken in expectation of continued low short-term rates including additional purchases of U.S. Treasuries and Government National Mortgage Association mortgage-backed securities.
 
Private label card portfolio Net interest income on private label credit card receivables was lower during the first quarter of 2011 as a result of higher premiums, lower average balances outstanding and lower receivable levels at penalty pricing, partially offset by lower funding costs.
 
Credit card portfolio Net interest income on credit card receivables decreased during the first quarter of 2011 primarily reflecting lower average balances outstanding, lower loan levels at penalty pricing and higher premiums, partially offset by lower funding costs.

Commercial loans Net interest income on commercial loans decreased during the first quarter of 2011 primarily due to lower average loan balances, partially offset by lower levels of nonperforming loans and lower funding costs.
 
Deposits Higher net interest income during the first quarter of 2011 reflects improved spreads in the Personal Financial Services ("PFS") and Commercial Banking business ("CMB") segments as deposit pricing has been adjusted to reflect the on-going low interest rate environment. Both segments continue to be impacted however, relative to historical trends, by the current rate environment and the growth in higher yielding deposit products such as on-line savings and Premier investor accounts.
 
Residential mortgage banking Higher net interest income during the first quarter of 2011 resulted from lower funding costs, partially offset by lower average residential loans outstanding.
 
Other activity Net interest income on other activity was lower during the first quarter of 2011, largely driven by lower net interest income from the sale of auto finance receivables during 2010.
 
Provision for Credit Losses The provision for credit losses associated with various loan portfolios is summarized in the following table.
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Commercial:
   
Construction and other real estate
$(28)
$2
Business banking and middle market enterprises
(2)
3
Large corporate
(5)
(77)
Other commercial
(6)
(1)
Total commercial
(41)
(73)
Consumer:
   
Residential mortgages, excluding home equity mortgages
21
(19)
Home equity mortgages
10
(21)
Private label card receivables
51
109
Credit card receivables
61
190
Auto finance
-
25
Other consumer
4
-
Total consumer
147
284
Total provision for credit losses
$106
$211
 
During the first quarter of 2011, we decreased our credit loss reserves as the provision for credit losses was $339 million lower than net charge-offs reflecting lower loss estimates in our commercial and consumer loan portfolios. The provision as a percentage of average receivables was .15 percent at March 31, 2011 compared to .27 percent at March 31, 2010.
 
We experienced a lower net recovery in commercial loan loss provision in the first quarter of 2011 as compared to the prior year quarter. While we experienced reserve reductions on troubled debt restructures in commercial real estate and middle market enterprises as well as lower nonperforming loans and criticized asset levels in the quarter, reductions in higher risk rated loan balances and stabilization in credit downgrades, including managed reductions in certain exposures and improvements in the financial circumstances of certain customer relationships in both periods resulted in a higher overall release in loss reserves during the year-ago period. Given the nature of the factors driving the reduction in commercial loan provision during the quarter, provision levels recognized in the first quarter of 2011 should not be considered indicative of provision levels in the future.
 
The provision for credit losses on residential mortgages including home equity mortgages increased $71 million during the first quarter of 2011 as compared to the prior year quarter. While residential mortgage loan credit quality
continues to improve as delinquency and charge-off levels continue to decline, the prior year quarter reflects a reduction in loss reserves associated with certain portfolio risk factors that did not re-occur in 2011.
 
Provision expense associated with our private label card portfolio decreased $58 million during the first quarter of 2011 compared to the year-ago quarter due to lower receivable levels, improved economic and credit conditions, including lower dollars of delinquency, improvements in early stage delinquency roll rates and higher recovery rates. Lower receivable levels reflect fewer active customer accounts and an increased focus by consumers to pay down card debt. The impact on private label card receivable losses from the current economic environment, including high unemployment levels, has not been as severe as originally expected due in part to improved customer payment behavior.
 
The provision for credit losses associated with credit card receivables decreased $129 million during the first quarter of 2011 compared to the year-ago quarter reflecting lower receivable levels, improved economic and credit conditions, including lower dollars of delinquency, improvements in early stage delinquency roll rates and higher recovery rates. Lower receivable levels reflect fewer active customer accounts and an increased focus by consumers to pay down credit card debt. The impact on credit card receivable losses from the current economic environment, including high unemployment levels, has not been as severe as originally expected due in part to improved customer payment behavior.
 
Provision expense associated with our auto finance portfolio decreased during the first quarter of 2011 as a result of the sale in August 2010 of the remaining auto loans purchased from HSBC Finance in August 2010.
 
Our methodology and accounting policies related to the allowance for credit losses are presented in "Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates" in MD&A and in Note 2, "Summary of Significant Accounting Policies and New Accounting Pronouncements" in our 2010 Form 10-K. See "Credit Quality" in this MD&A for additional discussion on the allowance for credit losses associated with our various loan portfolios.
 
Other Revenues The components of other revenues are summarized in the following table.
 
     
Increase
(Decrease)
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
Amount
%
 
(dollars are in millions)
Credit card fees
$169
$233
$(64)
(27.5)%
Other fees and commissions
198
285
(87)
(30.5)
Trust income
28
26
2
7.7
Trading revenue
224
186
38
20.4
Net other-than-temporary impairment losses
-
(28)
28
100.0
Other securities gains, net
44
21
23
100+
HSBC affiliate income:
       
Fees and commissions
24
27
(3)
(11.1)
Other affiliate income
22
6
16
100+
Total HSBC affiliate income
46
33
13
39.4
Residential mortgage banking revenue (loss)(1)
(35)
(37)
2
5.4
Gain (loss) on instruments at fair value and related derivatives
21
46
(25)
(54.3)
Other income:
       
Valuation of loans held for sale
(5)
77
(82)
(100+)
Insurance
3
5
(2)
(40.0)
Earnings from equity investments
10
3
7
100+
Miscellaneous income
21
73
(52)
(71.2)
Total other income
29
158
(129)
(81.6)
Total other revenues
$724
$923
$(199)
(21.6)%
____________
 
(1)
Includes servicing fees received from HSBC Finance of $2 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010.
 

 

Credit Card Fees Lower credit card fees during the first quarter of 2011 was due primarily to lower receivable levels as a result of fewer active customer accounts, changes in customer behavior, improved delinquency levels and the implementation of certain provisions of the Card Act subsequent to January 2010. The Card Act has resulted in significant decreases in overlimit fees as customers must now opt-in for such fees, restrictions on fees charged to process on-line and telephone payments and lower late fees due to limits on fees that can be assessed all of which are considered in determining the purchase price of the receivables purchased daily from HSBC Finance. Also contributing to the decrease were higher revenue share payments due to improved cash flows and renegotiation of certain merchant agreements since March 2010.
 
Other fees and commissions Other fee-based income decreased during the first quarter of 2011 largely due to lower refund anticipation loan fees as we did not offer these products during the 2011 tax season. Also contributing to the decline were lower loan syndication fees.
 
Trust income Trust income increased in the first quarter of 2011 due to an increase in fee income associated with our management of fixed income assets, partially offset by reduced fee income associated with the continued decline in money market assets under management.
 
Trading revenue is generated by participation in the foreign exchange, rates, credit and precious metals markets. The following table presents trading related revenue by business. The data in the table includes net interest income earned on trading instruments, as well as an allocation of the funding benefit or cost associated with the trading positions. The trading related net interest income component is included in net interest income on the consolidated statement of income. Trading revenues related to the mortgage banking business are included in residential mortgage banking revenue.
 
     
Increase
(Decrease)
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
Amount
%
 
(dollars are in millions)
Trading revenue
$224
$186
$38
20.4%
Net interest income
11
3
8
100+
Trading related revenue
$235
$189
$46
24.3%
Business:
       
Derivatives
$164
$107
$57
53.3%
Balance sheet management
5
21
(16)
(76.2)
Foreign exchange
42
36
6
16.7
Precious metals
20
20
-
-
Global banking
-
(5)
5
100.0
Other trading
4
10
(6)
(60.0)
Trading related revenue
$235
$189
$46
24.3%
 
Trading revenue increased during the first quarter of 2011 reflecting continuing improvements in market conditions during the quarter and continued reductions in counterparty exposure.
 
Trading revenue related to derivatives improved during the first quarter of 2011 largely due to increased new deal activity in interest rate swaps as higher demand for the product was related to the strong corporate debt issuance market. Demand for Emerging Markets focused products, especially cross currency swaps, also led to higher revenue. The performance of credit derivatives also increased during the first quarter of 2011 as credit spread volatility and the outlook for corporate defaults has stabilized.
 
Trading income related to balance sheet management activities declined during the first quarter of 2011 primarily due to lower net interest income as holdings of certain collateralized mortgage obligations were sold for risk management purposes.

 
Foreign exchange trading revenue increased during the first quarter of 2011 due to increased trading volumes and market volatility.
 
Precious metals volumes remained flat during the three months ended March 31, 2011 as customer demand for metals as a perceived safe haven investment remained stable.
 
Global banking trading revenue improved during the first quarter of 2011 as the business continued to reduce its risk exposure.
 
Other trading revenue decreased during the first quarter of 2011 as the prior year period benefitted from a one time settlement of a counterparty receivable.
 
Net Other-Than-Temporary Impairment Losses During the three months ended March 31, 2011 there were no other-than-temporary impairment losses recognized. During the three months ended March 31, 2010, 19 debt securities were determined to have either initial other-than-temporary impairment or changes to previous other-than-temporary impairment estimates with only the credit component of such other-than-temporary impairment recognized in earnings. The following table presents the other-than-temporary impairment recognized in earnings.
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Other-than-temporary impairment losses recognized in the consolidated statement of income
$-
$(28)
 
Other Securities Gains, Net We maintain various securities portfolios as part of our balance sheet diversification and risk management strategies. During the first quarter of 2011, we sold $8.5 billion of U.S. Treasury, mortgage-backed and other asset-backed securities as part of a strategy to adjust portfolio risk duration as well as to reduce risk-weighted asset levels and recognized gains of $82 million and losses of $38 million, which is included as a component of other security gains, net above. During the first quarter of 2010, we sold $4.0 billion of these securities and recognized gains of $32 million and losses of $11 million. Gross realized gains and losses from sales of securities are summarized in Note 4, "Securities," in the accompanying consolidated financial statements.
 
HSBC affiliate income Affiliate income increased during the first quarter of 2011 due to higher fees and commissions earned from HSBC Finance affiliates as compared to the year-ago quarter driven by the transfer in July 2010 of certain real estate default servicing employees from HSBC Finance, partially offset by lower fees and commissions earned from HSBC Markets USA ("HMUS") and other HSBC affiliates and lower fees on tax refund anticipation loans as we did not offer this loan program during the 2011 tax season.
 
Residential Mortgage Banking Revenue (Loss) The following table presents the components of residential mortgage banking revenue. The net interest income component of the table is included in net interest income
in the consolidated statement of income and reflects actual interest earned, net of interest expense and corporate transfer pricing.
 
     
Increase
(Decrease)
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
Amount
%
 
(dollars are in millions)
Net interest income
$60
$56
$4
7.1%
Servicing related income:
       
Servicing fee income
28
32
(4)
(12.5)
Changes in fair value of MSRs due to:
       
Changes in valuation inputs or assumptions used in valuation model
5
5
-
-
Realization of cash flows
(19)
(27)
8
29.6
Trading - Derivative instruments used to offset changes in value of MSRs
(16)
11
(27)
(100+)
Total servicing related income
(2)
21
(23)
(100+)
Originations and sales related income (loss):
       
Gains on sales of residential mortgages
16
13
3
23.1
Provision for repurchase obligations
(44)
(73)
29
39.7
Trading and hedging activity
(12)
(5)
(7)
(100+)
Total originations and sales related income (loss)
(40)
(65)
25
38.5
Other mortgage income
7
7
-
-
Total residential mortgage banking revenue included in other revenues
(35)
(37)
2
5.4
Total residential mortgage banking related revenue
$25
$19
$6
31.6%
 
Higher net interest income during the first quarter of 2011 reflects wider spreads on flat average outstanding balances offset by increased deferred cost amortization. We continue to sell the majority of new loan originations to government sponsored enterprises. Consistent with our Premier strategy, additions to the portfolio are comprised largely of Premier relationship products.
 
Total servicing related income decreased during the first quarter of 2011 due to deterioration in net hedged MSR performance and lower servicing fee income as the average serviced loan portfolio declined as new originations sold were more than offset by prepayments, partially offset by decreased realization of cash flows.
 
Originations and sales related income (loss) improved during the first quarter of 2011, driven largely by lower loss provisions for loan repurchase obligations associated with loans previously sold. During the three months ended March 31, 2011, we recorded a charge of $44 million due to an increase in our estimated exposure associated with repurchase obligations on loans previously sold compared to a charge of $73 million recorded in the year-ago quarter for such exposure.
 
Gain (loss) on instruments designated at fair value and related derivatives We have elected to apply fair value option accounting to commercial leveraged acquisition finance loans, unfunded commitments, certain own fixed-rate debt issuances and all structured notes and structured deposits issued after January 1, 2006 that contain embedded derivatives. We also use derivatives to economically hedge the interest rate risk associated with certain financial instruments for which fair value has been elected. See Note 11, "Fair Value Option," in the accompanying consolidated financial statements for additional information including a breakout of these amounts by individual component.
 
Valuation of loans held for sale Valuation adjustments on loans held for sale in the prior year quarter includes an $89 million settlement relating to certain whole loans previously purchased for re-sale from a third party. Excluding
the impact of this item, valuation adjustments on loans held for sale improved in 2011 due to lower balances and reduced volatility. Valuations on loans held for sale relate primarily to residential mortgage loans purchased from third parties and HSBC affiliates with the intent of securitization or sale. Included in this portfolio are sub-prime residential mortgage loans with a fair value of $304 million and $391 million as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. Loans held for sale are recorded at the lower of their aggregate cost or market value, with adjustments to market value being recorded as a valuation allowance. Valuations on residential mortgage loans we originate are recorded as a component of residential mortgage banking revenue in the consolidated statement of income.
 
Other Income Excluding the valuation of loans held for sale as discussed above, other income decreased during the three months ended March 31, 2011 as the year-ago quarter included a gain of $66 million relating to the sale of our equity investment in Wells Fargo HSBC Trade Bank ("WHTB") as well as a $5 million payment as a final payment from a judgment related to our purchase of a community bank from CT Financial Services.
 
Operating Expenses The components of operating expenses are summarized in the following tables.
 
     
Increase
(Decrease)
Three Months Ended March
2011
2010
Amount
%
 
(dollars are in millions)
Salaries and employee benefits:
       
Salaries
$162
$138
$24
17.4%
Employee benefits
131
126
5
4.0
Total salaries and employee benefits
293
264
29
11.0
Occupancy expense, net
68
71
(3)
(4.2)
Support services from HSBC affiliates:
       
Fees paid to HSBC Finance for loan servicing and other administrative support
154
224
(70)
(31.3)
Fees paid to HMUS
59
83
(24)
(28.9)
Fees paid to HTSU
206
172
34
19.8
Fees paid to other HSBC affiliates
42
31
11
35.5
Total support services from HSBC affiliates
461
510
(49)
(9.6)
Other expenses:
       
Equipment and software
90
10
80
100+
Marketing
18
28
(10)
(35.7)
Outside services
26
22
4
18.2
Professional fees
38
12
26
100+
Postage, printing and office supplies
4
4
-
-
Off-balance sheet credit reserves
(12)
(8)
(4)
(50.0)
FDIC assessment fee
35
36
(1)
(2.8)
Insurance business
(1)
(1)
-
-
Miscellaneous
80
106
(26)
(24.5)
Total other expenses
278
209
69
33.0
Total operating expenses
$1,100
$1,054
$46
4.4%
Personnel - average number
10,361
9,029
   
Efficiency ratio
62.22%
49.66%
   
 

 

Salaries and employee benefits Salaries and employee benefits expense increased during the first quarter of 2011 driven by increased costs associated with the transfer in July 2010 of certain employees from HSBC Finance to the default mortgage loan servicing department of a subsidiary of HSBC Bank USA, partially offset by continued cost management efforts.
 
Occupancy expense, net Occupancy expense decreased during the first quarter of 2011, as amounts in 2010 include $8 million in lease abandonment costs associated with the closure of several non-strategic branches. Excluding the impact of this item, occupancy expense increased during the three months ended March 31, 2011, reflecting higher costs associated with the expansion of our core banking network within the PFS segment resulting in higher rental expenses, depreciation of leasehold improvements, utilities and other occupancy expenses.
 
Support services from HSBC affiliates includes technology and certain centralized support services, including human resources, corporate affairs and other shared services, legal, compliance, tax and finance charged to us by HTSU. Support services from HSBC affiliates also includes services charged to us by an HSBC affiliate located outside of the United States which provides operational support to our businesses, including among other areas, customer service, systems, risk management, collection and accounting functions as well as servicing fees paid to HSBC Finance for servicing nonconforming residential mortgage loans, private label card receivables, credit card receivables and auto finance receivables until the auto finance portfolio was sold in August 2010.
 
Lower support services from HSBC affiliates during the first quarter of 2011 reflects lower charges from HSBC Finance due to lower levels of receivables being serviced, including lower levels of credit card loans and the impact of the sale in 2010 of all remaining auto loans purchased from HSBC Finance and lower expenses for servicing and assuming the credit risk associated with refund anticipation loans originated as we did not offer this loan program during the 2011 tax season. These decreases were partially offset by higher compliance costs.
 
Marketing expenses Lower marketing and promotional expenses resulted from continued optimization of marketing spend as a result of general cost saving initiatives, partially offset by a continuing investment in HSBC brand activities, primarily within the PFS and CMB business segments.
 
Other expenses Other expenses (excluding marketing expenses) increased during the first quarter of 2011 primarily due to a charge of $78 million included within equipment and software relating to the impairment of certain previously capitalized software development costs which are no longer realizable, as well as higher professional fees driven by increased compliance costs.
 
Efficiency ratio Our efficiency ratio, which is the ratio of total operating expenses, reduced by minority interests, to the sum of net interest income and other revenues, was 62.22 percent during the three months ended March 31, 2011 compared to 49.66 percent during the prior year quarter. The deterioration during the first quarter of 2011 reflects higher operating expenses driven by an impairment of certain software development costs while the total of net interest income and other revenues declined. Excluding the impact of the software development cost impairment, our efficiency ratio for the first quarter of 2011 was 57.81 percent.
 
Segment Results - IFRSs Basis
 
As discussed in our 2010 Form 10-K, we initiated a process in late 2010 to re-evaluate the financial information used to manage our business including the scope and content of the financial data being reported to our management and Board of Directors. During the first quarter of 2011, we completed our evaluation and decided we would no longer manage and evaluate the performance of the receivables purchased from HSBC Finance as a separate operating segment. Rather, we would manage and evaluate the performance of these assets as a component of our Personal Financial Services operating segment, consistent with HSBC's globally defined business segments. As a result, beginning in the first quarter of 2011, our management reporting was changed to reflect this decision and going forward we will now report our financial results under four reportable segments: Personal Financial Services, Commercial Banking, Global Banking and Markets and Private Banking. Segment financial information has been restated for all periods presented to reflect this new segmentation. There have been no other changes in the basis of our segmentation or measurement of segment profit as compared with the presentation in our 2010 Form 10-K. Our segment results are reported on a continuing operations basis.
 
HSBC previously announced that with effect from March 1, 2011, Retail Banking and Wealth Management would be managed as a single global business. This business is the existing Personal Financial Services with Asset Management moving from Global Banking and Markets to this new single business. Therefore, to coincide with the change in our management reporting effective beginning in the second quarter of 2011, we will change the name of our Personal Financial Services segment to Retail Banking and Wealth Management and will include the results of Asset Management in this segment for all periods presented.
 
We report to our parent, HSBC, in accordance with its reporting basis, IFRSs. As a result, our segment results are presented on an IFRSs Basis (a non-U.S. GAAP financial measure) as operating results are monitored and reviewed, trends are evaluated and decisions about allocating resources such as employees are made almost exclusively on an IFRSs basis. However, we continue to monitor capital adequacy, establish dividend policy and report to regulatory agencies on a U.S. GAAP basis. The significant differences between U.S. GAAP and IFRSs as they impact our results are summarized in Note 16, "Business Segments," in the accompanying consolidated financial statements and under the caption "Basis of Reporting" in this MD&A.
 
Personal Financial Services ("PFS")  Our PFS segment provides banking and wealth products and services, including personal loans, private label and credit card loans, deposits, branch services and financial planning products and services such as mutual funds, investments and insurance. All of our private label card receivables and a substantial majority of our credit card receivables are purchased daily from HSBC Finance.
 
During the first quarter of 2011, we continue to direct resources towards the expansion of the core retail banking business and in particular the growth of wealth services and HSBC Premier, HSBC's global banking service that offers customers a seamless international service. Premier customers increased to approximately 503,000 at March 31, 2011, a 3 percent increase from December 31, 2010 and a 31 percent increase from March 31, 2010. We remain focused on providing differentiated premium services to the internationally minded mass affluent and upwardly mobile customers.
 
We continue to sell the majority of new residential mortgage loan originations to government sponsored enterprises. Consistent with our strategy, additions to our portfolio are primarily comprised of Premier relationship products. In addition to normal sales activity, at times we have historically sold prime adjustable and fixed rate mortgage loan portfolios to third parties, however no such sales occurred during 2011 or 2010. We retain the servicing rights in relation to the mortgages upon sale. As a result, average residential mortgage loans outstanding have continued to decline during the first quarter of 2011.
 
The following table summarizes the IFRSs Basis results for our PFS segment:
 
     
Increase
(Decrease)
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
Amount
%
 
(dollars are in millions)
Net interest income
$656
$764
$(108)
(14.1)%
Other operating income
27
66
(39)
(59.1)
Total operating income
683
830
(147)
(17.7)
Loan impairment charges
151
207
(56)
(27.1)
 
532
623
(91)
(14.6)
Operating expenses
458
300
158
52.7
Profit before tax
$74
$323
$(249)
(77.1)%
 

 

Our PFS segment reported a lower profit before tax during the first quarter of 2011 than during the prior year quarter reflecting lower net interest income, lower other operating income and higher operating expenses, partially offset by lower loan impairment charges.
 
Net interest income was lower during the first quarter of 2011 driven by lower outstanding private label card and credit card loans as well as lower auto loan receivables as a result of the sale of the auto loan portfolio in August 2010. The decrease also reflected lower credit card and private label card yields due to higher premium amortization and the implementation of certain provisions of the Card Act including restrictions impacting repricing of delinquent accounts and periodic re-evaluation of rate increases. These decreases were partially offset by lower charge-offs of credit card and private label credit card interest driven by lower outstanding balances and improved delinquencies, higher finance charges from the GM and UP portfolios previously recorded at fair value, which continue to decline and be replaced with new volume and a lower cost of funds on cards due to a lower short-term interest rate environment as well as rate reductions on customer deposits.
 
Other operating income decreased during the first quarter of 2011, primarily due to lower fee income resulting from lower levels of credit card and private label card receivables outstanding including lower late and over limit fees on these portfolios driven by changes in customer behavior and the impact of the Card Act, lower delinquency levels and higher revenue share payments. The decrease also reflects changes in the ability to charge overdraft fees implemented on July 1, 2010 which resulted in lower deposit fee income as compared to the prior year quarter. These decreases were partially offset by lower servicing fees on portfolios serviced by our affiliate, HSBC Finance (which is recorded as a reduction to other operating income) due to lower outstanding receivable levels and a lower provision for loan repurchase obligations in the first quarter of 2011 associated with previously sold loans.
 
Loan impairment charges continued to decline during the first quarter of 2011, driven largely by lower loan balances and improvements in private label credit card and credit card credit quality as dollars of delinquency continued to decline leading to continued improvements in our future loss estimates. Loan impairment charges associated with credit card receivables, including private label credit card receivables, also reflect fewer active customer accounts and higher customer payment rates. The improvement in credit quality reflects improved economic conditions, including improvements in early stage delinquency roll rates and, as it relates to credit cards and private label credit cards, changes in customer payment behavior and higher recovery rates. These factors were partially offset by continued high levels of unemployment and, as it relates to residential mortgage loans, continued weakness in the housing market including depressed property values.
 
Operating expenses increased during the first quarter of 2011 driven primarily by the impairment of certain previously capitalized software development costs. In addition, there were higher costs from compliance and technology, branch expansion, and fraud expenses. There were also higher pension costs as the prior year quarter includes a $48 million pension curtailment gain as a result of the decision in February 2010 to cease all future benefit accruals for legacy participants under the final average pay formula components of the HSBC North America defined benefit pension plan effective January 1, 2011.
 
Commercial Banking ("CMB") Our Commercial Banking segment serves three client groups, notably Middle Market Enterprises, Business Banking and Commercial Real Estate. CMB's business strategy is to be the leader in international banking in target markets. In the U.S., CMB strives to execute on that vision and strategy by proactively targeting the growing number of U.S. companies that are increasingly in need of international banking, financial products and services. The products and services provided to these client groups are offered through multiple delivery systems including the branch banking network. We continue to focus on building our core proposition to mid size international companies, including expansion opportunities on the west coast and in Texas and Florida.
 
During the first quarter of 2011, interest rate spreads continued to be pressured from a low interest rate environment while loan impairment charges improved. An increase in demand for loans which began towards the end of 2010 and continued during the first quarter of 2011 has resulted in a 16 percent increase in loans outstanding to middle-market customers since March 31, 2010. The business banking loan portfolio has seen a 4 percent decrease in loans outstanding since March 31, 2010 resulting from an increase in paydowns and a decline in the demand for new credit facilities. The commercial real estate business continues to focus on deal quality and portfolio management rather than volume, which resulted in a 7 percent decline in outstanding receivables for this portfolio since March 31, 2010. Average customer deposit balances across all CMB business lines during the first quarter of 2011 increased 6 percent as compared to the year-ago quarter and average loans increased 2 percent as compared to the year-ago quarter.
 
The following table summarizes the IFRSs Basis results for our CMB segment:
 
     
Increase
(Decrease)
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
Amount
%
 
(dollars are in millions)
Net interest income
$175
$188
$(13)
(6.9)%
Other operating income
105
154
(49)
(31.8)
Total operating income
280
342
(62)
(18.1)
Loan impairment charges (recoveries)
(30)
1
(31)
(100+)
 
310
341
(31)
(9.1)
Operating expenses
176
150
26
17.3
Profit before tax
$134
$191
$(57)
(29.8)%
 
Our CMB segment reported a lower profit before tax during the first quarter of 2011 as lower net interest income, lower other operating income and higher operating expenses were partially offset by lower loan impairment charges.
 
Net interest income decreased during the first quarter of 2011 as lower deposit spreads resulting from changing product mix which was partially offset by higher loan balances.
 
Other operating income decreased during the first quarter of 2011 as higher fee income and higher gains on the sale of certain commercial real estate assets were more than offset by the impact of a $66 million gain recorded during the first quarter of 2010 on the sale of our equity investment in WHTB.
 
Loan impairment charges decreased in the first quarter of 2011 largely driven by lower reserves required on troubled debt restructures in commercial real estate and middle market enterprises as well as lower charge-offs in business banking due to improved credit quality and lower delinquency levels.
 
Operating expenses increased during the three months ended March 31, 2011 due to higher expenses relating to infrastructure costs such as compliance, partially offset by lower technology costs. Additionally, the first quarter of 2010 includes a $16 million pension curtailment gain as previously discussed.
 
Global Banking and Markets Our Global Banking and Markets business segment supports HSBC's emerging markets-led and financing-focused global strategy by leveraging HSBC Group advantages and scale, strength in developed and emerging markets and Global Markets products expertise in order to focus on delivering international products to U.S. clients and local products to international clients, with New York as the hub for the Americas business.
 
There are four major lines of business within Global Banking and Markets: Global Banking, Global Markets, Transaction Banking and Asset Management. The Global Banking business line includes corporate lending and investment banking activities, and this unit also coordinates client relationships across all Global Markets and Banking products. The Global Markets business services the requirements of the world's central banks, corporations, institutional investors and financial institutions through our global trading platforms and distribution capabilities. Transaction Banking provides payments and cash management, trade finance, supply chain and security services primarily to corporations and financial institutions. Asset Management provides investment solutions to institutions, financial intermediaries and individual investors.
 

The Global Banking and Markets segment results during the first quarter of 2011 continued to benefit from improved credit market conditions, which when combined with our risk management efforts, led to an increase in the credit quality of our corporate lending relationships, lower securities impairment charges, and improved performance in certain legacy positions. The improved credit quality of the portfolio and improved market conditions resulted in a tightening of the net interest margin in the Global Banking and Markets portfolio. As credit markets continued to remain stable during the first quarter of 2011, results from legacy positions including credit derivatives and subprime mortgage loans contributed to higher other operating income.
 
The following table summarizes IFRSs Basis results for the Global Banking and Markets segment.
 
     
Increase
(Decrease)
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
Amount
%
 
(dollars are in millions)
Net interest income
$132
$142
$(10)
(7.0)%
Other operating income
429
412
17
4.1
Total operating income
561
554
7
1.3
Loan impairment charges (recoveries)
(17)
(76)
59
77.6
 
578
630
(52)
(8.3)
Operating expenses
242
200
42
21.0
Profit before tax
$336
$430
$(94)
(21.9)%
 
Our Global Banking and Markets segment reported a lower profit before tax during the first quarter of 2011 driven by lower net interest income, lower recoveries of loan impairment charges and higher operating expenses, which was partially offset by higher other operating income.
 
Net interest income decreased during the first quarter of 2011 due to lower yields on our available-for-sale securities portfolio, as the proceeds from maturing securities and securities sales were reinvested in the prevailing low interest rate environment and in securities with a lower risk profile. Also contributing to lower net interest income were lower loan balances as the business continues to manage risk exposures.
 
Other operating income increased during the first quarter of 2011 due to higher realized gains on the sale of available-for-sale securities made for risk management purposes. Also contributing to the increase were improved trading results in interest rate derivatives and emerging markets derivatives from increased deal volumes. Revenues from structured credit products also improved from a continued decrease in monoline exposure and favorable credit spread movements. Foreign exchange and precious metals trading increased as a result of higher volumes and market volatility. Partially offsetting these increases in the current period comparative results was a gain of $89 million associated with a settlement relating to certain loans previously purchased for resale from a third party included in the prior year period.
 
Other operating income reflects gains on structured credit products of $80 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 compared to gains of $59 million during the year-ago quarter. Exposure to insurance monolines continued to impact revenues resulting in gains of $16 million during the three months ended March 31, 2011 compared to $56 million during the year-ago quarter. Valuation losses of $2 million during the first quarter of 2011 were recorded against the fair values of sub-prime residential mortgage loans held for sale as compared to valuation losses of $11 million during the prior year period.
 
Recoveries of loan impairment charges were lower during the first quarter of 2011 as reductions in higher risk rated loan balances and stabilization of credit downgrades in both periods resulted in an overall higher release in loss reserves during the year-ago quarter.
 
Operating expenses increased during the first quarter of 2011 driven by higher staff and compliance costs, partially offset by continuing decreases in legal and professional costs due to the curtailment of the sub-prime residential
mortgage securitization and structured credit product activities. The prior year quarter also included a $7 million pension curtailment gain.
 
Private Banking ("PB") As part of HSBC's global network, the PB segment offers integrated domestic and international services to high net worth individuals, their families and their businesses. These services address both resident and non-resident financial needs. During the first quarter of 2011, we continued to dedicate resources to strengthen product and service leadership in the wealth management market. Areas of focus are banking and cash management, investment advice including discretionary portfolio management, banking and cash management, residential mortgages, as well as wealth planning for trusts and estates.
 
Average client deposit levels decreased 1 percent compared to the prior year quarter as withdrawals in deposits from international core clients was partially offset by increased deposits from domestic clients. Total average loans decreased 6 percent compared to the prior year quarter from pay offs and reductions of commercial loan borrowings partially offset by growth in the tailored mortgage product. Overall client assets remained flat at $45.0 billion compared to the prior year quarter as increases in assets from core domestic and international clients was offset by withdrawals from institutional clients.
 
The following table summarizes IFRSs Basis results for the PB segment.
 
     
Increase
(Decrease)
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
Amount
%
 
(dollars are in millions)
Net interest income
$46
$46
$-
-%
Other operating income
36
35
1
      2.9
Total operating income
82
81
1
1.2
Loan impairment charges (recoveries)
(9)
(11)
2
18.2
 
91
92
(1)
(1.1)
Operating expenses
64
55
9
16.4
Profit before tax
$27
$37
$(10)
(27.0)%
 
Our PB segment reported a lower profit before tax during the first quarter of 2011 driven by higher operating expenses including the impact of a pension gain in the prior year quarter and lower recoveries of loan impairment charges.
 
Net interest income remained flat during the first quarter of 2011 due to improvement of lending and banking spreads, offset by lower corporate allocated revenues.
 
Other operating income increased slightly during the first quarter of 2011 primarily due to higher fees on managed products, structured products, insurance products and recurring fund fees.
 
Recoveries on loan impairment charges during the first quarter of 2011 decreased as reserve releases relating to certain exposures due to improved credit conditions and client credit ratings were lower as compared to the corresponding releases in the first quarter of 2010.
 
Operating expenses increased during the first quarter of 2011 due to higher costs for shared services. Additionally, the year-ago quarter included a $5 million pension curtailment gain as previously discussed.
 
Other The other segment primarily includes adjustments made at the corporate level for fair value option accounting related to certain debt issued, the offset to funding credits provided to CMB for holding certain investments, income and expense associated with certain affiliate transactions, adjustments to the fair value on HSBC shares held for stock plans, and in 2010, gains on the sale of various owned properties and the impact of the resolution of a lawsuit as discussed below.
 

The following table summarizes IFRSs Basis results for the Other segment.
 
     
Increase
(Decrease)
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
Amount
%
 
(dollars are in millions)
Net interest income
$(64)
$(9)
$(55)
(100+)%
Gain (loss) on own debt designated at fair value and related derivatives
(32)
12
(44)
(100+)
Other operating income
(4)
-
(4)
(100+)
Total operating income
(100)
3
(103)
(100+)
Loan impairment charges
-
2
(2)
(100+)
 
(100)
1
(101)
(100+)
Operating expenses
17
15
2
13.3
Loss before tax
$(117)
$(14)
$(103)
(100+)%
 
Loss before tax increased $103 million in the first quarter of 2011, driven largely by lower net interest income due to increased interest expense associated with changes in estimated tax exposure as well as credit and interest rate related changes in the fair value of certain owned debt instruments for which fair value option was elected. Along with the related fair value option derivatives, we recorded total losses of $32 million compared to gains of $12 million for the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively relating to these instruments.
 
Reconciliation of Segment Results As previously discussed, segment results are reported on an IFRS Basis. See Note 16, "Business Segments," in the accompanying consolidated financial statements for a discussion of the differences between IFRSs and U.S. GAAP. For segment reporting purposes, intersegment transactions have not been eliminated. We generally account for transactions between segments as if they were with third parties. Also see Note 16, "Business Segments," in the accompanying consolidated financial statements for a reconciliation of our IFRS Basis segment results to U.S. GAAP consolidated totals.
 
Credit Quality
 
In the normal course of business, we enter into a variety of transactions that involve both on and off-balance sheet credit risk. Principal among these activities is lending to various commercial, institutional, governmental and individual customers. We participate in lending activity throughout the U.S. and, on a limited basis, internationally.
 
Allowance for Credit Losses For commercial loans, we conduct a periodic assessment on a loan-by-loan basis of losses we believe to be inherent in the loan portfolio. When it is deemed probable based upon known facts and circumstances that full contractual interest and principal on an individual loan will not be collected in accordance with its contractual terms, the loan is considered impaired. An impairment reserve is established based on the present value of expected future cash flows, discounted at the loan's original effective interest rate, or as a practical expedient, the loan's observable market price or the fair value of the collateral if the loan is collateral dependent. Updated appraisals for collateral dependent loans are generally obtained only when such loans are considered troubled and the frequency of such updates are generally based on management judgment under the specific circumstances on a case-by-case basis. Problem commercial loans are assigned various obligor grades under the allowance for credit losses methodology. Each credit grade has a probability of default estimate.
 
Our credit grades align with U.S. regulatory risk ratings and are mapped to our probability of default master scale. These probability of default estimates are validated on an annual basis using back-testing of actual default rates and benchmarking of the internal ratings with external rating agency data like S&P ratings and default rates. Substantially all appraisals in connection with commercial real estate loans are ordered by the independent real estate appraisal unit at HSBC. The appraisal must be reviewed and accepted by this unit. For loans greater than $250,000, an appraisal is generally ordered when the loan is classified as Substandard as defined by the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency. On average, it is approximately four weeks from the time the appraisal is ordered until it is completed and the values accepted by HSBC's independent appraisal review unit. Subsequent provisions or charge-offs are completed shortly thereafter, generally within the quarter in which the appraisal is received.
 
In situations where an external appraisal is not used to determine the fair value the underlying collateral of impaired loans, current information such as rent rolls and operating statements of the subject property are reviewed and presented in a standardized format. Operating results such as net operating income and cash flows before and after debt service are established and reported with relevant ratios. Third-party market data is gathered and reviewed for relevance to the subject collateral. Data is also collected from similar properties within the portfolio. Actual sales levels of condominiums, operating income and expense figures and rental data on a square foot basis are derived from existing loans and, when appropriate, used as comparables for the subject property. Property specific data, augmented by market data research, is used to project a stabilized year of income and expense to create a 10-year cash flow model to be discounted at appropriate rates into present value. These valuations are then used to determine if any impairment on the underlying loans exists and an appropriate allowance is recorded when warranted.
 
Probable losses for pools of homogeneous consumer loans are generally estimated using a roll rate migration analysis that estimates the likelihood that a loan will progress through the various stages of delinquency, or buckets, and ultimately charge off. This analysis considers delinquency status, loss experience and severity and takes into account whether loans are in bankruptcy, have been re-aged or are subject to forbearance, an external debt management plan, hardship, modification, extension or deferment. The allowance for credit losses on consumer receivables also takes into consideration the loss severity expected based on the underlying collateral, if any, for the loan in the event of default based on historical and recent trends.
 
The roll rate methodology is a migration analysis based on contractual delinquency and rolling average historical loss experience which captures the increased likelihood of an account migrating to charge-off as the past due status of such account increases. The roll rate models used were developed by tracking the movement of delinquencies by age of delinquency by month (bucket) over a specified time period. Each "bucket" represents a period of delinquency in 30-day increments. The roll from the last delinquency bucket results in charge-off. Contractual delinquency is a method for determining aging of past due accounts based on the status of payments under the loan. The roll percentages are converted to reserve requirements for each delinquency period (i.e., 30 days, 60 days, etc.). Average roll rates are developed to avoid temporary aberrations caused by seasonal trends in delinquency experienced by some product types. We have determined that a 12-month average roll rate balances the desire to avoid temporary aberrations, while at the same time analyzing recent historical data. The calculations are performed monthly and are done consistently from period to period. In addition, loss reserves on consumer receivables including credit card receivables are maintained to reflect our judgment of portfolio risk factors which may not be fully reflected in the statistical roll rate calculation.
 
Our allowance for credit losses methodology and our accounting policies related to the allowance for credit losses are presented in further detail under the caption "Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates" and in Note 2, "Summary of Significant Accounting Policies and New Accounting Pronouncements," in our 2010 Form 10-K. Our approach toward credit risk management is summarized under the caption "Risk Management" in our 2010 Form 10-K. There have been no material revisions to our policies or methodologies during the first quarter of 2011, although we continue to monitor current market conditions and will adjust credit policies as deemed necessary.
 
 

The following table sets forth the allowance for credit losses for the periods indicated:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(dollars are in millions)
Allowance for credit losses
$1,832
$2,170
Ratio of Allowance for credit losses to:
   
Loans:(1)
   
Commercial
1.55%
1.77%
Consumer:
   
Residential mortgages, excluding home equity mortgages
1.18
1.22
Home equity mortgages
1.82
2.02
Private label card receivables
5.19
5.66
Credit card receivables
4.69
5.60
Other consumer loans
2.39
2.73
Total consumer loans
3.32
3.82
Total
2.55%
2.97%
Net charge-offs(1)(2):
   
Commercial
909.43%
158.58%
Consumer
77.05
66.34
Total
101.50%
77.47%
Nonperforming loans(1):
   
Commercial
52.74%
53.76%
Consumer
98.11
103.94
Total
80.00%
84.47%
____________
 
(1)
Ratios exclude loans held for sale as these loans are carried at the lower of cost or fair value.
   
(2)
Quarter-to-date net charge-offs, annualized.
 

 

Changes in the allowance for credit losses by general loan categories for the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010 are summarized in the following table:
 
 
Commercial
Consumer
   
Residential
           
   
Business
   
Mortgage,
           
 
Construction
Banking and
   
Excl Home
Home
Private
       
 
and Other
Middle Market
Large
Other
Equity
Equity
Label
Credit
Auto
Other
 
 
Real Estate
Enterprises
Corporate
Comm'l
Mortgages
Mortgages
Card
Card
Finance(1)
Consumer
Total
 
(in millions)
Three months ended March 31, 2011:
                     
Allowance for credit losses - beginning of period
$243
$132
$116
$45
$167
$77
$752
$606
$-
$32
$2,170
Provision charged to income
(28)
(2)
(5)
(6)
21
10
51
61
-
4
106
Charge offs
(4)
(13)
-
(5)
(26)
(20)
(225)
(229)
-
(13)
(535)
Recoveries
6
2
-
1
1
-
46
31
-
3
90
Net charge offs
2
(11)
-
(4)
(25)
(20)
(179)
(198)
-
(10)
(445)
Other
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
1
-
-
1
Allowance for credit losses - end of period
$217
$119
$111
$35
$163
$67
$624
$470
$-
$26
$1,832
Three months ended March 31, 2010:
                     
Balances at beginning of period
$303
$184
$301
$150
$347
$185
$1,184
$1,106
$36
$65
$3,861
Provision charged to income
2
3
(77)
(1)
(19)
(21)
109
190
25
-
211
Charge offs
(16)
(28)
(4)
(61)
(49)
(36)
(335)
(360)
(24)
(21)
(934)
Recoveries
3
6
-
1
1
-
42
25
-
4
82
Net charge offs
(13)
(22)
(4)
(60)
(48)
(36)
(293)
(335)
(24)
(17)
(852)
Other
-
-
-
1
-
-
-
3
-
-
4
Balance at end of period
$292
$165
$220
$90
$280
$128
$1,000
$964
$37
$48
$3,224
____________
 
(1)
In August 2010, we sold all the remaining auto loans previously purchased from HSBC Finance.
 
The allowance for credit losses at March 31, 2011 decreased $338 million, or 15.58 percent, since December 31, 2010 reflecting lower loss estimates in all of our consumer and commercial loan portfolios. The lower allowance on our private label credit card and credit card portfolio was due to lower receivable levels and improved credit quality including lower delinquency levels as well as an increased focus by consumers to reduce outstanding credit card debt. The lower delinquency levels also resulted from continued improvement in delinquency including early stage delinquency roll rates as economic conditions continued to improve. The decrease in the allowance for our residential mortgage loan portfolio and home equity line of credit ("HELOC") and home equity loan portfolios reflects lower dollars of delinquency and an improved outlook for incurred future losses. Reserve levels for all consumer loan categories however remain elevated due to ongoing weakness in the U.S. economy, including elevated unemployment rates and as it relates to residential mortgage loans, continued weakness in the housing market. Reserve requirements in our commercial loan portfolio have also declined due to pay-offs, including managed reductions in certain exposures and improvements in the financial circumstances of several customer relationships which led to credit upgrades on certain problem credits and lower levels of criticized assets.
 
The allowance for credit losses as a percentage of total loans at March 31, 2011 decreased as compared to December 31, 2010 for the reasons discussed above.
 
The allowance for credit losses as a percentage of net charge-offs improved in the first quarter of 2011, as the decline in dollars of net charge-off outpaced the decline in reserves. Net charge-off levels continued to decline in the first quarter of 2011 due to improved economic conditions and lower outstanding receivable balances as delinquency levels, including early stage delinquency roll rates continued to improve.
 
 

The allowance for credit losses by major loan categories, excluding loans held for sale, is presented in the following table:
 
 
March 31, 2011
December 31, 2010
 
 
 
 
Amount
% of
Loans to
Total
Loans(1)
 
 
 
Amount
% of
Loans to
Total
Loans(1)
 
(dollars are in millions)
Commercial(2)
$482
43.30%
$536
41.43%
Consumer:
       
Residential mortgages, excluding home equity mortgages
163
19.34
167
18.75
Home equity mortgages
67
5.13
77
5.23
Private label card receivables
624
16.75
752
18.20
Credit card receivables
470
13.96
606
14.80
Other consumer
26
1.52
32
1.59
Total consumer
1,350
56.70
1,634
58.57
Total
$1,832
100.00%
$2,170
100.00%
____________
 
(1)
Excludes loans held for sale.
   
(2)
Components of the commercial allowance for credit losses, including exposure relating to off-balance sheet credit risk, and the increases (decreases) since December 31, 2010, are summarized in the following table:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
On-balance sheet allowance:
   
Specific
$183
$178
Collective
274
335
Transfer risk
-
-
Unallocated
25
23
Total on-balance sheet allowance
482
536
Off-balance sheet allowance
176
94
Total commercial allowances
$658
$630
 
While our allowance for credit loss is available to absorb losses in the entire portfolio, we specifically consider the credit quality and other risk factors for each of our products in establishing the allowance for credit losses.
 
Reserves for Off-Balance Sheet Credit Risk We also maintain a separate reserve for credit risk associated with certain off-balance sheet exposures, including letters of credit, unused commitments to extend credit and financial guarantees. This reserve, included in other liabilities, was $176 million and $94 million at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. The related provision is recorded as a miscellaneous expense and is a component of operating expenses. The increase in off-balance sheet reserves at March 31, 2011 as compared to December 31, 2010 reflects the deconsolidation of the Bryant Park commercial paper conduit in the first quarter of 2011 which resulted in the establishment of a $94 million liability for our credit exposure related to our commitments to this entity. The increase was partially offset by improved credit conditions and lower outstanding exposure on other commitments. Off-balance sheet exposures are summarized under the caption "Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements and Contractual Obligations" in this MD&A.
 

Delinquency The following table summarizes dollars of two-months-and-over contractual delinquency and two-months-and-over contractual delinquency as a percent of total loans and loans held for sale ("delinquency ratio"):
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(dollars are in millions)
Dollars of Delinquency:
   
Commercial
$658
$765
Consumer:
   
Residential mortgage, excluding home equity mortgages(2)
1,164
1,248
Home equity mortgages
168
182
Total residential mortgages(1)
1,332
1,430
Private label card receivables
336
403
Credit card receivables
267
339
Other consumer
36
36
Total consumer
1,971
2,208
Total
$2,629
$2,973
Delinquency Ratio:
   
Commercial
2.06%
2.42%
Consumer:
   
Residential mortgage, excluding home equity mortgages
7.96
8.52
Home equity mortgages
4.57
4.76
Total residential mortgages(1)
7.28
7.74
Private label card receivables
2.80
3.03
Credit card receivables
2.67
3.13
Other consumer
3.08
2.88
Total consumer
4.75
5.04
Total
3.58%
3.93%
____________
 
(1)
The following reflects dollars of contractual delinquency and delinquency ratios for interest-only loans and ARM loans:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(dollars are in millions)
Dollars of Delinquency:
   
Interest-only loans
$127
$150
ARM loans
407
454
Delinquency Ratio:
   
Interest-only loans
4.56%
5.41%
ARM loans
5.03
5.67
 
(2)
At March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, residential mortgage loan delinquency includes $710 million and $852 million, respectively, of loans that are carried at the lower of cost or net realizable value.
 

 

Our total two-months-and-over contractual delinquency ratio decreased 35 basis points since December 31, 2010. Our two-months-and-over contractual delinquency ratio for consumer loans decreased to 4.75 percent at March 31, 2011 as compared to 5.04 percent at December 31, 2010, driven by declines in residential mortgage loan, private label card and credit card delinquency. Dollars of delinquency fell in almost all consumer portfolios. The decrease in dollars of delinquency in our private label card and credit card receivable portfolios reflect improving credit quality due to improved delinquency roll rates including early stage delinquency roll rates and the continued increased focus by consumers to make payments as well as seasonal improvements in collections activities during the first quarter of the year as some customers use their tax refunds to make payments. The decrease in our residential mortgage loan delinquency since December 31, 2010 reflects improved credit quality and seasonal improvements in collections during the first quarter of the year. Overall delinquency levels, however, continue to be impacted by elevated unemployment levels and, as it relates to residential mortgages, continued weakness in the housing market.
 
Our commercial two-months-and-over contractual delinquency ratio decreased 36 basis points since December 31, 2010 driven by lower dollars of commercial real estate delinquency while loans outstanding increased.
 

 

Net Charge-offs of Loans The following table summarizes net charge-off dollars as well as the net charge-off of loans for the quarter, annualized, as a percent of average loans, excluding loans held for sale, ("net charge-off ratio"):
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
March 31,
2010
 
(dollars are in millions)
Net Charge-off Dollars:
     
Commercial:
     
Construction and other real estate
$(2)
$77
$13
Business banking and middle market enterprises
11
13
21
Large corporate
-
(1)
4
Other commercial
4
7
61
Total commercial
13
96
99
Consumer:
     
Residential mortgage, excluding home equity mortgages
25
27
48
Home equity mortgages
20
23
36
Total residential mortgages
45
50
84
Private label card receivables
179
189
293
Credit card receivables
198
221
335
Auto finance(1)
-
-
24
Other consumer
10
9
17
Total consumer
432
469
753
Total
$445
$565
$852
Net Charge-off Ratio:
     
Commercial:
     
Construction and other real estate
(.10)%
3.63%
.60%
Business banking and middle market enterprises
.56
.66
1.22
Large corporate
-
(.04)
.14
Other commercial
.55
.98
6.40
Total commercial
.17
1.27
1.28
Consumer:
     
Residential mortgage, excluding home equity mortgages
.73
.78
1.43
Home equity mortgages
2.16
2.37
3.56
Total residential mortgages
1.04
1.13
1.92
Private label card receivables
5.74
5.92
8.29
Credit card receivables
7.77
8.18
10.94
Auto finance(1)
-
-
6.11
Other consumer
3.63
2.85
4.89
Total consumer
4.21
4.41
6.43
Total
2.50%
3.11%
4.40%
____________
 
(1)
In August 2010, we sold all the remaining auto loans previously purchased from HSBC Finance.
 

 

Our net charge-off ratio as a percentage of average loans decreased 61 basis points compared to the quarter ended December 31, 2010 primarily due to lower commercial, private label card and credit card charge-offs driven by lower receivable levels and improved credit quality. As it relates to private label card and credit card receivables, these favorable trends were partially offset by the impact from continued high unemployment levels.
 
Commercial charge-off dollars and ratios decreased compared to the prior quarter driven by lower charge-offs in construction and other real estate based on improving trends in portfolio quality.
 
Charge-off dollars and ratios in the residential mortgage loan portfolio improved modestly compared to the prior quarter reflecting improved credit quality including the impact of the lower delinquency levels we first began to experience in the second quarter of 2010. Charge-off dollars and ratios for private label card and credit card receivables declined compared to the prior quarter due to lower delinquency levels as a result of lower receivable balances including an increased focus by consumers to paydown debt, lower levels of personal bankruptcy filings and higher recoveries, partially offset by the impact of higher unemployment levels.
 
Compared to the year-ago quarter, our charge-off ratio decreased 190 basis points, driven by lower charge-offs across all products due to improved economic conditions.
 

 

Nonperforming Assets Nonperforming assets are summarized in the following table.
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(dollars are in millions)
Nonaccrual loans:
   
Commercial:
   
Real Estate:
   
Construction and land loans
$70
$70
Other real estate
553
529
Business banking and middle market enterprises
107
116
Large corporate
74
74
Other commercial
12
12
Total commercial
816
801
Consumer:
   
Residential mortgages, excluding home equity mortgages
812
900
Home equity mortgages
93
93
Total residential mortgages(2)
905
993
Credit card receivables
-
-
Others
9
9
Total consumer loans
914
1,002
Nonaccrual loans held for sale
169
186
Total nonaccruing loans
1,899
1,989
Accruing loans contractually past due 90 days or more:
   
Commercial:
   
Real Estate:
   
Construction and land loans
$-
$-
Other real estate
48
137
Business banking and middle market enterprises
37
47
Large corporate
-
-
Other commercial
13
12
Total commercial
98
196
Consumer:
   
Private label card receivables
243
295
Credit card receivables
194
250
Other consumer
25
25
Total consumer loans
462
570
Total accruing loans contractually past due 90 days or more
560
766
Total nonperforming loans
2,459
2,755
Other real estate owned
169
159
Total nonperforming assets
$2,628
$2,914
Allowance for credit losses as a percent of nonperforming loans(1):
   
Commercial
52.74%
53.76%
Consumer
98.11
103.94

 

____________
 
(1)
Represents our commercial or consumer allowance for credit losses, as appropriate divided by the corresponding outstanding balance of total nonperforming loans held for investment. Nonperforming loans include accruing loans contractually past due 90 days or more. Ratio excludes nonperforming loans associated with loan portfolios which are considered held for sale as these loans are carried at the lower of cost or market.
   
(2)
At March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, residential mortgage loan nonaccrual balances include $685 million and $826 million, respectively, of loans that are carried at the lower of cost or net realizable value.
 
Nonperforming loans at March 31, 2011 decreased as compared to December 31, 2010, driven largely by lower levels of residential mortgage nonaccrual loans due to improved credit quality including lower delinquency levels. Decreases in accruing loans past due 90 days or more since December 31, 2010 were driven by credit card and private label card receivables reflecting lower outstanding balances and improvements in credit quality including lower dollars of delinquency at March 31, 2011. Commercial real estate secured loans accruing past due 90 days or more also fell, driven by reductions in outstanding balances.
 
Accrued but unpaid interest on loans placed on nonaccrual status generally is reversed and reduces current income at the time loans are so categorized. Interest income on these loans may be recognized to the extent of cash payments received. In those instances where there is doubt as to collectability of principal, any cash interest payments received are applied as reductions of principal. Loans are not reclassified as accruing until interest and principal payments are brought current and future payments are reasonably assured.
 
Our policies and practices for problem loan management and placing loans on nonaccrual status are summarized in Note 2, "Summary of Significant Accounting Policies and New Accounting Pronouncements," in our 2010 Form 10-K.
 
Impaired Commercial Loans A commercial loan is considered to be impaired when it is deemed probable that all principal and interest amounts due, according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement, will not be collected. Probable losses from impaired loans are quantified and recorded as a component of the overall allowance for credit losses. Generally, impaired commercial loans include loans in nonaccrual status, loans that have been assigned a specific allowance for credit losses, loans that have been partially charged off and loans designated as troubled debt restructurings. Impaired commercial loan statistics are summarized in the following table:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Impaired commercial loans:
   
Balance at end of period
$1,163
$1,127
Amount with impairment reserve
607
620
Impairment reserve
191
188
 
Criticized Loans Criticized loan classifications are based on the risk rating standards of our primary regulator. Problem loans are assigned various criticized facility grades. We also assign obligor grades which are used under
our allowance for credit losses methodology. The following facility grades are deemed to be criticized. Criticized loans are summarized in the following table.
 
   
Increase
   
(Decrease) from
 
March 31,
December 31, 2010
 
2011
Amount
%
 
(dollars are in millions)
Special mention:
     
Commercial loans
$2,279
$(5)
(.2)%
Substandard:
     
Commercial loans
2,036
(224)
(9.9)
Consumer loans
1,682
(92)
(5.2)
Total substandard
3,718
(316)
(7.8)
Doubtful:
     
Commercial loans
257
55
27.2
Total
$6,254
$(266)
(4.1)
 
The overall decreases in criticized commercial loans in the first quarter of 2011 resulted primarily from changes in the financial condition of certain customers, some of which were upgraded during the period as well as paydowns related to certain exposures.
 
Geographic Concentrations Regional exposure at March 31, 2011 for certain loan portfolios is summarized in the following table.
 
 
Commercial
Construction and
Other Real
Estate Loans
 
Residential
Mortgage
Loans
 
Credit
Card
Receivables
New York State
47.7%
38.7%
11.1%
North Central United States
4.1
7.7
27.3
North Eastern United States
10.1
9.0
14.9
Southern United States
20.4
17.3
26.8
Western United States
17.7
27.3
19.5
Other
-
-
.4
Total
100.0%
100.0%
100.0%
 
Liquidity and Capital Resources
 
Effective liquidity management is defined as making sure we can meet customer loan requests, customer deposit maturities/withdrawals and other cash commitments efficiently under both normal operating conditions and under unpredictable circumstances of industry or market stress. To achieve this objective, we have guidelines that require sufficient liquidity to cover potential funding requirements and to avoid over-dependence on volatile, less reliable funding markets. Guidelines are set for the consolidated balance sheet of HSBC USA to ensure that it is a source of strength for our regulated, deposit-taking banking subsidiary, as well as to address the more limited sources of liquidity available to it as a holding company. Similar guidelines are set for the balance sheet of HSBC Bank USA to ensure that it can meet its liquidity needs in various stress scenarios. Cash flow analysis, including stress testing scenarios, forms the basis for liquidity management and contingency funding plans.
 
During the first quarter of 2011, marketplace liquidity continues to remain ample and companies in the financial sector continue to be able to issue debt with credit spreads approaching levels historically seen prior to the financial
crisis. The prolonged period of low Federal funds rates continues to put pressure on spreads earned on our deposit base.
 
Interest Bearing Deposits with Banks totaled $27.8 billion and $8.2 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. Balances will fluctuate from year to year depending upon our liquidity position at the time and our strategy for deploying such liquidity. The balances increased during the first quarter of 2011 as we redeployed surplus liquidity, driven by higher deposit levels.
 
Securities Purchased under Agreements to Resell totaled $6.8 billion and $8.2 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. Balances will fluctuate from year to year depending upon our liquidity position at the time and our strategy for deploying such liquidity.
 
Short-Term Borrowings totaled $13.8 billion and $15.2 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. See "Balance Sheet Review" in this MD&A for further analysis and discussion on short-term borrowing trends.
 
Deposits totaled $132.8 billion and $120.7 billion at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. See "Balance Sheet Review" in this MD&A for further analysis and discussion on deposit trends.
 
Long-Term Debt decreased to $17.0 billion at March 31, 2011 from $17.2 billion at December 31, 2010. The following table summarizes issuances and retirements of long-term debt during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010:
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
2011
2010
 
(in millions)
Long-term debt issued
$776
$678
Long-term debt retired
(986)
(1,171)
Net long-term debt retired
$(210)
$(493)
 
Issuances of long-term debt during the first quarter of 2011 included $776 million of medium term notes, of which $236 million was issued by HSBC Bank USA.
 
Under our shelf registration statement on file with the Securities and Exchange Commission, we may issue debt securities or preferred stock. The shelf has no dollar limit, but the ability to issue debt is limited by the issuance authority granted by the Board of Directors. At March 31, 2011, we were authorized to issue up to $21.0 billion, of which $8.5 billion was available. HSBC Bank USA also has a $40.0 billion Global Bank Note Program of which $17.7 billion was available at March 31, 2011.
 
As a member of the New York Federal Home Loan Bank ("FHLB"), we have a secured borrowing facility which is collateralized by real estate loans and investment securities. At March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, long-term debt included $1.0 billion, under this facility. The facility also allows access to further borrowings of up to $3.1 billion based upon the amount pledged as collateral with the FHLB.
 
At March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, we had a $2.5 billion unused line of credit with HSBC Bank plc, a U.K. based HSBC subsidiary to support issuances of commercial paper.
 
At March 31, 2011, we did not have any outstanding securities backed with private label credit card and credit card receivables issued under conduit credit facilities with commercial and investment banks. At December 31, 2010, credit card and private label card receivables of $233 million were used to collateralize $150 million of funding transactions structured as secured financings under these funding programs. The facilities were terminated in April 2011 as such facilities were no longer considered to be a cost-effective source of funding.
 
Preferred Equity See Note 19, "Preferred Stock," in our 2010 Form 10-K for information regarding all outstanding preferred share issues.
 
Common Equity During the first quarter 2011, we did not receive any cash capital contributions from HNAI.
 

Selected Capital Ratios Capital amounts and ratios are calculated in accordance with current banking regulations. In managing capital, we develop targets for Tier 1 capital to risk weighted assets, Total capital to risk weighted assets and Tier 1 capital to average assets. Our targets may change from time to time to accommodate changes in the operating environment or other considerations such as those listed above. Selected capital ratios are summarized in the following table:
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
Tier 1 capital to risk weighted assets
12.40%
11.80%
Total capital to risk weighted assets
18.72
18.14
Tier 1 capital to average assets
8.03
7.87
Total equity to total assets
8.76
9.10
 
HSBC USA manages capital in accordance with the HSBC Group policy. HSBC North America and HSBC Bank USA have each approved an Internal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process ("ICAAP") that works in conjunction with the HSBC Group's ICAAP. The ICAAP evaluates regulatory capital adequacy, economic capital adequacy, rating agency requirements and capital adequacy under various stress scenarios. Our initial approach is to meet our capital needs for these stress scenarios locally through activities which reduce risk. To the extent that local alternatives are insufficient or unavailable, we will rely on capital support from our parent in accordance with HSBC's capital management policy. HSBC has indicated that they are fully committed and have the capacity to provide capital as needed to run operations, maintain sufficient regulatory capital ratios and fund certain tax planning strategies.
 
As discussed in previous filings, HSBC North America is required to implement Basel II provisions in accordance with current regulatory timelines. While HSBC USA Inc. will not report separately under the new rules, HSBC Bank USA will report under the new rules on a stand-alone basis. Prior to adoption of Basel II, we are required to successfully complete a parallel run by measuring regulatory capital under both the new regulatory capital rules and the existing general risk-based rules for a period of at least four quarters. Successful completion of the parallel run period requires the approval of U.S. regulators. We began the parallel run period in January 2010 which encompasses enhancements to a number of risk policies, processes and systems to align HSBC Bank USA with the Basel II final rule requirements. We are uncertain as to when we will receive approval from the Federal Reserve Board, our primary regulator. Regulatory approval may not occur until later in 2011 or in 2012. We have integrated Basel II metrics into our management reporting and decision making process.
 
HSBC Bank USA is subject to restrictions that limit the transfer of funds to its affiliates, including HSBC USA, and its nonbank subsidiaries in so-called "covered transactions." In general, covered transactions include loans and other extensions of credit, investments and asset purchases, as well as certain other transactions involving the transfer of value from a subsidiary bank to an affiliate or for the benefit of an affiliate. Unless an exemption applies, covered transactions by a subsidiary bank with a single affiliate are limited to 10 percent of the subsidiary bank's capital and surplus and, with respect to all covered transactions with affiliates in the aggregate, to 20 percent of the subsidiary bank's capital and surplus. Also, loans and extensions of credit to affiliates generally are required to be secured in specified amounts. Where cash collateral is provided for an extension of credit to an affiliate, that loan is excluded from the 10 and 20 percent limitations. A bank's transactions with its nonbank affiliates are also required to be on arm's length terms.
 
We and HSBC Bank USA are required to meet minimum capital requirements by our principal regulators. Risk-based capital amounts and ratios are presented in Note 15, "Regulatory Capital," in the accompanying consolidated financial statements.
 

2011 Funding Strategy Our current range of estimates for funding needs and sources for 2011 are summarized in the following table.
 
 
Actual
January 1
through
March 31,
2011
Estimated
April 1
through
December 31,
2011
 
 
Estimated
Full Year
2011
 
(in billions)
Funding needs:
     
Net loan growth (attrition), excluding asset transfers
$-
$5
$5
Long-term debt maturities
(1)
5
4
Total funding needs
$(1)
$10
$9
Funding sources:
     
Core deposit growth
$1
$1
$2
Other deposit growth
11
(1)
10
Long-term debt issuance
1
6
7
Short-term funding/investments
(11)
4
(7)
Other, including capital infusions
(3)
-
(3)
Total funding sources
$(1)
$10
$9
 
The above table reflects a long-term funding strategy. Daily balances fluctuate as we accommodate customer needs, while ensuring that we have liquidity in place to support the balance sheet maturity funding profile. Should market conditions deteriorate, we have contingency plans to generate additional liquidity through the sales of assets or financing transactions. Our prospects for growth are dependent upon our ability to attract and retain deposits and, to a lesser extent, access to the global capital markets. We remain confident in our ability to access the market for long-term debt funding needs in the current market environment. Deposits are expected to grow as we continue to expand our core domestic banking network. We continue to seek well-priced and stable customer deposits as customers move funds to larger, well-capitalized institutions.
 
We will continue to sell a majority of new mortgage loan originations to government sponsored enterprises and private investors.
 
For further discussion relating to our sources of liquidity and contingency funding plan, see the caption "Risk Management" in this MD&A.
 
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
 
As part of our normal operations, we enter into credit derivatives and various off-balance sheet arrangements with affiliates and third parties. These arrangements arise principally in connection with our lending and client intermediation activities and involve primarily extensions of credit and, in certain cases, guarantees.
 
As a financial services provider, we routinely extend credit through loan commitments and lines and letters of credit and provide financial guarantees, including derivative transactions that meet the definition of a guarantee. The contractual amounts of these financial instruments represent our maximum possible credit exposure in the event that a counterparty draws down the full commitment amount or we are required to fulfill our maximum obligation under a guarantee.
 
The following table provides maturity information related to our credit derivatives and off-balance sheet arrangements. Many of these commitments and guarantees expire unused or without default. As a result, we believe that the contractual amount is not representative of the actual future credit exposure or funding requirements. Descriptions of these arrangements are found in our 2010 Form 10-K under the caption "Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements and Contractual Obligations."
 
 
Balance at March 31, 2011
 
 
One
Year
or Less
Over One
through
Five Years
Over
Five
Years
 
 
Total
Balance at
December 31,
2010
 
(in billions)
Standby letters of credit, net of participations(1)
$4.8
$2.6
$.5
$7.9
$7.2
Commercial letters of credit
.9
-
-
.9
.8
Credit derivatives(2)
47.8
263.9
47.9
359.6
354.8
Other commitments to extend credit:
         
Commercial
13.8
29.9
2.1
45.8
45.6
Consumer
7.1
-
-
7.1
7.2
Total
$74.4
$296.4
$50.5
$421.3
$415.6
____________
 
(1)
Includes $582 million and $486 million issued for the benefit of HSBC affiliates at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
   
(2)
Includes $52.3 billion and $49.4 billion issued for the benefit of HSBC affiliates at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.
 
We provide liquidity support to a number of multi-seller and single seller asset-backed commercial paper conduits ("ABCP conduits"). The tables below present information on our liquidity facilities with ABCP conduits at March 31, 2011. The maximum exposure to loss presented in the first table represents the maximum contractual amount of loans and asset purchases we could be required to make under the liquidity agreements. This amount assumes that we suffer a total loss on all amounts advanced and all assets purchased from the ABCP conduits. As such, we believe that this measure significantly overstates our expected loss exposure. See our 2010 Form 10-K under the caption "Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements and Contractual Obligations" in MD&A for additional information on these ABCP conduits.
 
   
Conduit Assets(1)
Conduit Funding(1)
 
 
Conduit Type
Maximum
Exposure
to Loss
 
Total
Assets
Weighted
Average Life
(Months)
 
Commercial
Paper
Weighted
Average Life
(Days)
 
(dollars are in millions)
HSBC affiliate sponsored (multi-seller)
$357
$350
60
$350
15
Third-party sponsored:
         
Single-seller
554
7,088
39
6,768
70
Total
$911
$7,438
 
$7,118
 
____________
 
(1)
For multi-seller conduits, the amounts presented represent only the specific assets and related funding supported by our liquidity facilities. For single-seller conduits, the amounts presented above represent the total assets and funding of the conduit.
 
 
Average
 
 
Asset
Average Credit Quality(1)
Asset Class
Mix
AAA
AA+/AA
A
A-
BB/BB-
B-
Multi-seller conduits
             
Debt securities backed by:
             
Auto loans and leases
100%
-%
-%
100%
-%
-%
-%
Total
100%
-%
-%
100%
-%
-%
-%
Single-seller conduits
             
Debt securities backed by:
             
Auto loans and leases
100%
98%
2%
-%
-%
-%
-%
Total
100%
98%
2%
-%
-%
-%
-%
____________
 
(1)
Credit quality is based on Standard and Poor's ratings at March 31, 2011 except for loans and trade receivables held by single-seller conduits, which are based on our internal ratings. For the single-seller conduits, external ratings are not available; however, our internal credit ratings were developed using similar methodologies and rating scales equivalent to the external credit ratings.
 
We receive fees for providing these liquidity facilities. Credit risk on these obligations is managed by subjecting them to our normal underwriting and risk management processes.
 
During the first quarter of 2011, U.S. asset-backed commercial paper volumes continued to be stable as most major bank conduit sponsors continue to extend new financing to clients but at a slow pace. Credit spreads in the multi-seller conduit market have generally remained consistent with year-end spreads. The low supply of ABCP has led to continued investor demand for the ABCP issued by large bank-sponsored ABCP programs. The improved demand for higher quality ABCP programs has led to less volatility in issuance spreads.
 
The preceding tables do not include information on liquidity facilities that we previously provided to certain Canadian multi-seller ABCP conduits that have been subject to restructuring agreements. As a result of specific difficulties in the Canadian asset backed commercial paper markets, we entered into various agreements during 2007 modifying obligations with respect to these facilities. Under one of these agreements, known as the Montreal Accord, a restructuring proposal to convert outstanding commercial paper into longer term securities was approved by ABCP noteholders and endorsed by the Canadian justice system in 2008. The restructuring plan was formally executed during the first quarter of 2009. As part of the enhanced collateral pool established for the restructuring, we have provided a $409 million Margin Funding Facility to new Master Conduit Vehicles, which is currently undrawn. HSBC Bank USA derivatives transactions with the previous conduit vehicles have been assigned to the new Master Conduit Vehicles. Under the restructuring, collateral provided to us to mitigate the derivatives exposures is significantly higher than it was prior to the restructuring.
 
Also in Canada but separately from the Montreal Accord, as part of an ABCP conduit restructuring executed in 2008, we agreed to hold long-term securities of CAD $300 million and provide a CAD $100 million credit facility. As of March 31, 2011 this credit facility was undrawn and approximately $103 million of long-term securities were held. As of December 31, 2010 this credit facility was undrawn and approximately $301 million of long-term securities were held.
 
As of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, other than the facilities referred to above, we no longer have outstanding liquidity facilities to Canadian ABCP conduits subject to the Montreal Accord or other agreements. However, we hold $10 million of long-term securities that were converted from a liquidity drawing which fell under the Montreal Accord restructuring agreement.
 
We have established and manage a number of constant net asset value ("CNAV") money market funds that invest in shorter-dated highly-rated money market securities to provide investors with a highly liquid and secure investment. These funds price the assets in their portfolio on an amortized cost basis, which enables them to create and liquidate shares at a constant price. The funds, however, are not permitted to price their portfolios at amortized cost if that
amount varies by more than 50 basis points from the portfolio's market value. In that case, the fund would be required to price its portfolio at market value and consequently would no longer be able to create or liquidate shares at a constant price. We do not consolidate the CNAV funds as they are not VIEs and we do not hold a majority voting interest.
 
Fair Value
 
Fair value measurement accounting principles require a reporting entity to take into consideration its own credit risk in determining the fair value of financial liabilities. The incorporation of our own credit risk accounted for a increase of $14 million in the fair value of financial liabilities during the three months ended March 31, 2011 compared to a decrease of $34 million during the prior year quarter.
 
Net income volatility arising from changes in either interest rate or credit components of the mark-to-market on debt designated at fair value and related derivatives affects the comparability of reported results between periods. Accordingly, the gain on debt designated at fair value and related derivatives during the three months ended March 31, 2011 should not be considered indicative of the results for any future period.
 
Control Over Valuation Process and Procedures A control framework has been established which is designed to ensure that fair values are either determined or validated by a function independent of the risk-taker. To that end, the ultimate responsibility for the determination of fair values rests with Finance. Finance establishes policies and procedures to ensure appropriate valuations. For fair values determined by reference to external quotations on the identical or similar assets or liabilities, an independent price validation process is utilized. For price validation purposes, quotations from at least two independent pricing sources are obtained for each financial instrument, where possible. We consider the following factors in determining fair values:
 
 
•    similarities between the asset or the liability under consideration and the asset or liability for which quotation is received;
 
 
•    consistency among different pricing sources;
 
 
•    the valuation approach and the methodologies used by the independent pricing sources in determining fair value;
 
 
•    the elapsed time between the date to which the market data relates and the measurement date; and
 
 
•    the source of the fair value information.
 
Greater weight is given to quotations of instruments with recent market transactions, pricing quotes from dealers who stand ready to transact, quotations provided by market-makers who originally structured such instruments, and market consensus pricing based on inputs from a large number of participants. Any significant discrepancies among the external quotations are reviewed by management and adjustments to fair values are recorded where appropriate.
 
For fair values determined by using internal valuation techniques, valuation models and inputs are developed by the business and are reviewed, validated and approved by the Quantitative Risk and Valuation Group ("QRVG") or other independent valuation control teams within Finance. Any subsequent material changes are reviewed and approved by the Valuation Committee which is comprised of representatives from the business and various control groups. Where available, we also participate in pricing surveys administered by external pricing services to validate our valuation models and the model inputs. The fair values of the majority of financial assets and liabilities are determined using well developed valuation models based on observable market inputs. The fair value measurements of these assets and liabilities require less judgment. However, certain assets and liabilities are valued based on proprietary valuation models that use one or more significant unobservable inputs and judgment is required to determine the appropriate level of adjustments to the fair value to address, among other things, model and input uncertainty. Any material adjustments to the fair values are reported to management.
 
Fair Value Hierarchy Fair value measurement accounting principles establish a fair value hierarchy structure that prioritizes the inputs to determine the fair value of an asset or liability (the "Fair Vale Framework"). The Fair Value
 

Framework distinguishes between inputs that are based on observed market data and unobservable inputs that reflect market participants' assumptions. It emphasizes the use of valuation methodologies that maximize observable market inputs. For financial instruments carried at fair value, the best evidence of fair value is a quoted price in an actively traded market (Level 1). Where the market for a financial instrument is not active, valuation techniques are used. The majority of our valuation techniques use market inputs that are either observable or indirectly derived from and corroborated by observable market data for substantially the full term of the financial instrument (Level 2). Because Level 1 and Level 2 instruments are determined by observable inputs, less judgment is applied in determining their fair values. In the absence of observable market inputs, the financial instrument is valued based on valuation techniques that feature one or more significant unobservable inputs (Level 3). The determination of the level of fair value hierarchy within which the fair value measurement of an asset or a liability is classified often requires judgment and may change over time as market conditions evolve. We consider the following factors in developing the fair value hierarchy:
 
 
•    whether the asset or liability is transacted in an active market with a quoted market price;
 
 
•    the level of bid-ask spreads;
 
 
•    a lack of pricing transparency due to, among other things, complexity of the product and market liquidity;
 
 
•    whether only a few transactions are observed over a significant period of time;
 
 
•    whether the pricing quotations vary substantially among independent pricing services;
 
 
•    whether inputs to the valuation techniques can be derived from or corroborated with market data; and
 
 
•    whether significant adjustments are made to the observed pricing information or model output to determine the fair value.
 
Level 1 inputs are unadjusted quoted prices in active markets that the reporting entity has the ability to access for identical assets or liabilities. A financial instrument is classified as a Level 1 measurement if it is listed on an exchange or is an instrument actively traded in the over-the-counter ("OTC") market where transactions occur with sufficient frequency and volume. We regard financial instruments such as equity securities and derivative contracts listed on the primary exchanges of a country to be actively traded. Non-exchange-traded instruments classified as Level 1 assets include securities issued by the U.S. Treasury or by other foreign governments, to-be-announced ("TBA") securities and non-callable securities issued by U.S. government sponsored entities.
 
Level 2 inputs are inputs that are observable either directly or indirectly but do not qualify as Level 1 inputs. We classify mortgage pass-through securities, agency and certain non-agency mortgage collateralized obligations, certain derivative contracts, asset-backed securities, corporate debt, preferred securities and leveraged loans as Level 2 measurements. Where possible, at least two quotations from independent sources are obtained based on transactions involving comparable assets and liabilities to validate the fair value of these instruments. Where significant differences arise among the independent pricing quotes and the internally determined fair value, we investigate and reconcile the differences. If the investigation results in a significant adjustment to the fair value, the instrument will be classified as Level 3 within the fair value hierarchy. In general, we have observed that there is a correlation between the credit standing and the market liquidity of a non-derivative instrument.
 
Level 2 derivative instruments are generally valued based on discounted future cash flows or an option pricing model adjusted for counterparty credit risk and market liquidity. The fair value of certain structured derivative products is determined using valuation techniques based on inputs derived from observable benchmark index tranches traded in the OTC market. Appropriate control processes and procedures have been applied to ensure that the derived inputs are applied to value only those instruments that share similar risks to the relevant benchmark indices and therefore demonstrate a similar response to market factors. In addition, a validation process has been established, which includes participation in peer group consensus pricing surveys, to ensure that valuation inputs incorporate market participants' risk expectations and risk premium.
 

Level 3 inputs are unobservable estimates that management expects market participants would use to determine the fair value of the asset or liability. That is, Level 3 inputs incorporate market participants' assumptions about risk and the risk premium required by market participants in order to bear that risk. We develop Level 3 inputs based on the best information available in the circumstances. As of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, our Level 3 instruments included the following: collateralized debt obligations ("CDOs") and collateralized loan obligations ("CLOs") for which there is a lack of pricing transparency due to market illiquidity, certain structured credit and structured equity derivatives where significant inputs (e.g., volatility or default correlations) are not observable, credit default swaps with certain monoline insurers where the deterioration in the creditworthiness of the counterparty has resulted in significant adjustments to fair value, U.S. subprime mortgage loans and subprime related asset-backed securities, mortgage servicing rights, and derivatives referenced to illiquid assets of less desirable credit quality.
 
Transfers between leveling categories are recognized at the end of each reporting period.
 
Material Transfers Between Level 1 and Level 2 Measurements During the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, there were no material transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 measurements.
 
Level 3 Measurements The following table provides information about Level 3 assets/liabilities in relation to total assets/liabilities measured at fair value as of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(dollars are in millions)
Level 3 assets(1)(2)
$5,398
$5,776
Total assets measured at fair value(3)
128,476
139,139
Level 3 liabilities
5,402
5,197
Total liabilities measured at fair value(1)
79,524
83,444
Level 3 assets as a percent of total assets measured at fair value
4.2%
4.2%
Level 3 liabilities as a percent of total liabilities measured at fair value
6.8%
6.2%
____________
 
(1)
Presented without netting which allow the offsetting of amounts relating to certain contracts if certain conditions are met.
   
(2)
Includes $4.5 billion of recurring Level 3 assets and $878 million of non-recurring Level 3 assets at March 31, 2011 and $4.8 billion of recurring Level 3 assets and $992 million of non-recurring Level 3 assets at December 31, 2010.
   
(3)
Includes $127.3 billion of assets measured on a recurring basis and $1.2 billion of assets measured on a non-recurring basis at March 31, 2011. Includes $137.6 billion of assets measured on a recurring basis and $1.5 billion of assets measured on a non-recurring basis at December 31, 2010.
 
Material Changes in Fair Value for Level 3 Assets and Liabilities
 
Derivative Assets and Counterparty Credit Risk We have entered into credit default swaps with monoline insurers to hedge our credit exposure in certain asset-backed securities and synthetic CDOs. Beginning in the second half of 2009 and continuing through 2010 and into the first quarter of 2011, the credit condition of some insurers began to improve. As a result, we made $16 million and $56 million positive credit risk adjustments to the fair value of our credit default swap contracts during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, which is reflected in trading revenue. We have recorded a cumulative credit adjustment reserve of $345 million and $361 million against our monoline exposure at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively. The decrease in the first quarter of 2011 reflects both reductions in our outstanding positions and improvements in exposure estimates.

 
Loans As of March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, we have classified $328 million and $413 million, respectively, of mortgage whole loans held for sale as a non-recurring Level 3 financial asset. These mortgage loans are accounted for on a lower of cost or fair value basis. Based on our assessment, we recorded a loss of $5 million for such mortgage loans during the first quarter of 2011 compared to a gain of $77 million during the prior year quarter. The changes in fair value are recorded as other revenues in the consolidated statement of income.
 
Material Additions to and Transfers Into (Out of) Level 3 Measurements During the three months ended March 31, 2011, we transferred $62 million of credit derivatives from Level 3 to Level 2 as a result of a qualitative analysis of the foreign exchange and credit correlation attributes of our model used for certain credit default swaps.
 
During the three months ended March 31, 2010, we transferred $218 million of credit derivatives from Level 2 to Level 3 as a result of a qualitative analysis of the foreign exchange and credit correlation attributes of our model used for certain credit default swaps. In addition, we transferred $109 million of mortgage and other asset-backed securities from Level 2 to Level 3 as the availability of observable inputs declined and the discrepancy in valuation per independent pricing services increased. We transferred $184 million of corporate bonds from Level 3 to Level 2 due to the availability of observable inputs in the market including broker and independent pricing service valuations.
 
See Note 20, "Fair Value Measurements," in the accompanying consolidated financial statements for information on additions to and transfers into (out of) Level 3 measurements during the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010 as well as for further details including the classification hierarchy associated with assets and liabilities measured at fair value.
 
Credit Quality of Assets Underlying Asset-backed Securities The following tables summarize the types and credit quality of the assets underlying our asset-backed securities as well as certain collateralized debt obligations and collateralized loan obligations held as of March 31, 2011:
 

Asset-backed securities backed by consumer finance collateral:
 
Credit Quality of Collateral:
 
     
Commercial
Mortgages
 
Prime
 
Alt-A
 
Sub-prime
 
Year of Issuance:
 
 
Total
Prior to
2006
2006 to
Present
Prior to
2006
2006 to
Present
Prior to
2006
2006 to
Present
Prior to
2006
2006 to
Present
         
(in millions)
       
Rating of securities:
Collateral type:
                 
AAA
Home equity loans
$150
$-
$-
$-
$-
$2
$146
$2
$-
 
Student loans
28
-
-
-
-
28
-
-
-
 
Residential mortgages
441
-
-
3
-
265
-
173
-
 
Commercial mortgages
514
52
462
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Other
103
-
-
-
-
103
-
-
-
 
Total AAA
1,236
52
462
3
-
398
146
175
-
AA
Home equity loans
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Residential mortgages
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Student loans
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Other
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Total AA
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
A
Home equity loans
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Residential mortgages
63
-
-
-
-
-
-
63
-
 
Commercial mortgages
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Other
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Total A
63
-
-
-
-
-
-
63
-
BBB
Home equity loans
102
-
-
-
-
2
99
1
-
 
Residential mortgages
4
-
-
-
-
4
-
-
-
 
Other
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Total BBB
106
-
-
-
-
6
99
1
-
BB
Home equity
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Residential mortgages
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Total BB
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
B
Auto loans
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Residential mortgages
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Total B
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
CCC
Home equity loans
84
-
-
-
-
1
83
-
-
 
Residential mortgages
8
-
-
-
-
4
-
-
4
 
Total CCC
92
-
-
-
-
5
83
-
4
CC
Residential mortgages
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
D
Home equity loans
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Residential mortgages
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Total D
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Unrated
Home equity loans
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Residential mortgages
9
-
-
-
-
9
-
-
-
 
Other
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
 
Total Unrated
9
-
-
-
-
9
-
-
-
   
$1,506
$52
$462
$3
$-
$418
$328
$239
$4
 
 

Collateralized debt obligations (CDO) and collateralized loan obligations (CLO):
 
Credit quality of collateral:
 
Total
A or Higher
BBB
BB/B
CCC
Unrated
   
(in millions)
       
Rating of securities:
Collateral type:
           
 
Corporate loans
$315
$-
$-
$315
$-
$-
 
Residential mortgages
9
9
-
-
-
-
 
Commercial mortgages
260
-
-
195
65
-
 
Trust preferred
153
-
153
-
-
-
 
Aircraft leasing
63
-
-
-
-
63
 
Others
-
-
-
-
-
-
   
800
$9
$153
$510
$65
$63
 
Total asset-backed securities
$2,306
         
 
Effect of Changes in Significant Unobservable Inputs The fair value of certain financial instruments is measured using valuation techniques that incorporate pricing assumptions not supported by, derived from or corroborated by observable market data. The resultant fair value measurements are dependent on unobservable input parameters which can be selected from a range of estimates and may be interdependent. Changes in one or more of the significant unobservable input parameters may change the fair value measurements of these financial instruments. For the purpose of preparing the financial statements, the final valuation inputs selected are based on management's best judgment that reflect the assumptions market participants would use in pricing similar assets or liabilities.
 
The unobservable input parameters selected are subject to the internal valuation control processes and procedures. When we perform a test of all the significant input parameters to the extreme values within the range at the same time, it could result in an increase of the overall fair value measurement of approximately $185 million or a decrease of the overall fair value measurement of approximately $149 million as of March 31, 2011. The effect of changes in significant unobservable input parameters are primarily driven by mortgage whole loans held for sale or securitization, certain asset-backed securities including CDOs, and the uncertainty in determining the fair value of credit derivatives executed against monoline insurers.
 
Risk Management
 
Overview Some degree of risk is inherent in virtually all of our activities. For the principal activities undertaken, the following are considered to be the most important types of risks:
 
 
•   Credit risk is the potential that a borrower or counterparty will default on a credit obligation, as well as the impact on the value of credit instruments due to changes in the probability of borrower default.
 
 
•   Liquidity risk is the potential that an institution will be unable to meet its obligations as they become due or fund its customers because of inadequate cash flow or the inability to liquidate assets or obtain funding itself.
 
 
•   Interest rate risk is the potential impairment of net interest income due to mismatched pricing between assets and liabilities as well as losses in value due to rate movements.
 
 
•   Market risk is the potential for losses in daily mark-to-market positions (mostly trading) due to adverse movements in money, foreign exchange, equity or other markets and includes both interest rate risk and trading risk.
 
 
•   Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people, or systems, or from external events (including legal risk but excluding strategic and reputational risk).
 
 
•   Compliance risk is the risk arising from failure to comply with relevant laws, regulations and regulatory requirements governing the conduct of specific businesses.
 
 
•   Fiduciary risk is the risk associated with offering services honestly and properly to clients in a fiduciary capacity in accordance with Regulation 12 CFR 9, Fiduciary Activity of National Banks.
 
 
•   Reputational risk involves the safeguarding of our reputation and can arise from social, ethical or environmental issues, or as a consequence of operational and other risk events.
 
 
•   Strategic risk is the risk to earnings or capital arising from adverse business decisions or improper implementation of those decisions.
 
There have been no significant changes to the policies or approach for managing various types of risk as disclosed in our 2010 Form 10-K, although we continue to monitor market conditions and will adjust risk management policies and procedures as deemed necessary. See "Risk Management" in MD&A in our 2010 Form 10-K for a more complete discussion of the objectives of our risk management system as well as our risk management policies and practices. Our risk management process involves the use of various simulation models. We believe that the assumptions used in these models are reasonable, but actual events may unfold differently than what is assumed in the models. Consequently, model results may be considered reasonable estimates, with the understanding that actual results may vary significantly from model projections.
 
Credit Risk Management Credit risk is the potential that a borrower or counterparty will default on a credit obligation, as well as the impact on the value of credit instruments due to changes in the probability of borrower default.
 
Credit risk is inherent in various on- and off-balance sheet instruments and arrangements, such as:
 
 
•   loan portfolios;
 
 
•   investment portfolios;
 
 
•   unfunded commitments such as letters of credit and lines of credit that customers can draw upon; and
 
 
•   treasury instruments, such as interest rate swaps which, if more valuable today than when originally contracted, may represent an exposure to the counterparty to the contract.
 
While credit risk exists widely in our operations, diversification among various commercial and consumer portfolios helps to lessen risk exposure. Day-to-day management of credit and market risk is performed by the Chief Credit Officer, the HSBC North America Chief Retail Credit Officer and the Head of Market Risk, who report directly to the HSBC North America Chief Risk Officer and maintain independent risk functions. The credit risk associated with commercial portfolios is managed by the Chief Credit Officer, while credit risk associated with retail consumer loan portfolios, such as credit cards, installment loans and residential mortgages, is managed by the HSBC North America Chief Retail Credit Officer. Further discussion of credit risk can be found under the "Credit Quality" caption in this MD&A.
 
Credit risk associated with derivatives is measured as the net replacement cost in the event the counterparties with contracts in a gain position to us fail to perform under the terms of those contracts. In managing derivative credit risk, both the current exposure, which is the replacement cost of contracts on the measurement date, as well as an estimate of the potential change in value of contracts over their remaining lives are considered. Counterparties to our derivative activities include financial institutions, foreign and domestic government agencies, corporations, funds (mutual funds, hedge funds, etc.), insurance companies and private clients as well as other HSBC entities. These counterparties are subject to regular credit review by the credit risk management department. To minimize credit risk, we enter into legally enforceable master netting agreements which reduce risk by permitting the closeout and netting of transactions with the same counterparty upon occurrence of certain events. In addition, we reduce credit risk by obtaining collateral from counterparties. The determination of the need for and the levels of collateral will vary based on an assessment of the credit risk of the counterparty.
 
The total risk in a derivative contract is a function of a number of variables, such as:
 
 
•   volatility of interest rates, currencies, equity or corporate reference entity used as the basis for determining contract payments;
 
 
•   current market events or trends;
 
 
•   country risk;
 
 
•   maturity and liquidity of contracts;
 
 
•   credit worthiness of the counterparties in the transaction;
 
 
•   the existence of a master netting agreement among the counterparties; and
 
 
•   existence and value of collateral received from counterparties to secure exposures.
 
The table below presents total credit risk exposure measured using rules contained in the risk-based capital guidelines published by U.S. banking regulatory agencies. Risk-based capital guidelines recognize that bilateral netting agreements reduce credit risk and, therefore, allow for reductions of risk-weighted assets when netting requirements have been met. As a result, risk-weighted amounts for regulatory capital purposes are a portion of the original gross exposures.
 
The risk exposure calculated in accordance with the risk-based capital guidelines potentially overstates actual credit exposure because: the risk-based capital guidelines ignore collateral that may have been received from counterparties to secure exposures; and the risk-based capital guidelines compute exposures over the life of derivative contracts. However, many contracts contain provisions that allow us to close out the transaction if the counterparty fails to post required collateral. In addition, many contracts give us the right to break the transactions earlier than the final maturity date. As a result, these contracts have potential future exposures that are often much smaller than the future exposures derived from the risk-based capital guidelines.
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Risk associated with derivative contracts:
   
Total credit risk exposure
$41,759
$39,652
Less: collateral held against exposure
4,658
4,577
Net credit risk exposure
$37,101
$35,075
 
Liquidity Risk Management There have been no material changes to our approach towards liquidity risk management since December 31, 2010. See "Risk Management" in MD&A in our 2010 Form 10-K for a more complete discussion of our approach to liquidity risk. Although our overall approach to liquidity management has not changed, we continue to enhance our implementation of that approach to reflect best practices. The past few years have suggested that in a market crisis, traditional sources of crisis liquidity such as secured lending and deposits with other banks may not be available. Similarly, the current regulatory initiatives are suggesting banks need to retain a portfolio of extremely high quality liquid assets. Consistent with these items, we are expanding our portfolio of high quality sovereign and sovereign guaranteed securities.
 
We continuously monitor the impact of market events on our liquidity positions. In general terms, the strains due to the recent credit crisis have been concentrated in the wholesale market as opposed to the retail market (the latter being the market from which we source core demand and time deposit accounts). Financial institutions with less reliance on the wholesale markets were in many respects less affected by those conditions. Our limited dependence upon the wholesale markets for funding has been a significant competitive advantage through the most recent period of financial market turmoil.
 
Our liquidity management approach includes increased deposits and potential sales (e.g. residential mortgage loans) in liquidity contingency plans. Total deposits increased $12.1 billion during the first quarter of 2011.
 

Our ability to regularly attract wholesale funds at a competitive cost is enhanced by strong ratings from the major credit ratings agencies. At March 31, 2011, we and HSBC Bank USA maintained the following long and short-term debt ratings:
 
 
Moody's
S&P
Fitch
DBRS(1)
HSBC USA Inc.:
       
Short-term borrowings
P-1
A-1+
F1+
R-1
Long-term debt
A1
AA-
AA
AA
HSBC Bank USA:
       
Short-term borrowings
P-1
A-1+
F1+
R-1
Long-term debt
Aa3
AA
AA
AA
____________
 
(1)
Dominion Bond Rating Service.
 
As of March 31, 2011, there were no pending actions in terms of changes to ratings on the debt of HSBC USA Inc. or HSBC Bank USA from any of the rating agencies.
 
Interest Rate Risk Management Various techniques are utilized to quantify and monitor risks associated with the repricing characteristics of our assets, liabilities and derivative contracts. Our approach to managing interest rate risk is summarized in MD&A in our 2010 Form 10-K under the caption "Risk Management." There have been no material changes to our approach towards interest rate risk management since December 31, 2010.
 
Present Value of a Basis Point ("PVBP") is the change in value of the balance sheet for a one basis point upward movement in all interest rates. The following table reflects the PVBP position at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Institutional PVBP movement limit
$8.0
$8.0
PVBP position at period end
1.5
3.9
 
Economic value of equity is the change in value of the assets and liabilities (excluding capital and goodwill) for either a 200 basis point immediate rate increase or decrease. The following table reflects the economic value of equity position at March 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(values as a
 
percentage)
Institutional economic value of equity limit
+/-15
+/-20
Projected change in value (reflects projected rate movements on January 1):
   
Change resulting from an immediate 200 basis point increase in interest rates
(5)
(7)
Change resulting from an immediate 200 basis point decrease in interest rates
(8)
(4)
 
The loss in value for a 200 basis point increase or decrease in rates is a result of the negative convexity of the residential whole loan and mortgage-backed securities portfolios. If rates decrease, the projected prepayments related to these portfolios will accelerate, causing less appreciation than a comparable term, non-convex instrument. If rates increase, projected prepayments will slow, which will cause the average lives of these positions to extend and result in a greater loss in market value.
 
Dynamic simulation modeling techniques are utilized to monitor a number of interest rate scenarios for their impact on net interest income. These techniques include both rate shock scenarios, which assume immediate market rate movements by as much as 200 basis points, as well as scenarios in which rates rise or fall by as much as 200 basis points over a twelve month period. The following table reflects the impact on net interest income of the scenarios utilized by these modeling techniques.
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
Amount
%
Amount
%
 
(dollars are in millions)
Projected change in net interest income (reflects projected rate movements
on January 1):
       
Institutional base earnings movement limit
 
(8)%
 
(10)%
Change resulting from a gradual 100 basis point increase in the yield curve
$77
2
$43
1
Change resulting from a gradual 100 basis point decrease in the yield curve
(238)
(5)
(205)
(4)
Change resulting from a gradual 200 basis point increase in the yield curve
110
2
20
-
Change resulting from a gradual 200 basis point decrease in the yield curve
(398)
(9)
(374)
(8)
Other significant scenarios monitored (reflects projected rate movements on January 1):
       
Change resulting from an immediate 100 basis point increase in the yield curve
93
2
43
1
Change resulting from an immediate 100 basis point decrease in the yield curve
(334)
(7)
(335)
(7)
Change resulting from an immediate 200 basis point increase in the yield curve
98
2
(20)
-
Change resulting from an immediate 200 basis point decrease in the yield curve
(535)
(12)
(531)
(11)
 
The projections do not take into consideration possible complicating factors such as the effect of changes in interest rates on the credit quality, size and composition of the balance sheet. Therefore, although this provides a reasonable estimate of interest rate sensitivity, actual results will vary from these estimates, possibly by significant amounts.
 
Capital Risk/Sensitivity of Other Comprehensive Income Large movements of interest rates could directly affect some reported capital balances and ratios. The mark-to-market valuation of available-for-sale securities is credited on a tax effective basis to accumulated other comprehensive income. Although this valuation mark is excluded from Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital ratios, it is included in two important accounting based capital ratios: the tangible common equity to tangible assets and the tangible common equity to risk weighted assets. As of March 31, 2011, we had an available-for-sale securities portfolio of approximately $40.6 billion with a negative mark-to-market of $125 million included in tangible common equity of $13.2 billion. An increase of 25 basis points in interest rates of all maturities would lower the mark-to-market by approximately $258 million to a net loss of $383 million with the following results on our tangible capital ratios. As of December 31, 2010, we had an available-for-sale securities portfolio of approximately $45.5 billion with a positive mark-to-market of $187 million included in tangible common equity of $12.5 billion. An increase of 25 basis points in interest rates of all maturities would lower the mark-to-market by approximately $328 million to a net loss of $141 million with the following results on our tangible capital ratios.
 
 
March 31, 2011
December 31, 2010
 
Actual
Proforma(1)
Actual
Proforma(1)
Tangible common equity to tangible assets
6.78%
6.68%
6.91%
6.80%
Tangible common equity to risk weighted assets
10.76
10.58
10.29
10.10
____________
 
(1)
Proforma percentages reflect a 25 basis point increase in interest rates.
 

 

Market Risk Management There have been no material changes to our approach towards market risk management since December 31, 2010. See "Risk Management" in MD&A in our 2010 Form 10-K for a more complete discussion of our approach to market risk.
 
Value at Risk ("VAR") is a technique used to estimate the maximum potential losses that could occur on risk positions as a result of movements in market rates and prices over a specified time horizon and to a given level of confidence.
 
VAR calculations are performed for all material trading activities and as a tool for managing interest rate risk inherent in non-trading activities. VAR is calculated daily for a one-day holding period to a 99 percent confidence level.
 
VAR - Trading Activities Our management of market risk is based on a policy of restricting individual operations to trading within an authorized list of permissible instruments, enforcing new product approval procedures and restricting trading in the more complex derivative products to offices with appropriate levels of product expertise and robust control systems. Market making trading is undertaken within Global Banking and Markets.
 
In addition, at both portfolio and position levels, market risk in trading portfolios is monitored and managed using a complementary set of techniques, including VAR and a variety of interest rate risk monitoring techniques as discussed above. These techniques quantify the impact on capital of defined market movements.
 
Trading portfolios reside primarily within the Markets unit of the Global Banking and Markets business segment, which include warehoused residential mortgage loans purchased with the intent of selling them, and within the mortgage banking subsidiary included within the PFS business segment. Portfolios include foreign exchange, interest rate swaps and credit derivatives, precious metals (i.e. gold, silver, platinum), equities and money market instruments including "repos" and securities. Trading occurs as a result of customer facilitation, proprietary position taking and economic hedging. In this context, economic hedging may include forward contracts to sell residential mortgages and derivative contracts which, while economically viable, may not satisfy the hedge accounting requirements.
 
The trading portfolios have defined limits pertaining to items such as permissible investments, risk exposures, loss review, balance sheet size and product concentrations. "Loss review" refers to the maximum amount of loss that may be incurred before senior management intervention is required.
 
The following table summarizes trading VAR for the three months ended March 31, 2011:
 
 
March 31,
Three Months Ended March 31, 2011
December 31,
 
2011
Minimum
Maximum
Average
2010
 
                              (in millions)
Total trading
$22
$15
$26
$18
$21
Equities
-
-
1
-
-
Foreign exchange
2
1
4
2
1
Interest rate directional and credit spread
21
13
22
16
18
 
The following table summarizes the frequency distribution of daily market risk-related revenues for trading activities during the three months ended March 31, 2011. Market risk-related trading revenues include realized and unrealized gains (losses) related to trading activities, but exclude the related net interest income. Analysis of the gain (loss) data for the three months ended March 31, 2011 shows that the largest daily gain was $14 million and the largest daily loss was $6 million.
 
 
Ranges of daily treasury trading revenue earned from market risk-related activities
Below
$(5)
$(5)
to $0
$0 to
$5
$5 to
$10
Over
$10
 
(dollars are in millions)
Number of trading days market risk-related revenue was within the stated range
1
14
36
9
2

 
VAR - Non-trading Activities Interest rate risk in non-trading portfolios arises principally from mismatches between the future yield on assets and their funding cost as a result of interest rate changes. Analysis of this risk is complicated by having to make assumptions on embedded optionality within certain product areas such as the incidence of mortgage repayments, and from behavioral assumptions regarding the economic duration of liabilities which are contractually repayable on demand such as current accounts. The prospective change in future net interest income from non-trading portfolios will be reflected in the current realizable value of these positions if they were to be sold or closed prior to maturity. In order to manage this risk optimally, market risk in non-trading portfolios is transferred to Global Markets or to separate books managed under the supervision of the local Asset and Liability Committee ("ALCO"). Once market risk has been consolidated in Global Markets or ALCO-managed books, the net exposure is typically managed through the use of interest rate swaps within agreed upon limits.
 
The following table summarizes non-trading VAR for the three months ended March 31, 2011, assuming a 99% confidence level for a two-year observation period and a one-day "holding period".
 
 
March 31,
Three Months Ended March 31, 2011
December 31,
 
2011
Minimum
Maximum
Average
2010
 
(in millions)
Interest rate
$110
$109
$146
$135
$138
 
Trading Activities - HSBC Mortgage Corporation (USA) ("HSBC Mortgage Corp") HSBC Mortgage Corp is a mortgage banking subsidiary of HSBC Bank USA. Trading occurs in mortgage banking operations as a result of an economic hedging program intended to offset changes in value of mortgage servicing rights and the salable loan pipeline. Economic hedging may include, for example, forward contracts to sell residential mortgages and derivative instruments used to protect the value of MSRs.
 
MSRs are assets that represent the present value of net servicing income (servicing fees, ancillary income, escrow and deposit float, net of servicing costs). MSRs are separately recognized upon the sale of the underlying loans or at the time that servicing rights are purchased. MSRs are subject to interest rate risk, in that their value will decline as a result of actual and expected acceleration of prepayment of the underlying loans in a falling interest rate environment.
 
Interest rate risk is mitigated through an active hedging program that uses trading securities and derivative instruments to offset changes in value of MSRs. Since the hedging program involves trading activity, risk is quantified and managed using a number of risk assessment techniques.
 
Modeling techniques, primarily rate shock analyses, are used to monitor certain interest rate scenarios for their impact on the economic value of net hedged MSRs, as reflected in the following table.
 
 
March 31,
2011
December 31,
2010
 
(in millions)
Projected change in net market value of hedged MSRs portfolio (reflects projected rate movements on April 1 and January 1, respectively):
   
Value of hedged MSRs portfolio
$396
$394
Change resulting from an immediate 50 basis point decrease in the yield curve:
   
Change limit (no worse than)
(10)
(10)
Calculated change in net market value
(8)
(2)
Change resulting from an immediate 50 basis point increase in the yield curve:
   
Change limit (no worse than)
(8)
(8)
Calculated change in net market value
8
5
Change resulting from an immediate 100 basis point increase in the yield curve:
   
Change limit (no worse than)
(12)
(12)
Calculated change in net market value
13
12
 

The economic value of the net hedged MSRs portfolio is monitored on a daily basis for interest rate sensitivity. If the economic value declines by more than established limits for one day or one month, various levels of management review, intervention and/or corrective actions are required.
 
The following table summarized the frequency distribution of the weekly economic value of the MSR asset during the three months ended March 31, 2011. This includes the change in the market value of the MSR asset net of changes in the market value of the underlying hedging positions used to hedge the asset. The changes in economic value are adjusted for changes in MSR valuation assumptions that were made during the course of the year.
 
 
Ranges of mortgage economic value from market risk-related activities
Below
$(2)
$(2) to
$0
$0 to
$2
$2 to
$4
Over
$4
 
(dollars are in millions)
Number of trading weeks market risk-related revenue was within the stated range
1
6
3
2
1
 
Operational Risk There have been no material changes to our approach toward operational risk since December 31, 2010.
 
Compliance Risk There have been no material changes to our approach toward compliance risk since December 31, 2010.
 
Fiduciary Risk There have been no material changes to our approach toward fiduciary risk since December 31, 2010.
 
Reputational Risk There have been no material changes to our approach toward reputational risk since December 31, 2010.
 
Strategic Risk There have been no material changes to our approach toward strategic risk since December 31, 2010.
 

 

Consolidated Average Balances and Interest Rates
 
The following table shows the quarter-to-date average balances of the principal components of assets, liabilities and shareholders' equity together with their respective interest amounts and rates earned or paid, presented on a taxable equivalent basis.
 
 
2011
2010
Three Months Ended March 31,
Balance
Interest
Rate(1)
Balance
Interest
Rate(1)
 
(dollars are in millions)
Assets
           
Interest bearing deposits with banks
$20,345
$16
.32%
$33,867
$22
.26%
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements
6,676
15
.94
2,495
6
1.01
Trading securities
12,762
51
1.62
5,399
32
2.37
Securities
46,437
323
2.82
32,569
247
3.08
Loans:
           
Commercial
31,660
233
2.98
32,398
245
3.06
Consumer:
           
Residential mortgages
14,710
162
4.47
14,820
176
4.82
HELOCs and home equity mortgages
3,743
29
3.14
4,103
33
3.29
Private label card receivables
12,638
292
9.38
14,326
362
10.24
Credit cards
10,331
185
7.27
12,428
288
9.38
Auto finance
-
-
-
1,865
82
17.96
Other consumer
1,211
22
7.35
1,450
25
7.16
Total consumer
42,633
690
6.57
48,992
966
8.00
Total loans
74,293
923
5.04
81,390
1,211
6.04
Other
6,096
12
.78
6,802
11
.68
Total earning assets
166,609
$1,340
3.26%
162,522
$1,529
3.82%
Allowance for credit losses
(2,093)
   
(3,776)
   
Cash and due from banks
1,633
   
1,560
   
Other assets
25,276
   
23,323
   
Total assets
$191,425
   
$183,629
   
Liabilities and Shareholders' Equity
           
Deposits in domestic offices:
           
Savings deposits
$57,262
$76
.54%
$52,961
$105
.81%
Other time deposits
16,852
31
.75
17,625
48
1.10
Deposits in foreign offices:
           
Foreign banks deposits
6,539
3
.21
9,500
5
.20
Other interest bearing deposits
16,980
6
.13
20,348
5
.10
Total interest bearing deposits
97,633
116
.48
100,434
163
.66
Short-term borrowings
22,005
13
.23
16,847
21
.51
Long-term debt
17,127
163
3.87
17,627
140
3.21
Total interest bearing liabilities
136,765
292
.87
134,908
324
.97
Net interest income/Interest rate spread
 
$1,048
2.39%
 
$1,205
2.85%
Noninterest bearing deposits
24,254
   
21,285
   
Other liabilities
13,459
   
12,108
   
Total shareholders' equity
16,947
   
15,328
   
Total liabilities and shareholders' equity
$191,425
   
$183,629
   
Net interest margin on average earning assets
   
2.55%
   
3.01%
Net interest margin on average total assets
   
2.22%
   
2.66%
____________
 
(1)
Rates are calculated on unrounded numbers.
 

 

Total weighted average rate earned on earning assets is interest and fee earnings divided by daily average amounts of total interest earning assets, including the daily average amount on nonperforming loans. Loan interest for the three months ended March 31, 2011 and 2010 included fees of $21 million and $14 million, respectively.
 
Item 3. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
 
Refer to Item 2, Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations, under the captions "Interest Rate Risk Management" and "Trading Activities" of this Form 10-Q.
 
Item 4. Controls and Procedures
 
Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures We maintain a system of internal and disclosure controls and procedures designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by HSBC USA in the reports we file or submit under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act"), is recorded, processed, summarized and reported on a timely basis. Our Board of Directors, operating through its audit committee, which is composed entirely of independent outside directors, provides oversight to our financial reporting process.
 
We conducted an evaluation, with the participation of the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures as of the end of the period covered by this report. Based upon that evaluation, the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of the end of the period covered by this report so as to alert them in a timely fashion to material information required to be disclosed in reports we file under the Exchange Act.
 
Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting There has been no change in our internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the quarter ended March 31, 2011 that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.
 
PART II. OTHER INFORMATION
 
Item 1. Legal Proceedings
 
See Note 19, "Litigation and Regulatory Matters," in the accompanying consolidated financial statements beginning on page 67 for our legal proceedings disclosure, which is incorporated herein by reference.
 
Item 6. Exhibits
 
Exhibits included in this Report:
 
12
Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges and Earnings to Combined Fixed Charges and Preferred Stock Dividends.
   
31
Certification of Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
   
32
Certification of Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 

 

Index
 
 
              
 
Assets:
       by business segment  
       consolidated average balances  
       fair value measurements  
       nonperforming  
       trading  
Asset-backed commercial paper conduits  
Asset-backed securities  
Balance sheet:
       consolidated  
       consolidated average balances  
       review  
Basel II  
Basis of reporting  
Business:
       consolidated performance review  
Capital:
       2011 funding strategy  
       common equity movements  
       consolidated statement of changes  
       regulatory capital  
       selected capital ratios  
Cash flow (consolidated)  
Cautionary statement regarding forward-looking
       statements  
Collateral - pledged assets  
Collateralized debt obligations  
Commercial banking segment results
       (IFRSs)  
Compliance risk  
Controls and procedures  
Credit card fees  
Credit quality  
Credit risk:
       adjustment  
       component of fair value option  
       concentration  
       exposure  
       management  
       related contingent features  
       related arrangements  
Current environment  
Deferred tax assets  
Deposits  
Derivatives:
       cash flow hedges  
       fair value hedges  
       notional value  
       trading and other  
Discontinued operations  
 
Equity:
       consolidated statement of changes  
       ratios  
Equity securities available-for-sale  
Estimates and assumptions  
Executive overview  
Fair value measurements:
       assets and liabilities recorded at fair value on a
          recurring basis  
       assets and liabilities recorded at fair value on a
          non-recurring basis  
       control over valuation process  
       financial instruments  
       hierarchy  
       transfers into/out of level one and
          two  
       transfers into/out of level two and
          three  
       valuation techniques  
Fiduciary risk  
Financial assets:
       designated at fair value  
Financial highlights metrics  
Financial liabilities:
       designated at fair value  
       fair value of financial liabilities  
Forward looking statements  
Funding  
Gain on instruments designated at fair value and related
       derivatives  
Gains less losses from securities  
Global Banking and Markets:
       balance sheet data (IFRSs)  
       segment results (IFRSs)  
Geographic concentration of receivables  
Goodwill  
Guarantee arrangements  
Impairment:
       available-for-sale securities  
       credit losses  
       nonperforming loans  
       impaired loans  
Intangible assets  
Income tax expense  
Internal control  
Interest rate risk  
Key performance indicators  
Legal proceedings  
Leveraged finance transactions  
 
     
Liabilities:
       commitments, lines of credit  
       deposits  
       financial liabilities designated at
          fair value  
       long-term debt  
       short-term borrowings  
       trading  
Liquidity and capital resources  
Liquidity risk  
Litigation and regulatory matters  
Loans:
       by category  
       by charge-off (net)  
       by delinquency  
       criticized assets  
       geographic concentration 
       held for sale  
       impaired  
       nonperforming  
       overall review  
       purchases from HSBC Finance  
       risk concentration  
       troubled debt restructures  
Loan impairment charges - see Provision for
       credit losses
Loan-to-deposits ratio  
Market risk  
Market turmoil:
       exposures  
       impact on liquidity risk  
Monoline insurers  
Mortgage lending products  
Mortgage servicing rights  
Net interest income  
New accounting pronouncements  
Off balance sheet arrangements  
Operating expenses  
Operational risk  
Other revenue  
Other segment results (IFRSs)  
Pension and other postretirement benefits  
Performance, developments and trends  
Personal financial services segment
       results (IFRSs)  
Pledged assets  
Private banking segment results (IFRSs)  
Profit (loss) before tax:
       by segment - IFRSs  
       consolidated  
Provision for credit losses  
 
Ratios:
       capital  
       charge-off (net)  
       credit loss reserve related  
       earnings to fixed charges - Exhibit  12
       efficiency  
       financial  
       loans-to-deposits  
Real estate owned  
Reconciliation of U.S. GAAP results to IFRSs  
Refreshed loan-to-value  
Related party transactions  
Reputational risk  
Results of operations  
Risk elements in the loan portfolio  
Risk management:
       credit  
       compliance  
       fiduciary  
       interest rate  
       liquidity  
       market  
       operational  
       reputational  
       strategic  
Securities:
       fair value  
       impairment  
       maturity analysis  
Segment results - IFRSs basis:
       personal financial services  
       commercial banking  
       global banking and markets  
       private banking  
       other  
       overall summary  
Selected financial data  
Sensitivity:
       projected net interest income  
Statement of changes in shareholders' equity  
Statement of changes in comprehensive income  
Statement of income  
Strategic risk  
Table of contents  
Tax expense  
Trading:
       assets  
       derivatives  
       liabilities  
       portfolios  
Trading revenue (net)  
Troubled debt restructures  
Value at risk  
Variable interest entities  
 

 

Signature
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned thereunto duly authorized.
 
Date: May 11, 2011
 
HSBC USA Inc.
(Registrant)
 
/s/  John T. Mcginnis                                         
John T. McGinnis
Executive Vice President and
Chief Financial Officer
 

 
 

 

Exhibit Index
 
12
Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges and Earnings to Combined Fixed Charges and Preferred Stock Dividends.
   
31
Certification of Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
   
32
Certification of Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 

 
 

 

EXHIBIT 12
 
HSBC USA INC.
COMPUTATION OF RATIO OF EARNINGS TO FIXED CHARGES AND TO
COMBINED FIXED CHARGES AND PREFERRED STOCK DIVIDENDS
 
 
Three Months
Ended March 31,
 
2011
2010
 
(dollars are in
millions)
Ratios excluding interest on deposits:
   
Income from continuing operations
$480
$544
Income tax expense
82
314
Less: Undistributed equity earnings
-
2
Fixed charges:
   
Interest on:
   
Borrowed funds
13
21
Long-term debt
163
140
One third of rents, net of income from subleases
8
7
Total fixed charges, excluding interest on deposits
184
168
Income from continuing operations before taxes and fixed charges, net of undistributed equity earnings
$746
$1,024
Ratio of earnings from continuing operations to fixed charges
4.05
6.10
Total preferred stock dividend factor(1)
$21
$29
Fixed charges, including the preferred stock dividend factor
$205
$197
Ratio of earnings from continuing operations to combined fixed charges and preferred stock dividends
3.64
5.20
Ratios including interest on deposits:
   
Total fixed charges, excluding interest on deposits
$184
$168
Add: Interest on deposits
116
163
Total fixed charges, including interest on deposits
$300
$331
Earnings from continuing operations before taxes and fixed charges, net of undistributed equity earnings
$746
$1,024
Add: Interest on deposits
116
163
Total
$862
$1,187
Ratio of earnings from continuing operations to fixed charges
2.87
3.59
Fixed charges, including the preferred stock dividend factor
$205
$197
Add: Interest on deposits
116
163
Fixed charges, including the preferred stock dividend factor and interest on deposits
$321
$360
Ratio of earnings from continuing operations to combined fixed charges and preferred stock dividends
2.69
3.30
____________
 
(1)
Preferred stock dividends grossed up to their pretax equivalents.
 

 
 

 

EXHIBIT 31
 
Certification of Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer
Pursuant to Section 302 of The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
Certification of Chief Executive Officer
 
I, Irene M. Dorner, President and Chief Executive Officer of HSBC USA Inc., certify that:
 
1. I have reviewed this quarterly report on Form 10-Q of HSBC USA Inc.;
 
2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
 
3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
 
4. The registrant's other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:
 
a) designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
 
b) designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
 
c) evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant's disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
 
d) disclosed in this report any change in the registrant's internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant's most recent fiscal quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant's internal control over financial reporting; and
 
5. The registrant's other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant's auditors and the audit committee of the registrant's board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
 
a) all significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant's ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
 
b) any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant's internal control over financial reporting.
 
Date: May 11, 2011
 
/s/  IRENE M. DORNER                                         
Irene M. Dorner
President and Chief Executive
Officer
 

 

Certification of Chief Financial Officer
 
I, John T. McGinnis, Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of HSBC USA Inc., certify that:
 
1. I have reviewed this quarterly report on Form 10-Q of HSBC USA Inc.;
 
2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
 
3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
 
4. The registrant's other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:
 
a) designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
 
b) designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
 
c) evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant's disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
 
d) disclosed in this report any change in the registrant's internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant's most recent fiscal quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant's internal control over financial reporting; and
 
5. The registrant's other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant's auditors and the audit committee of the registrant's board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
 
a) all significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant's ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
 
b) any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant's internal control over financial reporting.
 
Date: May 11, 2011
 
/s/  JOHN T. MCGINNIS                                         
John T. McGinnis
Executive Vice President and
Chief Financial Officer
 

 

EXHIBIT 32
 
Certification of Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer
Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
 
Certification Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to
Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
 
The certification set forth below is being submitted in connection with the HSBC USA Inc. (the "Company") quarterly report on Form 10-Q for the period ending March 31, 2011 as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the "Report") for the purpose of complying with Rule 13a-14(b) or Rule 15d-14(b) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the "Exchange Act") and Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the United States Code.
 
I, Irene M. Dorner, President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company, certify that:
 
1. the Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act; and
 
2. the information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of HSBC USA Inc.
 
Date: May 11, 2011
 
/s/  IRENE M. DORNER                                         
Irene M. Dorner
President and Chief Executive Officer
 

 

Certification pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to
Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
 
The certification set forth below is being submitted in connection with the HSBC USA Inc. (the "Company") quarterly report on Form 10-Q for the period ending March 31, 2011 as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the "Report") for the purpose of complying with Rule 13a-14(b) or Rule 15d-14(b) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the "Exchange Act") and Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the United States Code.
 
I, John T. McGinnis, Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of the Company, certify that:
 
1. the Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act; and
 
2. the information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of HSBC USA Inc.
 
Date: May 11, 2011
 
/s/ JOHN T. MCGINNIS                                         
John T. McGinnis
Executive Vice President and
Chief Financial Officer
 
These certifications accompany each Report pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and shall not, except to the extent required by the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, be deemed filed by HSBC USA Inc. for purposes of Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.
 
Signed originals of these written statements required by Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 have been provided to HSBC USA Inc. and will be retained by HSBC USA Inc. and furnished to the Securities and Exchange Commission or its staff upon request.
 


 

 
 
 
SIGNATURE
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
 
HSBC Holdings plc
 
 
 
                                                       By:
 
                                                                                Name:   P A Stafford
 
                                                                                                Title: Assistant Group Secretary
                     
                      
                                                                               Date: 11 May 2011